Admission Document
Transcription
Admission Document
RM2 International S.A. AIM Admission Document Nominated Adviser & Broker Cenkos Securities plc 6.7.8 Tokenhouse Yard London EC2R 7AS RM2 International S.A. 5, rue de la Chapelle L-1325 Luxembourg Grand Duchy of Luxembourg THIS DOCUMENT IS IMPORTANT AND REQUIRES YOUR IMMEDIATE ATTENTION. If you are in any doubt about the contents of this document or as to what action you should take, you are recommended immediately to seek your own financial advice from your stockbroker, bank manager, solicitor, accountant or other independent adviser who specialises in advising on the acquisition of shares and other securities and is authorised under the Financial Services and Markets Act 2000 (as amended) (“FSMA”) if you are resident in the UK, or, if you are not resident in the UK, from another authorised independent adviser. The whole of this document should be read. Your attention is drawn in particular to the section entitled “Risk Factors” in Part III of this document that describes certain risks associated with an investment in the Company. The Directors of RM2 International S.A. (the “Company”), whose names, business addresses and functions appear on page 4 of this document, and the Company itself accept responsibility, individually and collectively, in accordance with the AIM Rules for Companies (“AIM Rules”), for the information contained in this document. To the best of the knowledge and belief of the Directors and the Company (who have taken all reasonable care to ensure that such is the case), the information contained in this document is in accordance with the facts and does not omit anything likely to affect the import of such information. To the extent that information has been sourced from a third party, this information has been accurately reproduced and, as far as the Directors are aware and are able to ascertain from information published by that third party, no facts have been omitted which may render the reproduced information inaccurate or misleading. In connection with this document, no person is authorised to give any information or make any representation other than as set out in this document. This document, which comprises an admission document drawn up in accordance with the AIM Rules, has been issued in connection with the proposed admission of the issued and to be issued Ordinary Shares to trading on AIM, a market operated by the London Stock Exchange plc (“AIM”). This document does not contain an offer or constitute any part of an offer to the public within the meaning of sections 85 and 102B of FSMA or otherwise. This document is not an approved prospectus for the purposes of section 85 of FSMA and a copy of it has not been, and will not be, delivered to the Financial Conduct Authority (the “FCA”) in accordance with the Prospectus Rules or delivered to or approved by any other authority which could be a competent authority for the purposes of the Prospectus Directive. A copy of this document will be available, free of charge, during normal business hours on any weekday (except Saturdays, Sundays and public holidays), at the offices of Dentons UKMEA LLP, One Fleet Place, London EC4M 7WS for a period of one month from the date of Admission. Neither the delivery of this document nor any subscription made pursuant to this document will, under any circumstances, create any implication that there has been any change in the affairs of the Company since the date of this document or that the information in this document is correct at any time subsequent to its date. Application will be made to the London Stock Exchange for the issued and to be issued Ordinary Shares to be admitted to trading on AIM (“Admission”). It is expected that Admission will take place and that dealings in Ordinary Shares will commence on 6 January 2014. AIM is a market designed primarily for emerging or smaller companies to which a higher investment risk tends to be attached than to larger or more established companies. AIM securities are not admitted to the Official List of the United Kingdom Listing Authority (the “Official List”). A prospective investor should be aware of the risks of investing in such companies and should make the decision to invest only after careful consideration and, if appropriate, consultation with an independent financial adviser. In particular, it should be remembered that the price of securities and the income (if any) from them can go down as well as up. The AIM Rules are less demanding than those of the Official List. All subsequent written and oral forward-looking statements attributable to the Company, its directors or to persons acting on its behalf are expressly qualified in their entirety by the cautionary statements referred to above and contained elsewhere in this document. Each AIM company is required pursuant to the AIM Rules to have a nominated adviser. The nominated adviser is required to make a declaration to the London Stock Exchange on Admission in the form set out in Schedule Two to the AIM Rules for Nominated Advisers. It is emphasised that no application is being made for the Ordinary Shares to be admitted to the Official List or to any other recognised investment exchange. Further, neither the London Stock Exchange nor the FCA has examined or approved the contents of this document. RM2 INTERNATIONAL S.A. (Incorporated and operating under the laws of Luxembourg with company registration number B 132 740) PLACING OF 155,903,548 PLACING SHARES OF US$0.01 EACH AT 88P PER ORDINARY SHARE ADMISSION TO TRADING ON AIM NOMINATED ADVISER AND BROKER Share Capital immediately following the Placing and Admission Ordinary Shares of US$0.01 each, issued and fully paid Amount Number US$3,162,437.51 316,243,751 The Placing is conditional, inter alia, on Admission taking place on or before 6 January 2014 (or such later date as the Company and Cenkos Securities plc (“Cenkos”) may agree). The New Ordinary Shares will, on Admission, rank pari passu in all respects with the Existing Ordinary Shares including the right to receive all dividends or other distributions declared, paid or made after Admission. Cenkos is authorised and regulated in the United Kingdom by the FCA and is advising the Company and no one else in connection with the Placing and Admission (whether or not a recipient of this document), and is acting exclusively for the Company as nominated adviser and broker for the purpose of the AIM Rules. Cenkos will not be responsible to any person other than the Company for providing the protections afforded to its customers, nor for providing advice in relation to the Placing and Admission or the contents of this document. In particular, the information contained in this document has been prepared solely for the purposes of the Placing and Admission and is not intended to inform or be relied upon by any subsequent purchasers of Ordinary Shares (whether on or off exchange) and accordingly no duty of care is accepted in relation to them. Without limiting the statutory rights of any person to whom this document is issued, no representation or warranty, express or implied, is made by Cenkos as to the contents of this document. No liability whatsoever is accepted by Cenkos for the accuracy of any information or opinions contained in this document, for which the Company and the Directors are solely responsible, or for the omission of any information from this document. No legal, business, tax or other advice is provided in this document. Prospective investors should consult their professional advisers as needed on the potential consequences of subscribing for, purchasing, holding or selling Ordinary Shares under the laws of their country and/or state of citizenship, domicile or residence. This document does not constitute an offer to sell, or a solicitation of an offer to buy, Placing Shares in any jurisdiction in which such offer or solicitation is unlawful. In particular, this document is not for distribution in or into the United States, Canada, the Republic of South Africa, the Republic of Ireland or Japan except that the document may be provided in certain limited circumstances to persons in the United States in connection with a placing of Placing Shares in private placements exempt from the registration requirements of the US Securities Act of 1933, as amended (“Securities Act”). The Placing Shares have not been and will not be registered under the Securities Act, any state securities laws in the United States or any securities laws of Canada, the Republic of South Africa, the Republic of Ireland or Japan or in any country , territory or possession where to offer them without doing so may contravene local securities laws or regulations. Accordingly, the Placing Shares may not, subject to certain limited exceptions, be offered or sold, directly or indirectly, in the United States, Canada, the Republic of South Africa, the Republic of Ireland or Japan or to, or for the account limited or benefit of, any person in, or any national, citizen or resident of the United States, Canada, the Republic of South Africa, the Republic of Ireland or Japan. The distribution of this document outside the United Kingdom may be restricted by law and therefore persons outside the United Kingdom into whose possession this document comes should inform themselves about and observe any restrictions as to the Placing, the Placing Shares or the distribution of this document. Notice to prospective investors in the European Economic Area In the United Kingdom this document is being distributed to, and is directed only at qualified investors (as defined in the Prospectus Directive) who are (i) persons having professional experience in matters relating to investments who fall within the definition of “investment professionals” in Article 19(5) of the Financial Services and Markets Act 2000 (Financial Promotion) Order 2005, as amended (the “Order”), or (ii) high net worth bodies corporate, unincorporated associations and partnerships and trustees of high value trusts as descried in Article 49(2) of the Order and persons within the United Kingdom who receive this document (other than persons falling within (i) and (ii) above) should not rely on or act upon this document. In relation to each member state of the European Economic Area which has implemented the Prospectus Directive (each, a “Relevant Member State”), no Ordinary Shares have been offered or will be offered pursuant to the Placing to the public in that Relevant Member State prior to the publication of a prospectus in relation to the Ordinary Shares which has been approved by the competent authority in that Relevant Member State, or, where appropriate, approved in another Relevant Member State and notified to the competent authority in that Relevant Member State, all in accordance with the Prospectus Directive, except that offers of Ordinary Shares to the public may be made at any time under the following exemptions under the Prospectus Directive, if they are implemented in that Relevant Member State: (a) to any legal entity which is a qualified investor as defined in the Prospectus Directive; (b) to fewer than 150, or, if the Relevant Member State has not implemented the relevant provision of the Prospectus Directive, 100 natural or legal persons (other than qualified investors as defined in the Prospectus Directive) in such Relevant Member State; or (c) in any other circumstances falling within Article 3(2) of the Prospectus Directive, provided that no such offer of Ordinary Shares shall result in a requirement for the publication of a prospectus pursuant to Article 3 of the Prospectus Directive or any measure implementing the Prospectus Directive in a Relevant Member State and each person who initially acquires any Ordinary Shares or to whom any offer is made under the Placing will be deemed to have represented, acknowledged and agreed that it is a “qualified investor” within the meaning of Article 2(1)(e) of the Prospectus Directive. For the purposes of this provision, the expression an “offer to the public” in relation to any offer of Ordinary Shares in any Relevant Member State means a communication in any form and by any means presenting sufficient information on the terms of the offer and any Ordinary Shares to be offered so as to enable an investor to decide to purchase or subscribe for the Ordinary Shares, as the same may be varied in that Relevant Member State by any measure implementing the Prospectus Directive in that Relevant Member State and the expression “Prospectus Directive” means Directive 2003/71/EC (as amended), to the extent implemented in the Relevant Member State and includes any relevant implementing measure in each Relevant Member State. FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS This document includes “forward-looking statements” which include all statements other than statements of historical facts, including, without limitation, those regarding the Company’s financial position, business strategy, plans and objectives of management for future operations, or any statements preceded by, followed by or that include the words “targets”, “believes”, “expects”, “aims”, “intends”, “will”, “may”, “anticipates”, “would, “could” or similar expressions or negatives thereof. Such forward-looking statements are subject to, inter alia, the risk factors described in Part III of this document, and involve known and unknown risks, uncertainties and other important factors beyond RM2’s control that could cause the actual results, performance or achievements of the Company to be materially different from future results, performance or achievements expressed or implied by such forward-looking statements. Such forward-looking statements are based on numerous assumptions regarding RM2’s present and future business strategies and the environment in which the Company will operate in the future. These forward-looking statements speak only as at the date of this document. The Company expressly disclaims any obligation or undertaking to disseminate any updates or revisions to any forward-looking statements contained herein to reflect any change in the Company’s expectations with regard thereto or any change in events, conditions or circumstances on which any such statements are based unless required to do so by applicable law or the AIM Rules for Companies. 2 Page CONTENTS DIRECTORS AND ADVISERS 4 PLACING STATISTICS 5 EXPECTED TIMETABLE OF PRINCIPAL EVENTS 5 PART I INFORMATION RELATING TO RM2 6 PART II OVERVIEW OF THE PALLET MARKET 29 PART III RISK FACTORS 38 PART IV TAXATION 46 PART V FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON RM2 49 SECTION A: ACCOUNTANT’S REPORT ON THE HISTORICAL FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON RM2 49 SECTION B: HISTORICAL CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON RM2 FOR THE THREE YEARS ENDED 31 DECEMBER 2012 51 SECTION C: INTERIM REVIEW REPORT ON RM2 95 SECTION D: UNAUDITED INTERIM INFORMATION ON RM2 FOR THE SIX MONTHS ENDED 30 JUNE 2013 97 PART VI FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON EQUIPMENT TRACKING 106 SECTION A: ACCOUNTANT’S REPORT ON THE HISTORICAL FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON EQUIPMENT TRACKING 106 SECTION B: HISTORICAL CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON EQUIPMENT TRACKING FOR THE THREE YEARS ENDED 31 DECEMBER 2012 108 SECTION C: INTERIM REVIEW REPORT ON EQUIPMENT TRACKING 123 UNAUDITED INTERIM INFORMATION ON EQUIPMENT TRACKING FOR THE 31 JULY 2013 125 SECTION D: NINE MONTHS ENDED PART VII ADDITIONAL INFORMATION 133 PART VIII DEFINITIONS 164 3 Page DIRECTORS AND ADVISERS DIRECTORS Ian Molson John Walsh Ashavani Mohindra Jan Dekker Charles Duro Sir Stuart Rose Amaury de Seze Paul Walsh Chairman Chief Executive Officer Chief Financial Officer Non-Executive Director Non-Executive Director Non-Executive Director Non-Executive Director Non-Executive Director all of: 5, rue de la Chapelle L-1325 Luxembourg Grand Duchy of Luxembourg REGISTERED OFFICE 5, rue de la Chapelle L-1325 Luxembourg Grand Duchy of Luxembourg NOMINATED ADVISER AND BROKER Cenkos Securities plc 6.7.8 Tokenhouse Yard London EC2R 7AS SOLICITORS TO THE COMPANY AS TO ENGLISH LAW Dentons UKMEA LLP One Fleet Place London EC4M 7WS SOLICITORS TO THE COMPANY AS TO LUXEMBOURG LAW Duro & Goebel 3, rue de la Chapelle L-1325 Luxembourg Grand Duchy of Luxembourg SOLICITORS TO THE NOMINATED ADVISER AND BROKER CMS Cameron McKenna LLP Mitre House 160 Aldersgate Street London EC1A 4DD REPORTING ACCOUNTANTS AND TAX ADVISERS Grant Thornton UK LLP 30 Finsbury Square London EC2P 2YU REGISTRARS Computershare Investor Services (Jersey) Limited Queensway House Hilgrove Street Jersey JE1 1ES DEPOSITARY Computershare Investor Services PLC The Pavilions Bridgwater Road Bristol BS13 8AE FINANCIAL PR Citigate Dewe Rogerson 3 London Wall Buildings London Wall London EC2M 5SY COMPANY TELEPHONE NUMBER/FAX NUMBER +352 27 44 96 53 COMPANY WEBSITE www.rm2.com 4 Page PLACING STATISTICS PLACING PRICE 88 pence NUMBER OF EXISTING ORDINARY SHARES IN ISSUE PRIOR TO THE PLACING 156,182,775 NUMBER OF PLACING SHARES BEING ISSUED PURSUANT TO THE PLACING 155,903,548 NUMBER OF DPE SHARES BEING ISSUED ON ADMISSION 4,157,428 NUMBER OF ORDINARY SHARES ON ADMISSION 316,243,751 PERCENTAGE OF THE ENLARGED ISSUED SHARE CAPITAL BEING PLACED 49.30 per cent. ESTIMATED GROSS PROCEEDS OF THE PLACING £137.2 million ESTIMATED NET PROCEEDS OF THE PLACING RECEIVABLE BY THE COMPANY £130.8 million MARKET CAPITALISATION IMMEDIATELY FOLLOWING COMPLETION OF THE PLACING AT THE PLACING PRICE DPE SHARES £278.3 million AND ISSUE OF THE AIM ‘ TICKER’ RM2.L SEDOL BGFB1F1 LU0994178464 ISIN NUMBER EXPECTED TIMETABLE OF PRINCIPAL EVENTS PUBLICATION OF ADMISSION DOCUMENT ADMISSION EFFECTIVE AND DEALINGS IN THE ORDINARY SHARES COMMENCES ON AIM CREST ACCOUNTS EXPECTED TO BE CREDITED 17 December 2013 8.00 a.m. on 6 January 2014 6 January 2014 References to time are to London time unless otherwise stated. Each of the dates in the above timetable is subject to change without further notice. 5 Page PART I INFORMATION RELATING TO RM2 1. INTRODUCTION TO RM2 RM2 specialises in pallet development, manufacture, supply and management and was founded in Luxembourg in 2007 to establish a disruptive presence in global pallet supply and improve the supply chain of manufacturing and distribution businesses through the effective and efficient use and management of composite pallets. RM2 has designed and manufactured the BLOCKPal, a multi-trip pallet made of a glass fibre and resin composite that is suitable for use in both automated and manual areas of the supply chain of sectors such as fast moving consumer goods, food ingredients, pharmaceuticals and packaging. The composite material and the associated manufacturing process, known as pultrusion, have together been shown to provide strength, durability and flexibility and the pultrusion manufacturing process is easily scalable with minimal risk. The BLOCKPal has been independently tested by leading institutions and has been shown to perform well in industry standard tests. Other benefits of the BLOCKPal are discussed at paragraph 3 below. RM2 intends to operate principally within the upstream logistics market, which is focused on the supply of raw materials and components to manufacturers, and to target the rental of its pallets and their utilisation within closed loop supply chains of its potential customers. RM2 believes that this avoids existing rental competition in the downstream portion of the logistics market, where customers generally require a higher quality pallet, leaving RM2 to compete with the lower quality, one-way or limited use pallets in the upstream market. RM2’s products have been developed in consultation with potential customers and RM2 intends to provide such customers, being typically large manufacturing, distribution and retail businesses, with an integrated solution to their pallet movement needs whilst interacting with other logistics partners, as necessary. RM2 is one of the few pallet businesses that provides a holistic solution, combining pallet manufacturing, standalone pallet management and financial options. In addition, the Company’s pallet tracking and management software, the TACS (Track Asset, Control Spend) system, which RM2 previously licenced from Equipment Tracking and acquired on 10 December 2013, offers potential customers services which can provide ‘real time’ equipment balances throughout their supply chains. These services can replace or strengthen existing tracking systems and are designed to enable potential customers to improve their pallet pool management. The TACS system was designed to provide potential customers with greater visibility over costs and, where possible, the ability to reduce the direct and indirect costs associated with goods movements between customers and suppliers. RM2 believes that the velocity of pallet movement, the number of trips a pallet makes in any period, is crucial to value creation and further that retention, its ability to effectively track and manage pallet movements, is key to preventing value destruction. RM2 believes that its competitive advantages, when compared to other pallet manufacturers and pallet rental companies, include: ‘superior product’ RM2’s ‘next generation’ products are, amongst other things, durable, strong, customisable, hygienic, non-toxic, fire resistant and consistent. ‘flexible design’ RM2’s manufacturing process allows for considerable flexibility in pallet design and enables it to meet varied customer requirements with minimal time-consuming and capital-intensive design and tooling considerations. This facilitates sales opportunities to the whole marketplace rather than the hitherto mainstream approach, where competition is at its highest and manufacturing margins at their lowest. ‘stable raw material pricing’ The compound used to produce the BLOCKPal reduces exposure to volatile oil and natural gas-linked pricing, giving a greater degree of product price certainty than plastic 6 Page alternatives. All raw materials and substances utilised by RM2 in the manufacture of the BLOCKPal are readily available from leading material providers across the globe. ‘market focus’ Through RM2’s pallet rental model, a product can be offered to potential customers which can enable savings and revenue opportunities through financial and operational efficiencies for its target upstream market. This allows RM2 to manage and track its assets within a closed loop and to initially align in a controlled and effective manner with fewer, high-quality counterparties who are the receivers of the products before expanding in a controlled manner. ‘tracking and management’ The TACS system can be customised to track any pool of hired equipment and to support several providers and allows extensive data capture through interfacing with existing customer software and systems. ‘expertise’ RM2’s Board draws on the experience of individuals who have, in the recent past, held senior executive positions within some of the world’s leading organisations, many of which are the receivers of palletised goods, and a number of its senior executives and key employees have a demonstrable track record in the key disciplines which are core to RM2’s business. The Company is staffed by professionals whose core competencies include materials science, engineering, pallet rental, logistics, sales, commodity trading and global finance. RM2 has invested significantly in market research and product R&D to establish a solid foundation for its proposed strategy. The Company is now ready to enter a phase of significant capital expenditure, asset investment and commercialisation of the business through which it intends to build a pool of rental pallets which, once deployed in the pallet pools of its potential rental customers, are expected to generate high quality, long-term, asset backed rental revenues. 2. GROUP STRUCTURE AND HISTORY A. GROUP STRUCTURE The Company was incorporated on 23 October 2007 under the laws of Luxembourg having its registered office at 5, rue de la Chapelle, L-1325 Luxembourg, Grand Duchy of Luxembourg. The Company is the principal holding company within the Group which currently comprises ten further legal entities established across eight countries, all of which are Subsidiaries of RM2. The Group is currently headquartered in Luxembourg with manufacturing and distribution facilities in Ontario, Canada, sales offices in Switzerland and the USA and an administration office in the UK. Further details of each of these Subsidiaries are provided in Part VII of this document, together with a Group structure chart. B. HISTORY & DEVELOPMENT The development of RM2 and the BLOCKPal is the result of several years of market research and product R&D focused on pallet technology, pallet products and market practices. This process has resulted in a deep understanding of the marketplace and the identification of a scalable business model to address what the Directors believe to be a substantial market opportunity. The BLOCKPal product has evolved through multiple manufacturing technologies before the current method of pultrusion was identified as providing solutions to many of the issues encountered with other techniques and processes. Pultrusion is a process that produces continuous lengths of composite materials with constant crosssections and is one of the fastest-growing manufacturing processes in the composites industry and is highly suited to the production of pallets. Pultrusion equipment was installed in the Company’s manufacturing facilities in 2011 and testing began on various designs of the BLOCKPal. Further information on the pultrusion process is outlined at paragraph 3.C below. On 27 September 2013, RM2 signed an agreement to acquire the entire issued share capital of Equipment Tracking for £2 million. Completion of the acquisition of Equipment Tracking occurred on 10 December 2013. Equipment Tracking was founded in 1995 (having traded as Adventures in Business Limited until the 7 Page incorporation of Equipment Tracking in 2004) and its pallet tracking and management software, which the Company previously licensed and (through the acquisition of Equipment Tracking) acquired on 10 December 2013, underpins the TACS system which assists customers to manage complex pallet flows. It has serviced some of the world’s largest suppliers of consumer goods. 3. RM2 PRODUCTS AND SERVICES A. THE BLOCKPAL RM2 has designed and manufactured the BLOCKPal, a multi-trip pallet made of a glass fibre and resin composite that is suitable for use in both automated and manual areas of the supply chain of sectors such as fast moving consumer goods, food ingredients, pharmaceuticals and packaging. The BLOCKPal label covers all pallets produced by RM2, regardless of size or dimension. Figure 1: BLOCKPal Source: Company The Company believes that, as a result of the extensive R&D programme, it has achieved the optimum balance of the five key design parameters – strength, stiffness, durability, functionality and cost – with the maximising of no single attribute acting to the detriment of the overall effectiveness of the product. Key to this success is the method of pultrusion manufacturing and the materials utilised in the construction of the BLOCKPal. The Directors believe, taking into account the preliminary results of simulated pallet use testing currently being carried out but not yet finalised, that the BLOCKPal can achieve in excess of 70 cycles of use before first failure. In many cases the BLOCKPal will be capable of repair, further increasing its life cycle and value proposition. In contrast, a 2010 survey of pallet users estimated that approximately 80 per cent. of pallets were used for ten cycles or fewer with only 15 per cent. being used for more than 20 cycles. The combination of the following key attributes ensures the broadest application of roles and usage across industry sectors and a compelling value proposition to potential customers: ‘durable’ The BLOCKPal has been independently tested to ISO 8611 and ASTM D 1185 standards. ‘specific strength’ The glass fibre utilised in the construction of the BLOCKPal is processed under tension and the resin employed is specifically selected to provide strength and impact-resistant qualities. Pultruded glass fibre reinforced plastic has a superior strength-to-weight-ratio than steel. ‘customisable’ A flexible assembly system allows RM2 to manufacture the BLOCKPal to bespoke dimensions largely from the same profiles to satisfy a customer’s specific requirements quickly and with minimal additional capital expenditure. ‘hygienic’ The BLOCKPal is easily cleaned with steam and has a natural resistance to moisture, bacteria and chemicals, meaning the pallet can be particularly effective in transporting goods where hygiene or contamination is a primary consideration. 8 Page B. ‘non-toxic’ The materials used in the BLOCKPal are compliant with the ‘Generally Recognised as Safe’ and/or Food-Additive List Specifications of the US Food and Drug Administration (“FDA”) for substances and materials. ‘fire resistant’ A BLOCKPal design tested has passed the Underwriters Laboratories 2335 fire test protocol for storage pallets without the use of expensive and occasionally controversial fire retardants that tend to affect material properties negatively. ‘consistent’ The pultrusion manufacturing process allows component ‘profiles’ to be produced to fine tolerances complemented by extensive use of automation in production and assembly which reduces human involvement and labour costs. ‘high-volume’ The pultrusion manufacturing process is continuous, subject to routine maintenance and is easily scalable with minimal risk. ‘stable pricing’ The compound used in the BLOCKPal has lower exposure to volatile oil and natural gaslinked pricing than plastic alternatives, giving potential customers a greater degree of product price certainty. ‘cost-effective’ The light weight of the BLOCKPal, when compared to wooden pallets of the same size, can lead to significant fuel savings, reducing the effective cost per trip. ‘sustainable’ The combination of the long life cycle, materials used and low weight will assist many of the potential customers to achieve their sustainability goals. ‘reduced theft risk’ The BLOCKPal can be repaired or, at the end of its useful life, pulverised and the compound used has little or no secondary value, thereby deterring theft and removal from the system. ‘RFID enabled’ Potential customers have the option to request installation of RFID tags, which can be used for tracking, temperature monitoring, global positioning system and/or ownership and can be located in the legs. The BLOCKPal would have to be broken to remove them. ‘superior handling’ The BLOCKPal is designed to have low profile runners and wide fork openings for easy handling with materials handling equipment. STRATEGY & REVENUE MODEL Since the Group’s establishment, RM2’s vision has been to become a ‘disruptive’ participant in the pallet manufacture and rental industry and to develop differentiated and value-creating products and services. The Company’s target market is the upstream logistics operations of large manufacturing, distribution and retail businesses. RM2’s operations will focus on both rental and sales of the BLOCKPal, as well as the management and tracking of RM2 and third party products for its potential customers through the TACS system. It is anticipated that a proactive management of these different opportunities will offer investors an attractive combination of high-quality, long-term asset backed rental revenues and more short-term, higher-margin revenue, allowing for significant but prudent growth from a stable platform. RM2 operates a structured four-stage process for the identification of, and engagement with, potential new customers as each opportunity moves from trial to full implementation. An often protracted sales cycle within large companies requires flexibility in RM2’s business model and RM2 intends to adapt to change and to allocate resources according to customer requirements. The Company’s objective is to increase Shareholder value through, firstly, establishing itself as a critical service provider to major companies across a diverse range of industry sectors in the US and Canada before replicating this strategy in Europe and, thereafter, the rest of the world. 9 Page i. PALLET RENTAL RM2’s primary strategy is to utilise its BLOCKPal system to turn a potentially unquantified cost in the supply chain into a significant, recurring increase in margin using simple, flexible and transparent pricing structures. RM2’s market research has indicated that some receivers of palleted goods (the “Receiver”) (typically large manufacturers and primary and secondary suppliers) regard the cost of “inbound” or “upstream” palletisation as being difficult to quantify and manage whilst others regard it as a general, embedded overhead. What is common is that it is often not controlled and, whilst generally recognised as inefficient by potential customers, the Company is not aware of a complete solution to this issue that is available in the market. The RM2 model is designed to reduce direct and indirect costs for both the Receiver and the supplier of the goods (the “Supplier”) without impacting the apportionment of costs and method of billing between these parties. In order to tailor its rental offering to its potential customers, RM2 will enter into discussions to understand each element of that Receiver’s supply chain. That process will allow RM2 to identify the direct cost of deliveries for that Receiver (such as the cost of the pallets, transport and fuel costs and labour costs associated with loading and unloading) and estimate ancillary or indirect costs (such as product damage and returns, inspection, repair and cleaning of pallets, downtime in automated systems handling inefficiencies and cleaning-up of nails, shards and splinters) as well as the number of pallets required to adequately populate the pallet pool to allow that aspect of the supply chain to operate effectively and with maximum efficiency. Consequently, RM2 is then able to identify potentially significant operational benefits for the Receiver and thereby set an appropriate and customer-specific cost ‘per trip’ of the pallet based on the anticipated number of trips per annum that each pallet will make. RM2 will seek to deploy its pallets where pallet velocity, and consequently recurring revenues, are highest. In addition to bringing a superior pallet product and mutually agreeable and visible pricing between Receivers and Suppliers, RM2 also expects to be able to deliver operational efficiencies and direct and/or indirect cost savings to the Receiver as well as assisting Receivers in achieving sustainability goals. For example, the BLOCKPal’s material make-up endows a strength-to-weight ratio superior to, and provides a weight saving when compared to, typical multi-trip wooden pallets. This translates to reduced fuel usage and associated emissions to transport the same quantity of goods, driving down the cost per unit. In addition, in most cases the Receiver will receive a participation payment from RM2 per pallet trip, providing an incentive to optimise the number of pallets within closed loops and encourage higher pallet velocity. The following figure illustrates the responses to a 2010 survey appearing in Modern Materials Handling, which asked respondents to identify the reason which best described their desire to use a pallet retrieval and recovery system. Figure 2: Drivers of pallet rental systems Source: Peerless Media Research Group 10 Page RM2’s strategy aims to identify and address issues experienced by both Receivers and Suppliers: ii. ‘Receiver issues’ Product damage and pallet debris ‘BLOCKPal solutions’ The BLOCKPal’s superior handling characteristics including impact resistance and rigidity (i) minimise the occurrence of product damage and incidence of product contamination; and (ii) avoid shards of wood, splinters and nails in warehouses and in sensitive areas of a facility where pallets may be used. Safety and handling limitations The BLOCKPal is suited for all mainstream handling equipment and automated handling systems due to its demonstrable racking strength, block construction (facilitating 4-way handling), and its consistent size and shape. Disposal Upon a request presented through the TACS system, RM2 will collect and remove its pallets free of charge by RM2’s local logistics partner thus avoiding any cost associated with broken limited-use wooden pallet removal or landfill taxes. Cost Any savings or efficiencies accruing from using the RM2 pallet will create a benefit manifested in lower operational cost for the parties involved. Where the Receiver collects the goods from the supplier, further savings can be made in fuel usage and emissions due to the pallets lighter weight compared to heavy duty whitewood pallets. ‘Supplier issues’ Capital intensive ‘BLOCKPal solutions’ RM2 will facilitate ‘just-in-time’ delivery of pallets ordered through the TACS system for which that Supplier has no responsibility or cost associated with maintaining a pallet stock of sufficient size to meet peak demand. Requires storage of pallet stock RM2’s service offering should free up warehousing space that might be better utilised by Suppliers. Damaged stock and stock returns The BLOCKPal’s superior handling characteristics, rigidity and impact resistance is designed to reduce the incidence of product damage and returns which are incurred at the Supplier’s expense. Retrieval and control of pallets is a non-core business RM2 provides a simple and easy to understand pallet ordering and billing mechanism through the TACS system, allowing the Supplier to concentrate on its core business. Cost In addition to the cost and cash-flow benefits above, including any applicable fuel cost savings, RM2 can reduce the overheads typically associated with the required maintenance, refurbishment or replacement of less durable pallets. PALLET SALES Whilst the Company’s primary strategy will require it to direct the majority of BLOCKPal production to the Company’s pallet rental scheme described in paragraph 3.B.i above, the balance of production will be targeted at the direct sale of BLOCKPal to potential customers in North America and, in the future, Europe and the rest of the world. This will allow RM2’s potential customers to benefit from the flexibility and economy of the Company’s manufacturing and assembly process which mitigates the financial commitment required to commission non-standard pallet designs using competing technology. 11 Page The Company will target potential customers likely to procure and populate their supply chains with RM2’s BLOCKPal and operate these in tightly controlled loops between internal divisions, whereby the pallets only transport goods from one location to another within a specified network. Companies that are more likely to purchase bespoke pallets are in sectors that use non-standard pallet sizes or configurations or who have individual components which are oversized compared to normal fast-moving consumer goods (and are consequently less suitable for pooling) such as the chemical, automotive, agricultural, technological, pharmaceutical, packaging and brewing industries. RM2 expects such products also to be of interest to inter-divisional pools within large organisations. To assist potential customers analyse the value for money that the BLOCKPal provides against their existing pallet system, whether purchased or rented, RM2 commissioned additional durability testing at the Center for Packaging and Unit Load Design at Virginia Polytechnic Institute. This allows a potential customer to reach a ‘per trip’ cost measurement which can be compared to their current cost of pallet ownership, repair and disposal and/or the cost of their rental programme(s). The benefits of owning such an asset are also dependent upon how individual companies perceive their ability to control the asset and their appetite to hold a long term asset on their balance sheet as against a consumable asset. Whilst no single dimensional standard governs pallet production, the ISO has sanctioned six pallet dimensions, detailed in ISO Standard 6780. The most commonly used pallet in North America is the US Grocery Manufacturers Association (“GMA”) pallet, which is 48 inches by 40 inches under ISO 6780, and accounted for 26.9 per cent. of all new pallets produced in the US in 2006. However, it was estimated that almost 50 per cent. of pallets sold in the US in 2006 were of configurations outside the normal pooling sizes and such pallets are designed to meet the requirements of a specific product, packaging type or service requirement. Accordingly, the Company believes that its ability to deliver to its potential customers non-standard, bespoke pallets represents a significant market opportunity. In addition, the Company believes that a significant competitive advantage is its ability to do so more quickly and efficiently than can be achieved by traditional moulding manufacturing processes. The nature of the RM2 manufacturing process means prices can be quickly and accurately forecast, leading to a more efficient process. Thereafter, RM2’s manufacturing and assembly processes allow it to re-programme machines to cut existing pultrusion shapes to the required size, adjust component profile configurations (if required) and plan the build programme into the factory schedule in a controlled and simple manner. All of this is achieved with design and tooling considerations that are neither capital-intensive nor time-consuming. iii. PALLET TRACKING & MANAGEMENT Through the TACS system, the integrated equipment management service, RM2 can assist potential customers with the management of complex pallet flows (including non-RM2 pallets) by providing a tailored solution that can integrate with, or replace, a customer’s existing tracking infrastructure and this will allow RM2 to focus on the closed loop operations with the highest velocity. This analysis of asset movements can identify potential cost reduction exercises through an understanding of the deployment of assets and associated costs. The software has been integrated with all relevant third-party systems which have been encountered and is able to track pools down to the individual asset movement, if required, by barcode or RFID. The TACS system can provide ‘real time’ equipment balances throughout a customer’s supply chain and was designed to be the central operations software for equipment suppliers, providing a single integrated system for tracking, delivering, collecting, and invoicing for an equipment pool. Its inherent flexibility allows it to support multiple supply scenarios without any modification to the underlying code and is capable of being used by multiple users and over a network of sites, providing authorised users with global visibility. The TACS system can also be optimised for potential customers running hired pools of equipment over their own network of factories and warehousing sites or logistic operators storing and delivering equipment for a number of different clients. It also allows potential customers to manage balances, 12 Page declarations of equipment use to suppliers and invoice reconciliation, thereby removing the need to use a different supplier portal for each pallet type. The TACS system can reduce administrative time as flexible data entry options give companies the opportunity to capture the majority of dispatch and receipt data with minimal manual intervention. The software is able to interface with all relevant production, warehouse management or planning systems that can produce a flat file and can accept full or partial data, and multiple interface files can each deliver data that relates to each movement part. It is a dedicated multi user, networked database system, focused on managing equipment from all current suppliers. In the year to 22 August 2013, the TACS system, as currently supplied to its customers by Equipment Tracking, has tracked a total of 200 million individual equipment movements (including 15 million pallet movements) and the system currently has responsibility for managing 800,000 pallets. No key customer contracts have been lost by Equipment Tracking in the period covered by the financial information set out in Part VI, evidencing a high level of customer satisfaction with the system, including asset retention. C. PRODUCTION & MATERIALS Materials RM2 has developed a composite material for use in the BLOCKPal which consists of approximately 80 per cent. glass fibre to 20 per cent. liquid resin. The composite has a low-volatility raw material input price when compared with those made from predominantly hydrocarbon derivative products utilised by some other plastic pallet manufacturers. All raw materials and substances utilised by RM2 in the manufacture of the BLOCKPal are readily available from leading international material providers. Glass fibre provides longitudinal strength and is then ‘wrapped’ in matting which provides strength in the transverse direction. The reinforcement materials are in continuous form and are saturated within a resin mixture in a resin bath and pulled through a die. The gelation, or hardening, of the resin is initiated by the heat in the die and a rigid, cured profile is formed that corresponds to the particular shape of the die. The resin has been chosen over alternatives primarily to achieve superior product performance and a longer productive lifecycle. This resin allows higher loadings of glass fibre reinforcement, augmenting its inherent superior strength (tensile, compressive, shear and bending). Other positive attributes include water resistance, chemical and acid resistance, impact resistance, abrasion resistance and fire resistance. The resin, together with the choice of the other materials, mean BLOCKPal is compliant with the GRAS and/or Food-Additive List Specifications of the FDA for substances and materials. The typical BLOCKPal consists of up to 58 pieces of pultruded profiles along with fasteners and adhesives and is produced and assembled in three phases – pultrusion of the composite material, followed by cutting and shaping and, finally, automated assembly of the pallet. Pultrusion Pultrusion is a manufacturing process for producing continuous lengths of composite materials with constant cross-sections. It is one of the fastest-growing manufacturing processes in the composites industry. The process is based on fibres that are impregnated with a thermosetting resin and pulled using a continuous pulling device (rather than pushed, as is the case in extrusion) through a heated die where curing takes place. Different laminate lay-ups are possible with reinforcements of, for example, fibreglass mats. The finished profiles are cut to length by a saw at the end of the line and the lengths of the profile can be altered to customer specifications without the requirement for significant additional capital expenditure. Pultrusion allows component profiles to be produced to fine tolerances and lends itself to a high degree of automation with low associated labour costs. The manufacturing process is continuous, subject to routine maintenance, thereby reducing downtime to a minimum. 13 Page While pultrusion machine design varies, the basic pultrusion process concept is described in the schematic shown below. Figure 3: Pultrusion Process Source: Company Automated Assembly The automated assembly system designed for RM2 is configured around a set of assembly fixtures which travel along parallel hydraulic transfer systems with lateral transfers at each end (see figure 4 below). Locating mechanisms are positioned at each station to position accurately the assembly fixtures for each function. The system design specifically allows for the future mechanism of some functions currently carried out manually and for the introduction of a separate set of assembly fixtures for different sizes of BLOCKPal product. The fixtures are designed to maintain all of the individual components in an accurate assembly position while they are being moved from station to station. The fixtures allow the pallet to be clamped for setting the glue and inverted for screw driving on the bottom surface of the assembly. The main control houses a human machine interface that allows the operator to start the total system, and also houses all alarms and operating information. Individual stations have their own control junction boxes and specific controls as required to allow the station to function as an independent machine. 14 Page Figure 4: Automated Assembly Process Source: Company D. MANUFACTURING FACILITIES RM2’s manufacturing operation is located in a 15 acre site in Ontario, Canada. The Company leases approximately 135,000 square feet of manufacturing and warehouse space which has air conditioning and over 8,000 Amps of available power. The existing pultrusion production area is just over 50,000 square feet and houses all manufacturing, raw material storage and blending areas. The facility is close to existing rail infrastructure and has eight truck level doors and two drive-in doors for receipt of materials and equipment and shipment of parts and finished products. The facility currently has ten pultrusion machines in place, six of which are ‘narrow-bed’ and four of which are ‘wide-bed’ or double capacity, and operational capacity of over 40 million feet of pultruded profiles per annum, assuming a continuous operation, equivalent to an estimated production capacity of approximately 588,000 pallets per annum. Available space exists for a further ten ‘wide bed’ pultruders giving additional operational capacity of over 100 million feet of pultruded profiles per annum, again assuming a continuous operation. The pre-assembly and assembly areas measure approximately 55,000 square feet and are located adjacent to the pultrusion manufacturing area. The pre-assembly area includes all equipment used to convert the pultruded profiles to parts of exact dimension and geometric orientations to produce the BLOCKPal, including water jet cutting and shaping systems, milling machines, and CNC machining centres. The Company currently has one automated assembly line in operation with an estimated production capacity of approximately 450,000 pallets per annum, assuming a continuous operation. It is the Company’s intention to expand the operational capacity of the Ontario facility before opening further manufacturing and/or assembly facilities (as appropriate) in other locations. 15 Page E. TESTING & REGULATION i. TESTS The BLOCKPal has been assessed by independent laboratories, including the Center for Packaging and Unit Load Design at Virginia Polytechnic Institute, the world’s leading authority responsible for various research activities to develop and progress the design of packaging, pallet and unit load design. It was assessed according to the following US and international standards: – ISO 8611 is an international standard for methods of testing new flat pallets for material handling; and – ASTM D1185 is an alternative standard for methods of testing pallets. In addition, RM2 has internal testing facilities to assist product development and refinement. Pallet tests under both regimes are broadly divided into two categories: ‘strength and stiffness’ ‘durability and functionality’ Static compression and bending tests provide Dynamic tests utilise accelerated ‘rough handling’ data that are used to estimate stiffness, strength, and devices employed in material handling and and safe working loads for pallets under specified shipping environments to determine the average load and support conditions. life of a pallet. Typical supports include warehouse floor stacking, racking across length, racking across width, and conveyor chain. The load is applied using a uniform, flexible airbag as a general purpose load. Specific loads can also be used during testing. These tests provide data which are used to estimate the physical durability and functionality of a pallet, for example, using an incline impact tester to impact the end board or stringer/post. These estimates provide a basis for designing single or multiple use pallets. These estimates provide a basis for designing pallets and comparing the performance between pallets of different designs and constructions. Specifically, the following tests have been undertaken and results observed, with the noted safe load referring to the highest applicable threshold implied by ISO 8611 and ASTM D1185. ‘bending test – fork time support’ This test replicates the loads and stresses on a pallet using fork tine support conditions. The top deck of the pallets is loaded across their weakest orientation for 30 minutes with calculated creep test load. The deflection is measured at specified locations of the pallet initially and after 30 minutes of applying the creep load. The creep load is removed after 30 minutes and the deflection of the pallet is measured after another 30 minutes of relaxation time to determine permanent deformation. Additionally, the pallets are loaded to maximum stresses and the failure load and deflection are recorded. Whilst the safe load for the BLOCKPal was found to be 10,000 lbs., this test also demonstrated that the BLOCKPal has a maximum load, when tested to failure, in excess of 20,000 lbs. ‘bending test – rack support’ This test replicates the loads and stresses on a pallet when it is supported at either end while the remainder of the pallet is suspended between the end supports. The top deck of the pallets is loaded across their weakest orientation for 24 hours with calculated creep test load. The deflection is measured at specified locations of the pallet initially and after 24 hours of applying the creep load. The creep load is removed after 24 hours and the deflection of the pallet is measured after two hours of relaxation time to determine permanent 16 Page deformation. Additionally, the pallets are loaded to maximum stresses and the failure load and deflection are recorded. Whilst the safe load for the BLOCKPal was found to be 3,400 lbs. and the generally accepted industry standard for a pooled general purpose pallet is 2,800 lbs., this test also demonstrated that the BLOCKPal has a maximum load, when tested to failure, of 7,485 lbs. ‘bending test – bottom deck’ This test replicates the loads and stresses on a pallet using floor stacking support conditions where all blocks of the pallet are supported. The bottom deck of the pallets is loaded across their weakest orientation for 24 hours with calculated creep test load. The deflection is measured at specified locations of the pallet initially and after 24 hours of applying the creep load. The creep load is removed after 24 hours and the deflection of the pallet is measured after two hours of relaxation time to determine permanent deformation. Additionally, the pallets are loaded to maximum stresses and the failure load and deflection are recorded. Whilst the safe load for the BLOCKPal was found to be 5,600 lbs., this test also demonstrated that the BLOCKPal has an average maximum load, when tested to failure, of 11,607 lbs. ‘bending test – top deck’ This test replicates the loads and stresses on a pallet using floor stacking support conditions where all blocks of the pallet are supported. The top deck of the pallets is loaded across their weakest orientation for 24 hours with calculated creep test load. The deflection is measured at specified locations of the pallet initially and after 24 hours of applying the creep load. The creep load is removed after 24 hours and the deflection of the pallet is measured after two hours of relaxation time to determine permanent deformation. Additionally, the pallets are loaded to maximum stresses and the failure load and deflection are recorded. Whilst the safe load for the BLOCKPal was found to be 12,000 lbs., this test also demonstrated that the BLOCKPal has an average maximum load, when tested to failure, of 22,516 lbs. ‘incline impact test’ This test utilises an incline table which evaluates the stability of full unit loads and durability of pallets and packaging designs. The BLOCKPal did not fail within the range of the testing equipment. ‘coefficient of friction’ This test measures three separate measurements: Top Deck on Corrugated Board The top deck of the pallet is placed on top of a corrugated board and a horizontal force is applied until the pallet moves. The maximum force that causes this motion is recorded and the coefficient of friction is calculated. Pallet on Pallet Two pallets are placed on the floor and another pallet was placed on top of them. A horizontal force is applied to the top pallet until it moves. The maximum force that causes this motion is recorded and the coefficient of friction is calculated. 17 Page Bottom of Top Deck on Fork Tines The bottom of the top deck is supported by fork tines and a horizontal force is applied until the pallet moves. The maximum force that causes this motion is recorded and the Coefficient of Friction is calculated. The measured coefficient of friction of the BLOCKPal design exceeds the minimum American National Standards Institute MHI 2005 standard of 0.15. TESTS Top deck on corrugated board Pallet on pallet Bottom on top deck of fork tines ‘free fall drop test’ RESULT 0.36 0.22 0.24 This test is conducted in two stages: – in the first stage, the pallet is dropped on one corner ten times (or until failure) from a height of 40 inches. – in the second stage, the pallet is dropped on one corner a further ten times from a height of 80 inches. The BLOCKPal was not damaged after stage one and two-thirds of those tested were not damaged after completion of stage two, with the remaining third failing after eight drops in the second stage. 4. THE COMPETITIVE LANDSCAPE A. COMPETING COMPANIES The pallet production market is highly fragmented with no one manufacturer accounting for more than 3.2 per cent. of total industry revenues in the US in 2012. In the pallet rental market, the number of industry participants was estimated to increase at an annualised rate of 0.6 per cent. in the five years to 2012, to approximately 2,869 establishments. Despite this overall gain, some consolidation has been occurring and the top four companies account for an estimated 56 per cent. of market share in the US in 2012. None of these companies’ strategy is specifically aimed at the upstream component of the supply chain, rather addressing their resources largely to downstream distribution (finished products). This is due to a number of factors such as the risk of co-mingling between pools, pallets moving downstream with the flow of goods, generally smaller counterparties and pools and a different approach to losses. Losses are generally accepted as inevitable in the upstream chain and so the pallets used are often cheap and disposable. RM2’s product and systems are offering an alternative to this approach. 18 Page Figure 5: US Market Share Source: “Pallet and Skid rental in the US – 2012” IBISWorld As outlined in figure 5 above, RM2’s principal competitors in the pallet rental industry are: ‘Brambles’ Brambles Limited (“Brambles”) is a pooling solutions company specialising in the provision of reusable pallets, crates and containers and associated logistics services. Headquartered in Sydney, Australia, Brambles operates across multiple industry supply chains in more than 50 countries. Brambles operates pooling solutions operations under two core brands: ‘PECO’ – CHEP is a pooling solutions business specialising in the provision of reusable pallets, crates, containers and associated logistics services. CHEP owns and manages approximately 300 million pallets, crates and containers in more than 50 countries; and – IFCO operates a pool of more than 150 million reusable plastic crates worldwide and, in the USA, sorts, repairs and reissues about 200 million pallets a year through its pallet management network. PECO Pallet, Inc. (“PECO”) is a private provider of pallet rental services headquartered in Yonkers, NY. PECO maintains service centres and manufacturing plants throughout the United States, Canada and Mexico and its redwood block pallets are used by manufacturers to ship grocery and consumer goods products to retailers throughout North America. In March 2011, private investment firm The Pritzker Group acquired PECO. ‘iGPS’ Intelligent Global Pooling Systems Company, LLC (“iGPS”) is a private provider of pallet rental services founded in 2006 and headquartered in Orlando, Florida and with a National Sales and Innovation Center in Bentonville, Arkansas. In June 2013, iGPS filed for bankruptcy and agreed to sell its assets to a newly-formed joint venture company, iGPS Logistics LLC, a joint venture formed by private equity firms Balmoral Funds LLC and One Equity Partners, a shareholder of pallet manufacturer Schoeller Arca Systems, and Jeff and Robert Liebesman. 19 Page The Company believes that the current and future market opportunity is more than sufficient to support RM2’s forecast growth and, further, that for the reasons set out in paragraph 3.A. above, the RM2 proposition has a number of significant advantages over those of its competitors. B. BARRIERS TO ENTRY Barriers to entering the industry vary depending on the scale and scope of an aspiring player’s operations. On one hand, the industry has relatively low barriers to entry if an operator is trying to compete on a local level or specialise within one product segment. The market is moderately fragmented with little concentration of ownership, and firms are not required to have any licences or certifications to operate. On the other hand, firms wishing to compete on a national or international level will have to compete directly with the industry’s largest players. Although technological change occurs at a medium pace, barriers to entry into the global market become increasingly difficult as logistics and tracking become increasingly complicated. Competing effectively in this sector of the market requires a significant capital investment in order to: – acquire production and manufacturing equipment; – sustain the purchasing power necessary to maintain and operate a pool of pallets; – manufacture in sufficient volume to effectively disrupt the market; and – fund R&D at the more advanced end of the market. Recognising the scalability of the marketplace and the opportunity it presented, RM2 has invested significantly over seven years in developing its products and refining its service offering and now intends to use the net proceeds of the Placing to move into a phase of significant capital expenditure and asset investment and commercialisation of the business, thereby establishing itself as a disruptive presence in the upstream logistics market. On Admission, the Company believes that there are the following key barriers to entry for the provision of similar services to those of RM2: ‘resources’ Any new entrant would require the financial resources necessary for a long development cycle required in order to obtain the relevant equipment and know-how by which time the Directors believe that RM2 will have achieved such a strong presence in the market in terms of units deployed and customer relationships that any competitor will be at a significant disadvantage. Specifically, the Company believes that, once installed within the supply chain of its customers, the costs and complexity of sorting pallets from a second source and overlaying a second tracking system are expected to be a significant disincentive to that customer using other equipment. The larger pallet pooling and logistics companies have significant capital committed to their existing business models, both with regard to product type and focus, which are both different to those of RM2. ‘know-how’ RM2 has developed technical and commercial know-how through its continued R&D and extensive market research has led to a deep understanding of the marketplace and the regulatory environment. In addition, through the acquisition of Equipment Tracking (completion of which occurred on 10 December 2013), RM2 now owns the logistics and tracking software which it previously licensed from Equipment Tracking, which will put it ahead of any new entrants to the market who would require both the technical capability and know-how to develop and market a commercial and effective product. Utilising Equipment Tracking’s services will, based on its performance prior to acquisition, ensure a high level of asset retention. 20 Page Having invested a significant amount of time in understanding the market place, RM2 has a deep understanding of the market’s demands and how these can be met through a combination of material science, product design and services. ‘customer relationships’ 5. RM2 has spent considerable time and effort developing senior level relationships with key players in the relevant industries, giving it the opportunity and credibility to guide potential customers to make significant and critical decisions and commitments regarding RM2’s product offering. REASONS FOR ADMISSION AND USE OF PROCEEDS The Directors believe that Admission is an important step in RM2’s development and expect that it will provide a platform for the Company as it moves into a phase of significant capital expenditure and asset investment and commercialisation of the business. Admission will also provide the Company with a more diversified shareholder base and will help the Group attract, retain and incentivise Directors and key employees through its equity incentive schemes. In addition, Admission is also expected to provide the Group with access to further capital in the future, should the Directors identify appropriate opportunities for acquisitions or seek to accelerate the further development of the business in response to market demand for its products and services. The Placing of the Placing Shares will raise up to approximately £130.8 million (equivalent to approximately US$214.5 million) net of expenses, for the Company, which will principally be used to further expand the Company’s pallet production capacity and fund the production of BLOCKPal for use in both the pallet rental market as well as direct sales. The Directors believe that RM2’s business model will facilitate successful market penetration as it offers customers the opportunity to take advantage of the Company’s proposition without having to make significant capital expenditure decisions or fully understand and take responsibility for the assets and their use. In order to finance the development of its products and services, RM2 entered into a number of short-term funding arrangements. Further information on these arrangements is detailed in paragraph 12 of Part VII of this document. Accordingly, in addition, the Company will use the net proceeds of the Placing to repay these funding arrangements and to retire the DPE Warrants, leaving the Company debt free (other than in respect of a mortgage granted over the Group’s property in Switzerland) immediately following Admission and with no options or warrants outstanding other than options granted to key employees under the 2013 Plan. The Directors intend that the balance of the net proceeds of the Placing will be used for the Company’s general working capital requirements. USE Expand pallet production capacity, production of BLOCKPals and working capital requirement Repayment of short term loans and retirement of DPE Warrants Expenses and commissions associated with the Placing US$ MILLION* 143 71.5 10.5 * Assumes an exchange rate of £1: US$1.64. 6. DIRECTORS, SENIOR MANAGERS AND EMPLOYEES A. THE BOARD On Admission, the Board of the Company shall comprise two executive Directors and six Non-Executive Directors whose biographical details are as follows: R. Ian Molson, aged 58 – Non-Executive Chairman R. Ian Molson was born and grew up in Montreal, Canada and is currently a director of a number of private equity, investment and other companies including Alphatec Spine Inc., Cayzer Continuation PCC Ltd, Central European Petroleum Ltd (Deputy Chairman) and Healthpoint Capital LLC. Mr Molson also serves as Chairman of The Royal Marsden NHS Foundation Trust and The Royal Marsden Hospital Charity. From 1999 to 2004, he was deputy chairman of the board and Chairman of the Executive Committee of Molson Inc, a Canadian public corporation founded in 1786. Between 1977 and 1997, he was employed by Credit Suisse First Boston, one of the leading investment banking and securities firms in the world. From 1993 to 1997, he 21 Page served as co-Head of their Investment Banking Department in Europe, a position which encompassed all corporate finance, corporate advisory, mergers and acquisitions businesses in Europe, Russia, Africa and the Middle East. He graduated from Harvard University (BA Honours) in 1977. John Walsh, aged 50 – Chief Executive Officer John Walsh has been Chief Executive Officer since its inception. Mr Walsh has been instrumental in the development of the Group. Mr Walsh has held leadership positions in the finance industry in New York and London. Mr Walsh began his career at Bank of America and then joined Prudential Bache. From 1988 to 2003 Mr Walsh was at Credit Suisse, where he became a Managing Director. Mr Walsh was Head of Syndication and Head of Capital Markets in London and spent ten years as Head of Global Capital Markets. Mr Walsh was a member of the firm’s Fixed Income and Investment Management Committee and the Global Management Committee. In 2004, Mr Walsh joined RBS Greenwich Capital Markets where he was Head of North American Credit Markets. Immediately prior to leaving the finance industry to focus on RM2, Mr Walsh was recognised as the third most influential European in US Financial Markets by Financial News (November 2005) and the seventh most important British Businessman in the US by the Sunday Times (December 2005). Ashavani Mohindra, aged 54 – Chief Financial Officer Ashavani Mohindra has been CFO of the Group since its inception. Mr Mohindra has considerable commercial experience gained at both large and small companies, ranging from ABN Amro, the then financial regulator SFA (forerunner of the FCA), through to Touche Ross & Co. He has had a number of roles ranging from management accounts, audits, legal and compliance, computer systems implementation, regulatory and general financial reporting, and general management through representation at board level as an executive director. Mr Mohindra graduated in 1980 from Manchester University with a Mathematics degree, and qualified as a chartered accountant in 1983. Sir Stuart Rose, aged 64 – Non-Executive Director Sir Stuart Rose has been the Chief Executive of a number of substantial retail businesses including Burton Group plc, Argos plc, Booker plc and Arcadia Group plc. He was Chief Executive and also, latterly, Chairman of Marks & Spencer plc from 2004 to 2010. Sir Stuart is currently a non-executive director of Land Securities Group and Woolworths Holdings Limited. He is Chairman of Ocado Group plc and Fat Face Group Ltd as well as a number of other companies. Paul Walsh, aged 58 – Non-Executive Director Paul Walsh was Chief Executive of Diageo plc from 2000 to 2013 and is now an adviser to the Chairman and Chief Executive of Diageo. Mr Walsh joined GrandMet’s brewing division in 1982 and became its Finance Director in 1986. He held financial and commercial positions with Inter-Continental Hotels and in the GrandMet food business, becoming CEO of The Pillsbury Company in 1992. Mr Walsh was appointed to the GrandMet Board in October 1995 and to the Diageo Board in December 1997. Mr Walsh is a non-executive director of FedEx Corporation, Unilever plc, and Avanti Communications plc and was previously a non-executive director of Centrica plc, stepping down in May 2009. He has also been appointed Business Ambassador for the food and drink industries by the UK Department for Business, Innovation and Skills and is a Council Member, and former Chairman, of the Scotch Whisky Association. In June 2013 it was announced that Mr Walsh will join the board of Compass Group PLC in January 2014 as a non-executive director and will assume the position of its chairman in February 2014. Charles Duro, aged 55 – Non-Executive Director Charles Duro is the founding partner of Duro-Goebel, a Luxembourg law firm started in 1995, after having been a partner in another law firm in Luxembourg. He practises mainly in company law and has been on the board of a number of Luxembourg companies active in various sectors. Mr Duro is a former chairman of the tax commission of the “Association Internationale des Jeunes Avocats”. Jan Dekker, aged 65 – Non-Executive Director Jan Dekker worked for Philips Corporation from 1973 to 1981. He then joined KPMG Meijburg & Co where he became Senior Partner in the International Tax Practice. Mr Dekker is a director of a number of private 22 Page companies and became chairman of RM2 in 2009, moving to a non-executive role shortly before Admission. He attended the Universities of Leyden, Rotterdam and Tilburg, studying civil and economic and international tax law, gaining several masters degrees. Amaury de Seze, aged 67 – Non-Executive Director Amaury de Seze started his career in 1968 at Bull General Electric. In 1978, he joined Volvo Group, one of the world’s largest producers of trucks, buses and construction equipment where he successively held positions of deputy chief executive officer of Volvo France, chairman and chief executive officer of Volvo France, chairman and chief executive officer of Volvo Europe, member of the group executive committee of AB Volvo and member of the strategic committee of Renault Volvo. He joined the Paribas group in 1993 as a member of the management boards of Compagnie Financière de Paribas and Banque Paribas. Mr de Seze is founding partner, chairman and chief executive officer of the private equity firm PAI Partners. He is currently vice chairman of Power Financial Corporation of Canada and is a member of the board of directors of Carrefour, Groupe Bruxelles Lambert, Imerys, Publicis, and Suez Environment. B. SENIOR MANAGERS AND OPERATIONAL TEAM The biographical details of the Senior Managers of RM2 are set out below: Philip Seligmann – Chairman RM2 North America Philip Seligmann has been with RM2 since its inception. Mr Seligmann has a wealth of sales experience and has been instrumental in developing dedicated sales groups to penetrate US markets. Prior to joining the Group, Mr Seligmann was a Managing Partner of a US based trade and investment banking boutique, prior to which he was head of Commodity Trade Finance for Merrill Lynch and Company in New York. Mr Seligmann also ran his family’s metal trading and brokerage business. Mr Seligmann has spent his whole career in sales and marketing. Mr Seligmann is a graduate of Syracuse University’s Maxwell School of Citizenship and Public Affairs with advanced degrees in International Relations and Political Economics. Matthew Gilfillan – Head of North American Sales and Marketing Matthew Gilfillan has been with RM2 since its inception. Mr Gilfillan has been responsible for developing third party relationships to execute RM2’s strategy in the US, and has negotiated joint venture agreements with third party logistics providers and pallet technology providers necessary to achieve RM2’s strategic goals. Prior to joining RM2 Mr Gilfillan was a senior salesman at ABN Amro, Lehman Brothers and Bear Stearns. Mr Gilfillan covered some of the largest institutions in the US and served on many committees to devise global sales and marketing strategies concentrating on the largest US logistics companies. Mr Gilfillan graduated in 1990 from Bucknell University with a Major in Economics and a Minor in International Politics. Christopher Gibbs – Head of EMEA Sales and Marketing Christopher Gibbs has a wealth of experience in the materials handling equipment sector. Prior to joining RM2, Mr Gibbs worked for Sunrise Global Finance where he was the field based Major Accounts Director in its Materials Handling Division. Mr Gibbs was responsible for the Materials Handling Division for Asset Finance and secondary market use for returned assets, via manufacturer partners based in UK, North and South America, Australia and China. Mr Gibbs developed, in conjunction with selected partner companies, new market innovative products which can be utilised via asset lease programmes, generating primary and secondary market streams. Mr Gibbs has also held Senior National Account Managerial Positions with CHEP controlling the Pallet and Plastic Returnable Packaging Pool for Asda Wal*MART network in the UK. Ewa Groszek – Managing Director of Equipment Tracking Ewa Groszek started working with CHEP in 1990 in a wide range of areas including marketing and then account management. In 1995, Ms Groszek launched a consultancy service and then developed a dedicated network software system that would provide sophisticated returnable asset tracking data to pool users. Ms Groszek was the major shareholder in Equipment Tracking. Equipment Tracking, which has been working with RM2 for three years, was fully acquired by RM2 on 10 December 2013. Tom Lane – Head of Manufacturing Tom Lane has been working in product development and manufacturing at RM2 since 2010. Immediately prior to this he was the Managing Partner and founder of Lane Properties II, before which he held senior, multi office, 23 Page management roles at Wachovia Securities, Prudential, Previsor Corp, Merrill Lynch and ICI. His areas of focus have included product development, consolidation of operations, and primary responsibility for execution of strategy. Mr Lane was a member of Prudential Services Executive Council and a director of the National Futures Association. His five year military service was served in the airborne infantry and as commander of a Special Forces operational detachment. Rick Needham – Head of Strategic Manufacturing Development Rick Needham has a background in engineering and holds a degree in Nuclear Engineering. He started his career at Bechtel Corporation providing technical administration of the nuclear steam supply system for a commercial nuclear power plant. More recently, he has held a number of senior management roles including President of Circle Seal Controls and President CEO of Haskel International and subsequently ProQual Industries. He has been responsible for contracts, sales and marketing, engineering, operations and acquisitions. His military service includes serving in the US Navy, achieving Nuclear and Submarine qualification status. Ruari McGirr – Strategic Development and Investor Relations Ruari McGirr qualified as a chartered accountant with KPMG and then moved into corporate finance, joining Dresdner Kleinwort Benson and Daniel Stewart where he focused on advising growth companies before investing in and becoming Chief Executive of broking firm, St Helens Capital. Mr McGirr joined WH Ireland in 2010 in the corporate broking group. Richard San Martin – North America Sales Richard San Martin began his career at Anheuser Busch where he spent 13 years, primarily in beer packaging and shipping, rising to Group Manager. He then moved to COTT where he ultimately became Senior Vice President for Operations and Marketing. Mr San Martin was Senior Vice President for Logistics and Operations at Intelligent Global Pooling Company LLC until July 2010 and ran his own supply chain and operations consulting and training business before joining RM2. Robert Blaikie – EMEA Sales Robert Blaikie joined the European Sales & Marketing team of RM2 in 2013. Mr Blaikie has extensive experience in pallets, logistics and industrial sales having been Sales and Marketing Director of Speedy Hire for Core Business and Industrials, Sales Director of ATS Euromaster Michelin and Sales Director of CHEP UK. C. EMPLOYEES RM2 is headquartered in Luxembourg. It has premises in Luxembourg, Switzerland, Canada, the US and the UK. As of 31 December 2012, RM2 had 51 employees, the increase in the last 12 months was primarily due to recruitment of additional employees in Canada. The breakdown of the number of employees and their respective activities over the previous three financial years (as at 31 December each year) is set out in the table below: LOCATION CANADA LUXEMBOURG SWITZERLAND USA UK HOLLAND/FRANCE TOTAL 2010 – 1 6 1 3 1 2011 – 1 6 3 4 1 2012 33 1 6 4 6 1 12 15 51 In addition, as at 31 December 2012, the Group employed ten additional agency staff at its factory in Canada. As at 30 June 2013, being the latest date for which full figures are available, the Group employed 77 staff and a further 17 agency staff. In addition, Equipment Tracking employs 22 staff. 24 Page D. SHARE OPTIONS AND RESTRICTED SHARES The Company believes that the success of RM2 will depend to a high degree on the future performance of its Directors and key employees. The Directors also recognise the importance of ensuring that employees are well motivated and identify closely with the success of the Group. The Directors regard equity participation to be an important aspect of the Group’s ability to attract, retain and incentivise its key staff. Pursuant to the 2013 Plan, the Company has granted options over a total of 1,917,000 Ordinary Shares to certain of the Group’s key employees. Further details of the grant of options to key employees pursuant to the 2013 Plan are provided in paragraph 6 of Part VII of this document. In addition, a total of 12,308,775 Restricted Shares have been granted to certain Directors. Further details of the Restricted Shares are set out in paragraph 6.2 of Part VII of this document. 7. THE PLACING AND ADMISSION Under the Placing, the Company is issuing 155,903,548 Placing Shares representing 49.30 per cent. of the Enlarged Issued Ordinary Share Capital of the Company following the Placing. At the Placing Price, the Placing of Placing Shares will raise approximately £130.8 million (net of expenses) for the Company. Cenkos has agreed, pursuant to the Placing Agreement and conditional inter alia on Admission, to use its reasonable endeavours to place the Placing Shares with institutional and other investors. The Placing, which is not being underwritten, is conditional, inter alia, upon: – the Placing Agreement becoming unconditional and not having been terminated in accordance with its terms prior to Admission; and – Admission becoming effective not later than 6 January 2014, or such later date as Cenkos and the Company may agree, being not later than 20 January 2014. The New Ordinary Shares rank pari passu in all respects with the Existing Ordinary Shares including the right to receive all dividends and other distributions declared, paid or made after the date of issue. None of the New Ordinary Shares has been marketed to or will be made available in whole or in part to the public in conjunction with the application for Admission. The market capitalisation of the Company immediately following the Placing, at the Placing Price, will be approximately £278.3 million. Application has been made to the London Stock Exchange for the Ordinary Shares, issued and to be issued, to be admitted to trading on AIM. Admission is expected to become effective and dealings in the Ordinary Shares are expected to commence on 6 January 2014. The existing aggregate shareholdings of the Shareholders prior to the Placing and the issue of the DPE Shares on Admission will be diluted to 49.39 per cent. of the Enlarged Issued Share Capital and 49.09 per cent. on a fully diluted basis (assuming that all the 2013 Options have fully vested). Further details of the Placing Agreement are set out in paragraph 12(i) of Part VII of this document. 8. LOCK-IN ARRANGEMENTS The Locked-In Shareholders have agreed with the Company and Cenkos to accept certain restrictions on the disposal of their interests in Ordinary Shares for a period of at least 12 months from the date of Admission, save in certain limited circumstances. Each Locked-In Shareholder has agreed with the Company and Cenkos: (a) not to dispose of any of their interests in Ordinary Shares for a period of at least 12 months from the date of Admission, save in those circumstances expressly permitted by the AIM Rules and the Lock-In Arrangements (as described in paragraph 12 (l) of Part VII); and 25 Page (b) not to dispose of any of their interests in Ordinary Shares for a period of 12 months from the first anniversary of the date of Admission, except with the consent of, and through, Cenkos (or the Company’s broker from time to time), so as to maintain an orderly market in the Ordinary Shares. The aggregate interests following Admission which shall be subject to the lock-in and orderly market arrangements as described above will amount to 53,079,366 Ordinary Shares, which is equivalent to approximately 16.78 per cent. of the Enlarged Issued Share Capital. Further details of the lock-in and orderly market arrangements described above are set out in paragraph 12 (l) of Part VII of this document. 9. CORPORATE GOVERNANCE The Company intends, following Admission, so far as is practicable and appropriate for a company of its size, stage of development, resources and nature, to comply with the provisions of the UK Corporate Governance Code, as modified by the recommendations of the Quoted Companies Alliance in the QCA Code. The Company has appointed six, independent, Non-Executive Directors (including the Chairman) to bring an independent view to the Board, and to provide a balance to the executive Directors. The Board is responsible for formulating, reviewing and approving RM2’s strategy, budgets and corporate actions. The Directors intend to hold meetings of the Board four times a year following Admission with additional meetings as and when required. RM2 has also established an Audit Committee and a Remuneration Committee with formally delegated duties and responsibilities. A. AUDIT COMMITTEE The Audit Committee will have the primary responsibility of monitoring the quality of internal controls and ensuring that the financial performance of RM2 is properly measured and reported on. It will receive and review reports from the executive management team (including reports from members of the executive management team not on the board) and external auditors relating to the interim and annual accounts and the accounting and internal control systems in use throughout RM2. The Audit Committee will meet not less than twice in each financial year and will have unrestricted access to RM2’s external auditors. At Admission, the Audit Committee shall consist of the following persons: B. NAME POSITION Jan Dekker Ian Molson Sir Stuart Rose Amaury de Seze Chairman Member Member Member REMUNERATION COMMITTEE The Remuneration Committee will review the performance of the executive Directors and make recommendations to the Board on matters relating to their remuneration and terms of service. The Remuneration Committee will also make recommendations to the Board on proposals for the granting of share options and other equity incentives pursuant to any employee equity incentive scheme in operation from time to time, having due regard to the interests of Shareholders. The Remuneration Committee will meet as and when necessary and at least once a year. In exercising this role, the Directors shall have regard to the recommendations put forward in the QCA Code and, where appropriate, the UK Corporate Governance Code. At Admission, the Remuneration Committee shall consist of the following persons: NAME POSITION Paul Walsh Ian Molson Sir Stuart Rose Amaury de Seze Chairman Member Member Member 26 Page C. SHARE DEALING CODE The Board intends to comply, and to procure compliance, with Rule 21 of the AIM Rules for Companies relating to dealings in the Company’s securities by the Directors and other applicable employees (as defined in the AIM Rules for Companies). To this end, the Company has adopted a code for directors’ and other applicable employees’ dealings appropriate for a company whose shares are admitted to trading on AIM and will take all reasonable steps to ensure compliance by the Directors and any applicable employees. D. NO TAKEOVER PROTECTIONS The Takeover Code is issued and administered by the Takeover Panel. The Takeover Code applies to takeovers and merger transactions, however effected, where the offeree company is, inter alia, a company whose registered office is in the UK, the Channel Islands or the Isle of Man and either (a) such company’s shares are admitted to trading on a “regulated market” (which term does not include AIM) or a “multilateral trading facility” (which term does include AIM), in either case in the UK; or (b) in the opinion of the Takeover Panel, such company’s place of central management and control is in the UK, the Channel Islands or the Isle of Man and only to private companies in certain prescribed circumstances. As the Company’s registered office is not in the UK, the Channel Islands or the Isle of Man, the Company does not fall within the jurisdiction of the Takeover Code and Shareholders are therefore not entitled to the protections afforded by the Takeover Code. As the Company is not admitted to trading on a “regulated market”, it is also not subject to any takeover laws in Luxembourg. E. THE BRIBERY ACT The Bribery Act 2010, which inter alia prescribes criminal offences for businesses engaged or allowing others to engage in bribery or corrupt practices came into force on 1 July 2011. Whilst the Bribery Act 2010 does not apply to RM2 itself, RM2 has UK subsidiaries and British employees to whom the Bribery Act 2010 does apply. As such the Directors intend to have regard to the impact of such legislation and, as a result, the Company adopted an anti-bribery policy on 19 November 2013. The Company intends to train its employees on the impact of the legislation. The anti-bribery policy contains procedures that allow for reporting and communication by the employees and to the Board of any matters which may or may not be relevant in ensuring that the daily operations are maintained in light of such legislation. 10. DIVIDEND POLICY The declaration of any payment by the Company of any future dividends in respect of the Ordinary Shares, and the amount of such dividend, will depend on the results of its operations, financial condition, cash requirements, future prospects, profits available for distribution and other factors deemed to be relevant at the time. The nature of RM2’s business and its proposed strategy mean that the Board does not intend to declare a dividend in the short to mediumterm but will reconsider this as and when the growth and profitability of the Company allows. 11. SETTLEMENT The Articles permit the Company to issue shares in uncertificated form and contain provisions concerning the transfer of shares which are consistent with the transfer of shares in uncertificated form under the CREST Regulations. CREST is a paperless settlement procedure enabling securities to be evidenced otherwise than by a certificate and transferred otherwise than by written instrument. CREST is unable to take responsibility for the electronic settlement of shares issued by companies incorporated in certain non-UK jurisdictions, including companies such as the Company, which are incorporated in Luxembourg. Securities in overseas companies cannot generally be held or settled electronically in the CREST system. To enable Shareholders to settle their securities in the Company through the CREST system, the Company has put in place a Depositary Interests facility operated by the Depositary. The Depositary Interests facility is created pursuant to a deed poll dated 29 November 2013 (the “Deed Poll”), under which the Depositary (or its nominee) will hold Ordinary Shares in book-entry form on trust for Shareholders and it will issue uncertificated Depositary Interests (on a one-for-one basis) representing those underlying Ordinary Shares and provide the necessary custodian services. The relevant Shareholders 27 Page will retain the beneficial interest in the Ordinary Shares held through the Depositary Interests facility and voting rights, dividends or any other rights relating to those Ordinary Shares will be passed on by the Depositary (or its nominee) in accordance with the terms of the Deed Poll. The Depositary Interests can then be traded, and settlement can be effected, within the CREST system in the same way as any other CREST security. The Company does not issue share certificates. Shareholders wishing to withdraw from the Depositary Interest facility and hold their Ordinary Shares in book-entry form may do so at any time using standard CREST messages. Transfers of Depositary Interests are subject to stamp duty reserve tax in the normal way. Admission is expected to take place and unconditional dealings in the Ordinary Shares is expected to commence on AIM at 8.00 a.m. on 6 January 2014. For further information concerning CREST, Shareholders should contact their broker or Euroclear UK & Ireland Limited at 33 Cannon Street, London EC4M 5SB, United Kingdom, or by telephone on +44 (0) 20 7849 0000. Further details of the settlement arrangements relating to the Placing are set out in Part VII of this document. 12. TAXATION Information regarding taxation is set out in Part IV of this document. These details are intended as a general guide only to the current tax position in Luxembourg and the United Kingdom regarding withholding taxes and are not intended to constitute personal tax advice for any person. Prospective investors are strongly advised to consult their own independent professional tax advisers regarding the tax consequences of purchasing and owning Ordinary Shares. 13. FURTHER INFORMATION Your attention is drawn to Part III of this document which contains risk factors relating to RM2 and its operations and to Part VII which contains additional information on RM2. 28 Page PART II THE PALLET MARKET 1. OVERVIEW Pallets are used throughout the world, although their use is most common in the developed economies of North America, Europe, and the Asia/Pacific region. The Asia/Pacific region represents by far the largest market for pallets, as these countries have large populations and have also undergone rapid industrialisation in recent decades, manufacturing and distributing many of North America and Western Europe’s consumer goods. Global demand for pallets in unit terms was 6.2 billion in 2012. In the US market alone approximately 2.3 billion pallets are used on an annual basis with demand in 2012 for 1.135 billion new and refurbished pallets. Figure 6: World Market for Pallets, 2012 Source: “Industry Study #3033: Pallets” Freedonia 29 Page The following figure illustrates the proportion of pallet stock by product in 2012, based on a total stock of 2.3 billion units: Figure 7: Pallet Stock by Product, 2012 Source: “Industry Study #3033: Pallets” Freedonia 2. PALLET SALES Demand for pallets is projected to expand 3.5 per cent. per year in unit terms to 1.3 billion in 2017, driven by the recovering global economy and exhibiting a reversal of the trend between 2007 and 2012 when the pallet market shrank, due in large part to the prevailing economic climate. However, growth in pallet sales is expected to be tempered by the increased use of pallet management service providers and pallet pools and, in addition, by the higher forecast stock shares of plastic and metal pallets, such as those produced by RM2. These pallets have longer life spans compared to wood, the dominant material, and thus need to be replaced far less often, causing overall demand to climb at a less rapid pace that would otherwise be the case. Specifically, pallet demand in dollar terms is expected to grow at a faster rate than demand in unit terms, stimulated again by the increasing adoption, and expanding sales, of more expensive pallet products like plastic and metal pallets and the continued upward pressure on prices due to the recovering global economy. On the other hand, increases in average pallet life spans attributable, in part, to the preponderance of those durable pallets, will limit replacement product requirements and will constrain and moderate growth in pallet demand and value. Plastic pallets are projected to see above average gains in unit and dollar demand over the next few years. Unlike most other pallet types, plastic pallets did not experience sales declines during the economic downturn (although growth did decelerate) because the specific advantages – which include durability, temperature tolerance and resistance to biological contaminants – outweighed the higher initial cost of the product. 3. PALLET RENTAL The pallet rental industry in the US alone in 2012 was estimated at US$3.6 billion and this sector is expected to grow at an average annual rate of 4.6 per cent. between 2012 and 2017 to US$4.5 billion. Whilst growth in the pallet rental industry also slowed during the economic downturn as downstream demand from the retail and manufacturing sectors declined, freight volumes and total trade value have since increased, boosting the demand for pallets used in warehousing and transportation of goods. In addition, the rental industry has benefited from an increasing number of companies that use pallet rental programmes rather than purchasing pallets. Reduced profitability during that period, coupled with the attempts of the larger participants to gain market share, has contributed to some consolidation in the rental sector. However, the industry remains relatively fragmented with the number of pallet rental companies expected to increase marginally, notwithstanding further, modest consolidation as the 30 Page larger firms acquire smaller, regional operators to extend their geographic reach whilst also continuing to expand into international markets. Although it is expected that many pallet users will continue to maintain their own fleet of pallets, more downstream industries are expected to adopt pallet rental programmes to save time and resources. The renting of pallets can generate considerable cost savings, given the significant cost of purchasing pallets. In the US, whilst wooden pallets accounted for an estimated 92.6 per cent. of the pallet rental market in 2012, there has been a recent shift toward pallets made of other materials, particularly plastic, which accounted for the remaining 7.4 per cent. of the market during that period. This shift has been relatively slow, given the high cost associated with plastic pallets. However, this trend is expected to accelerate over the next five years due to the slower increase in the price of plastic (vs. the price of wood) and an increasing number of retailers who are expected to require suppliers to use pallets made of impermeable materials, such as metal and plastic, to minimise the risk of contaminating perishable items. It should be noted that RM2’s strategy is largely focused on the ‘upstream’ area of the supply chain where pooling is currently not common. 4. PALLET STRUCTURE & MATERIALS A. PALLET STRUCTURE & DIMENSIONS Pallets are flat structures that support goods in a stable fashion while they are being transported or handled and which offer the opportunity for the efficient transportation of items on a large scale. Pallets have upper and lower horizontal surfaces, or decks, upon which goods are placed. These decks have perpendicular supports underneath them that add stability and strength, enabling them to hold larger loads without bending or breaking. These supports come either in the form of three long supports (“stringers”) or in nine cube-shaped supports (“blocks”), with one placed at each corner, in the middle on opposing sides, and one in the centre. Pallets have partially hollow interiors that allow forklifts, hand trucks, pallet jacks and other materials handling equipment to lift loads from one area to another. When stored, they can be stacked supported by racking, stacked freestanding, or stacked nested within each other. Although pallets come in all manner of sizes and configurations, all pallets fall into two very broad categories: Stringer pallets use a frame of three or more stringers. The top deckboards are then affixed to the stringers to create the pallet structure. Stringer pallets can have a notch cut into them allowing “four-way” entry. B. Block pallets are typically stronger than stringer pallets and utilise both parallel and perpendicular stringers to better facilitate efficient handling. A block pallet is also known as a “four-way” pallet, since a pallet-jack may be used from any side to move it. PALLET MATERIALS Pallets are manufactured from a number of different raw materials: wood, plastic resins, metal, and corrugated paper. Users select one material over another primarily on the basis of cost, although environmental considerations, pallet weight, the type of load to be carried, and other factors also influence a purchaser’s decision. A 2012 survey conducted for Modern Materials Handling asked respondents to identify the most important factors in deciding to use a certain type of pallet, and respondents identified reusability, customer requirements, durability and strength – all attributes of the BLOCKPal – as key features in their selection process with 38 per cent., 43 per cent., 49 per cent. and 55 per cent. respectively. i. WOODEN PALLETS Wooden pallets dominate the market as the up-front cost is low in comparison to plastic and metal alternatives. They are highly customisable, primarily in terms of providing a variety of sizes and 31 Page strengths according to user requirements. Wooden pallets can be made from various types of wood such as hard, soft, kiln-dried, recycled or some combinations thereof. They also benefit from being easy to make, spawning an industry that is highly fragmented, with localised production, mainly due to cost of moving the finished pallet. Hygiene concerns have been raised, following wooden pallets testing positive for e.Coli and Listeria. The cheapest pallets are made of lumber and are often considered expendable, to be discarded, along with other wrapping elements, at the end of the trip. These pallets tend to be simple stringer pallets, where some are only accessible from two opposing sides. In reality, some of these pallets can be reconditioned and reused and are better described as “limited use” pallets. Limited use lumber pallets need repair and refurbishment and the average price of such pallets is approximately US$10 (excluding repair) with an estimated average life of four to six trips. Slightly more complex block pallets are becoming more popular, as they can be lifted from four sides, allowing greater handling efficiencies and safety. The higher quality ones, such as those used by the big pallet rental companies use a higher proportion of hardwood and, although heavier, are much more robust and therefore suitable for use in storage racking conditions. These typically cost around US$20, and also require constant inspection, maintenance and cleaning but tend to be part of sophisticated networks of service centres so that efficiency keeps such costs relatively low compared to the cheaper pallets. ii. PLASTIC PALLETS Plastic pallets are constructed using a variety of processes, including high pressure injection moulding, structural foam moulding, thermoforming, compression moulding and rotational moulding. The most popular resins used are HDPE and polypropylene but other resins can be used or added to give particular characteristics. Recycled resins are also used but in 2012 it was estimated that the ratio of virgin resin use to recycled resin use was just over 5-to-1. Comparative to wood, plastic pallets are very durable, lasting for between ten and 60 trips and costing an average price of US$40. Plastic pallets are resistant to moisture, rot, mould, chemicals and corrosion, are easy to sanitise and are exempt from inspection for bio-safety concerns (ISPM-15 regulation) for international shipping. To take advantage of this, many pallets are made very lightweight and used for export on a ‘send-and-forget’ basis, other light duty pallets are made for downstream distribution purposes and made so that they nest inside each other to minimise storage space and maximise the amount of pallets that can be trucked on the return journey. Some heavier duty pallets can become permanently distorted due to plastic creep if used to store heavy loads for long periods. Some plastic pallet manufacturers claim that their products are of a higher specific strength (strengthto-weight ratio) than wooden equivalents and certain heavy duty pallets are deemed durable enough to populate pallet rental pools which have a small but growing share of the overall market. In certain cases reinforcing bars typically made of steel are added to increase strength though this adds to both cost and weight. The large supply chains have increased the use of plastic pallets as organisations seek to maximise efficiency and reduce costs through waste, transport and health and safety. Plastic pallets with fire retardant accreditations enable Receivers of pallets to comply with the provisions of NFPA13, the other alternatives being the installation or upgrading of expensive sprinkler systems. Cheaper fire retardants, used to mitigate the cost of the pallet, can significantly compromise structural integrity. The use of DecaBDE as a retardant in the USA has been the subject of great controversy and its further use in new pallet manufacture has effectively been stopped (albeit this does not impact pallets already in circulation). iii. METAL PALLETS Metal pallets are strong and are used for heavy loads, high-stacking loads, long term dry storage, and loads moved by abusive logistic systems. Materials used include carbon steel, stainless steel, and aluminium. Of these, carbon steel offers excellent durability at the lowest cost; however, it requires coating to prevent rusting. Stainless steel is preferred for such applications as clean room environments. 32 Page Aluminium offers the durability of steel at a lighter weight. General advantages of metal pallets are high strength and stiffness, excellent durability, insect free, no splinters, sanitary, fire proof and recyclable. Disadvantages include a high initial price and susceptibility to rusting (carbon steel) and high weight (steel). Metal is primarily used in captive or closed loop environments where durability and product protection are key performance requirements. iv. OTHER PALLETS Paper pallets are often used for light loads, but engineered paper pallets are increasingly used for loads that compare with wood. Paper pallets are also used where recycling and easy disposal is important. Paper pallets do not require fumigation or barrier “slip” sheets but do require protection from water damage. 5. PALLET INDUSTRY STRUCTURE The pallet industry is composed of pallet manufacturers, pallet refurbishers and repair specialists, and pallet management service and pallet pooling firms. A. PALLET MANUFACTURERS There are a significant number of companies involved in the manufacture of pallets and the market is highly fragmented, albeit these typically fabricate only one product type due to the different manufacturing techniques and raw materials for production. B. PALLET REFURBISHERS Although wood pallet refurbishing has existed in the US since the 1970s, interest in it increased considerably through the 1980s and 1990s and, in recent years, users have sought to reduce their environmental impact and enhance their profitability through the use of pallet refurbishment services. Rather than dispose of pallets, users send them to pallet refurbishers which repair slightly damaged pallets by replacing broken boards with fresh panels. More severely distressed pallets are taken apart, and undamaged components are used to repair other pallets. Rebuilt pallets are either returned to their original owners or sold on the open market. Those parts of the pallets that are too severely damaged to be refurbished are, depending on what chemical treatment the pallet may have received, burned for fuel or ground into such products as mulch or animal bedding or, alternatively, sent to landfill. C. PALLET RENTAL & MANAGEMENT SERVICE PROVIDERS Pallet management service providers and pallet rental pools are important participants in the industry and range from large firms with national networks of offices, repair sites, and distribution facilities to medium and smaller pallet pools that typically serve potential customers in one industry that are in close proximity to each other geographically and often market products at the same retail outlets. This segment of the pallet industry in the US is somewhat less fragmented than the pallet manufacturing and repair segments. 6. KEY MARKETS Pallets find use in a wide variety of applications, not only in durable and non-durable goods manufacturing, but also in non-manufacturing industries such as retail and transportation and warehousing. 33 Page Figure 8: US Major Market Segmentation, 2012 Source: “Pallet and Skid rental in the US – 2012” IBISWorld A. MANUFACTURING The manufacturing sector is the dominant market for pallet rentals. Regardless of the industry, practically all manufacturing activities require pallets for the transportation and storage of raw materials, finished goods, machinery support and warehousing functions. B. RETAIL The retail sector also constitutes a major market for pallet rentals. Most major retail operations receive shipments of inventory on pallets and move excess inventory within their stock rooms and warehouses. Accordingly, the choice of pallet type is an important consideration. For example, major retailers often display retail items on their sales floors on the same pallets that were used to load and unload shipments on and off the delivery truck. This type of marketing can increase the standards such retailers require of their pallet supplies. Also, the types of goods destined for retail can have implications for pallet requirements, such as the regulations some jurisdictions have for using plastic instead of wooden pallets to stem the possibility of e. coli and other contamination. C. TRANSPORTATION AND WAREHOUSING Whilst pallets are integral to the transportation and warehousing sector, such firms generally invest in their own pallet equipment because of the critical need for it in their businesses. As measured by total trade value, the transportation and warehousing market is expected to overcome the losses incurred during the economic downturn, largely on the back of strong demand from emerging markets. Exports in this sector tend to face a higher degree of regulation, and the US Department of Agriculture’s new fumigation standards for wooden packaging materials could encourage companies to invest in alternative transportation media. 7. MARKET DRIVERS Growth in the key markets for pallets identified in paragraph 6 above is linked to overall economic conditions and, accordingly, demand for pallets depends on a variety of macro factors, such as population growth, exchange rates and disposable incomes, as well as industry-specific micro factors, such as product prices, the prices of substitutes and consumer trends. Demand can also fluctuate in line with changing requirements among downstream industries and any change in regulations. 34 Page A. DEMOGRAPHICS Pallet demand is driven in part by population growth. Many consumer goods – including clothing, food and beverages, home electronics, pharmaceuticals, and small appliances – are typically shipped on pallets from manufacturers to distributors and retailers, where consumers then purchase them. Demand for these products tends to rise as the population grows, which in turn increases demand for the pallets on which these goods are shipped. In addition, many building and construction materials – such as cement, lumber, paint, shingles, and siding – are shipped on pallets to contractors, home builders, and remodelers. Population increases often fuel demand for new housing units and refurbishment of existing housing, which spurs demand for building materials and thus for pallets. B. MANUFACTURING DEMAND Pallet demand closely follows growth or decline in manufacturers’ shipments. Most manufactured goods are shipped and stored on pallets, as pallets add load stability during shipment, and allow users to move goods more compactly and efficiently. Growth in demand from manufacturers will increase the industry’s revenue while a decline in manufacturing activity will negatively impact industry revenue. Accordingly, when manufacturing activity contracts, pallet demand tends to fall more rapidly. Pallets make fewer trips due to reduced shipments and thus last longer, and manufacturers accumulate idle stock, both of which restrain demand for replacement pallets. Similarly, when manufacturing activity rebounds, pallet demand tends to rise more slowly because manufacturers utilise idle stock before making new purchases. One trend that could have a significant impact on the outlook for US manufacturing is insourcing (also called reshoring or onshoring). A number of factors are making manufacturing in the US more attractive, including rising labour costs in developing countries, especially China; increasing shipping costs; shorter product development cycles; supply chain uncertainty; increasing US worker productivity; lower property costs; and import quality issues. In addition, a rebound in US oil and gas production is improving the feedstock cost position of downstream material producers. Another major factor in the improving outlook for US manufacturing is the increasing production of shale oil and gas in the US. Higher production of natural gas and the resultant decrease in natural gas prices have given the US an advantage over Europe and Asia in a number of manufacturing industries due to lower energy costs. C. RETAIL TRADE LEVELS Retailers are one of the industry’s largest markets. Pallets are used to transport and store consumer goods in warehouses to stores and demand from retailers is likely to impact the industry’s revenue. Much like slumping manufacturing activity during the past five years, retail trade also suffered during the economic downturn. Durable Goods Demand for pallets in the US is closely connected to manufacturers’ shipments of durable goods i.e. products that have an average useful life of at least three years. Many producers use pallets to transport their products from the factory to the warehouse, as pallets offer the necessary stability and sturdiness to handle most durable goods, including those most susceptible to damage during transit because of their large size and heavy weight, or their fragile components. Leading durable goods manufacturing markets for pallets include electronic equipment, machinery, metal products, and transportation equipment. In real (inflation-adjusted) terms, shipments of durable goods are projected to increase 2.4 per cent. per year through to 2017. Non-durable goods Pallets are also used to transport non-durable manufactured goods. Many of these items – including chemical resin pellets, foodstuffs, paper rolls, and textiles – are traditionally packaged in materials that are unwieldy and/or highly susceptible to damage. Such items can be placed on pallets, which are then wrapped with plastic film or other protective outer layers to prevent the items from shifting or falling during transit. These loaded pallets are easier to handle and transport than unpalletised loads, and can be more easily separated at 35 Page warehouses, retail stores, and other end-use facilities. Non-durables frequently shipped on pallets include beverages, boxed and dried foods, consumer products, and drums of chemical pellets and resins. In real (inflation-adjusted) terms, shipments of non-durable goods are projected to increase 1.5 per cent. per annum through to 2017. D. WAREHOUSING EXPENDITURES The warehousing services industry represents a significant market for the US pallet industry. Many warehousing and storage firms partner with manufacturers to provide for the shipment of palletised products to their customers and then return the pallets to the manufacturer once they have been emptied. Other warehousing service providers own large pallet stocks and contract with manufacturers and retailers to palletise and deliver products to the customer. These companies buy large numbers of pallets each year. In real (inflation-adjusted) terms, warehousing and storage expenditures are forecast to increase 3.1 per cent. annually through to 2017, driven in part by further increases in the number of manufacturers and retailers that prefer to have their shipping and receiving needs handled by third-party providers. E. CONSTRUCTION EXPENDITURES Construction is an important pallet market and many items used in building are shipped on palletised loads. These include bricks, doors, pipes, shingles, tiles, and wiring, among other items. Increased construction activity thus results in growth of pallet sales, as more pallets are required to ship construction-related products to builders, contractors, and retailers. 8. INDUSTRY STANDARDS ISO 8611 The ISO is a worldwide network of national standards bodies and the work of preparing international standards is carried out through ISO technical committees. ISO technical committee TC51 covers pallets exclusively and they work on the current range of ISO pallet standards started in earnest in 1979. The test procedures described in ISO 8611-1 are approximate simulations of pallet use. These tests help the pallet designer to establish an initial acceptable balance between the cost and the performance of a pallet design and are regarded as the best analytical tools for users or manufacturers to establish exactly how pallets perform under simulated conditions. ASTM D1185 ASTM International, formerly known as the American Society for Testing and Materials (“ASTM”), is an international standards organisation that develops and publishes voluntary consensus technical standards, test methods, specifications, guides, and practices for a wide range of materials, products, systems, and services. ASTM D1185 is the Standard Test Methods for Pallets and Related Structures Employed in Materials Handling and Shipping. These test methods cover the performance of pallets and related structures, functioning as skids, bases, platforms, and bins in materials handling and shipping. 9. FIRE REGULATIONS The National Fire Protection Association (“NFPA”) establishes the standard, NFPA 13, that provides the basis for most state and local fire prevention laws and regulations governing warehouse construction and management throughout the United States, although state or local requirements may sometimes be more stringent. The NFPA 13 standard includes requirements for management of shipping pallets in warehouses, including requirements that mandate stricter management controls and fire prevention systems for plastic pallets than for wood pallets. For plastic pallets, NFPA 13 provides two options: imposition of more stringent requirements on the warehouse for managing plastic pallets than for managing wood pallets, or use of plastic pallets that have passed tests demonstrating, “a fire hazard that is equal to or less than wood pallets and are listed as such.” 36 Page To enable adoption of a rental pool populated with plastic pallets, a pallet supplier would want to be able to provide shippers of goods with a pallet that has passed testing such as the Factory Mutual (“FM 4996”) or Underwriters Laboratories (“UL 2335”) tests, or risk rejection of shipments by Receivers who would otherwise then fail to comply with NFPA 13 requirements for plastic pallets. Phasing out of the use of the popular and widely available DecaBDE fire retardant due to health and environmental fears left manufacturers of plastic pallets not only facing an array of formulation challenges in balancing the demands of flame retardancy and other physical attributes for a plastic pallet but also major cost concerns. Cost pressures include both the development process itself and the ultimate cost of the pallet in the marketplace. Alternatives create problems as they generally have to be used in larger quantities than DecaBDE, often in excess of 20 per cent. As a general rule, the cheaper the fire retardant the more is required and this tends to add weight, add cost, reduce material performance or processing properties (melt-flows) and contain toxins. A shipping pallet is not a premium-price product – the best pallet capable of manufacture is likely to be far too costly for the massmarket. Accordingly, developers are faced with the technical balancing act of providing the required level of flame retardancy whilst maximising essential strength, stiffness, durability and functionality. The compound used by RM2 in the construction of the BlockPal is fire resistant without any fire retardant additives. One design of the BLOCKPal has been presented for testing, and passed the UL 2335 testing protocol, due to a combination of the pallet geometry and raw materials utilised. 37 Page PART III RISK FACTORS Investing in the Company is speculative and involves a high degree of risk. Before making an investment decision, prospective investors are advised to consult a professional adviser authorised under FSMA who specialises in investments of the kind described in this document. You should carefully consider the entire contents of this document, including, but not limited to, the risk factors described below, before you decide to invest in the Company. As at the date of this document, the Company considers the following risks to be the material risks of which they are aware and the most significant risks for shareholders and potential investors. Such risks have not been set out in any order of priority. In addition, you should note that the risks described below are not the only risks faced by RM2. In particular, there may be additional risks that the Directors currently consider not to be material or of which they are not presently aware. The Group’s business, financial condition or results of operations could be materially and adversely affected by any of the risks described below. There can be no certainty that the Group will be able to implement successfully the strategy set out in this document. No representation is or can be made as to the future performance of the Group and there can be no assurance the Group will achieve its objectives. 1. GENERAL RISKS An investment in the Company is only suitable for investors capable of evaluating the risks and merits of such investment and who have sufficient resources to bear any loss which may result. A prospective investor should consider with care whether an investment in the Company is suitable for him in the light of his personal circumstances and the financial resources available to him. Investment in the Company should not be regarded as short-term in nature. There can be no guarantee that any appreciation in the value of the Ordinary Shares will occur or that the objectives of the Company will be achieved. Investors may not get back the full or any amount initially invested. The prices of shares and the income (if any) derived from them can go down as well as up. Past performance is not necessarily a guide to the future. Changes in economic conditions including, for example, exchange rates, interest rates, rates of inflation, industry conditions, competition, political and diplomatic events and trends, tax laws and other factors can substantially and adversely affect equity investments and the Company’s prospects. 2. RISKS RELATING TO RM2 AND ITS BUSINESS (a) Early stage of operations RM2 is at an early stage of development. The commencement of RM2 earning material revenues is difficult to predict and there is no guarantee that RM2 will generate any material revenues in the near future. RM2 has a limited operating history upon which its performance and prospects can be evaluated and faces the risks frequently encountered by developing companies. These risks include the uncertainty as to which areas to target for growth. There can be no assurance that RM2’s proposed operations will be profitable or produce a reasonable return, if any, on investment. (b) Product development RM2 intends to continue to develop products which are designed to have a commercial application. There is no guarantee that any such product will be successful nor that any products will actually result in any commercial applications. 38 Page The success of RM2 is reliant upon there being a demand for its products. In addition, RM2 relies upon third parties to incorporate its products into their own processes. A particular third party having access to RM2’s products may fail to use the products in an effective process or the products or processes may not be or become commercially viable. There can be no assurance that such products will achieve commercial success or be an attractive alternative to conventional products or processes. It is possible that RM2 focuses its activities on a limited number of products and technologies and that after such further development has taken place, RM2 finds that the resulting product is not successful or has no profitable commercial application, or that the resulting product has been superseded by other products which have a more profitable commercial application when compared with those of RM2. The development and manufacture of products takes some time to complete. Depending on the process, RM2 may not be able to develop its products within the timeframe required by its potential customers and/or that targeted by its competitors. Further, the success of RM2 may depend on its continued ability to develop new products and to meet potential customers’ changing requirements. (c) Market acceptance The development of a market for a new product is affected by many factors, most of which are beyond the control of RM2, including the emergence of newer and more competitive products or processes, the costs of the products, regulatory requirements, including any future regulatory changes, end-users’ perceptions as to the safety of any product and the propensity of end-users to try new products or processes. If a market for any product fails to develop or develops more slowly than anticipated, RM2 may fail to achieve profitability with respect to the associated products. In addition, RM2 may not continue to develop such products if market conditions do not support the continuation of those products. (d) RM2 may experience accelerated demand for its products and services RM2 expects to be able to meet its current capital expenditures from internal resources and the net proceeds of the Placing. In future, it may explore other sources of financing including invoice discounting and other debt facilities. A need to fulfil large orders rapidly may require RM2 to seek additional capital which could entail the issuance of new equity, debt financing or some combination thereof. If RM2 is unable to raise the necessary additional financing for any expanded working capital requirement it could adversely affect its ability to expand its business. (e) RM2 is expected to experience rapid growth. If RM2 is not able to effectively manage its growth, its operations could be damaged and profitability reduced RM2’s business and operations are expected to experience rapid growth. This future growth could place significant demands on RM2’s operational and financial infrastructure and its ability to expand to meet such growth will be tested. RM2 may need to expand and enhance its infrastructure and technology, and improve its operational and financial systems and procedures and controls from time to time in order to be able to match that growth. If RM2 is unable to manage its growth effectively, its operations could be harmed and profitability reduced. The growth of RM2’s sales and profits in the future will depend, in part, on its ability to expand its operations through the roll-out of its products and services to new potential customers and into new markets and geographies. Furthermore, in order to manage its planned expansion, it will need continually to evaluate the adequacy of its management capability, operational procedures, financial controls and information systems. Accordingly, there can be no assurance that RM2 will be able to achieve its expansion goals on a timely or profitable basis. (f) RM2 will need to ensure that its financial risk limitation policies, procedures and practices remain suitable as RM2 grows and changes from being a research and development company to an operating manufacturing company The financial risk limitation policies, procedures and practices RM2 has established to date are suitable for a company of the size and stage of development of RM2. As RM2 seeks to grow, the design and implementation of RM2’s policies, procedures and practices used to identify, monitor and control a variety of risks may fail to be effective. RM2’s financial risk limitation methods rely on a combination of internally developed technical 39 Page controls, industry standard practices, observation of historical market behaviour and human supervision. These methods may not adequately prevent future losses. A lack of effective internal controls could have a material adverse effect on RM2’s reputation, business, financial condition and operating results. Any material weaknesses may materially adversely affect RM2’s ability to report accurately its financial condition and results of operations in the future in a timely and reliable manner. (g) RM2’s expansion may not be successful RM2’s operations are subject to certain risks including changes in government policies, changes in political and economic conditions, changes in regulatory environments, exposure to different legal, regulatory or fiscal standards, difficulties in staffing and managing operations, and potentially adverse tax consequences. There are no guarantees that RM2 will be able to successfully expand its operations in line with its current expectations. (h) RM2 may experience unforeseen delays and cost overruns when rolling out its products and services Management effort and financial resources are being employed by RM2 in rolling out its products and services to potential customers. Following Admission, RM2 expects production to increase significantly and its pallet production capacity is untested on the scale at which it hopes to operate. Although RM2 has budgeted for expected costings, additional expenses in the event of unforeseen delays, cost overruns, unanticipated expenses, regulatory changes and increases in the price of materials and other manufacturing equipment utilised in RM2’s processes may negatively affect RM2’s business, financial condition and results of operations. (i) RM2 is dependent on developing relationships with potential customers The success of RM2’s business is, and is expected to continue to be, dependent on the development of commercial relationships with its potential customers and suppliers. There is no guarantee that these relationships will be developed sufficiently to the point of generating revenue for RM2, or that such potential customers will not seek to use alternative providers of products and services similar to those of RM2. (j) RM2 is dependent on continued availability of raw materials and manufacturing equipment The raw materials and manufacturing equipment utilised by RM2 in the delivery of its products and services are readily available from a number of suppliers and counterparties. However, any restriction on the availability of such items may negatively affect RM2’s business, financial condition and results of operations. (k) Exchange rate fluctuations RM2’s principal revenues in the near term are expected to be earned in US$. Currency fluctuations may affect RM2’s operating cash flow since certain of its costs and revenues are likely to be denominated in a number of different currencies other than US$ and any potential income may become subject to exchange control or similar restrictions. Fluctuations in exchange rates between currencies in which RM2 operates may cause fluctuations in its financial results which are not necessarily related to its underlying operations. RM2 does not currently have any foreign currency hedges in place. If and when appropriate, the adoption of a hedging policy will be considered by the Board. (l) Terrorism, political and social instability Terrorist activities or armed conflict involving any country in which RM2 operates or to which RM2’s products and services are provided may adversely affect its business activities and financial conditions. If events of this nature occur or persist, the resulting political and social instability could adversely affect RM2’s revenues. (m) Competition There can be no assurance that potential competitors of RM2, which may have greater financial, R&D, sales and marketing and personnel resources than RM2, are not currently developing, or will not in the future develop, products and strategies that are equally or more effective and/or economical as any products or strategies developed by RM2 or which would otherwise render its products or strategies obsolete. 40 Page RM2 operates within competitive markets and the Directors believe that it has adopted a competitive business strategy. However, RM2’s business, results, operations and financial condition could be materially adversely affected by the actions of its competitors (including their marketing and pricing strategies and product and services development). RM2 may be forced to change the nature of its business as a result of competitive factors and there is no assurance that RM2 will be able to compete successfully in the market place in which it seeks to operate. (n) Manufacturing technology Even if new and advanced manufacturing or production equipment becomes available to RM2, it may not have funds available or be able to obtain necessary financing on acceptable terms to acquire or utilise it. Further, any investment RM2 may make in a perceived technological advance may not be effective, economically successful or otherwise accepted in the market. (o) RM2’s expenses include fixed costs A significant proportion of RM2’s costs may be fixed and may not then be easily reduced in the short-term. Therefore, RM2 may not be able to reduce certain expenses promptly in response to any future reduction in revenue. Should such a reduction occur and RM2 be unable to reduce its fixed expenses accordingly, its business, financial condition and results of operations may be materially adversely affected. (p) RM2 may acquire other businesses or assets if suitable opportunities become available Any future acquisition poses integration and other risks which may significantly affect RM2’s results or operations and any businesses that it may acquire may not turn out to be profitable. In addition, the operation and management of additional businesses, assets or customers may require additional resources, such as human or infrastructure resources. There can be no assurance that RM2 will be able to procure the additional resources to cope with the growth in the number of assets under its management. (q) Ability to attract and retain key executives, officers, managers and technical personnel RM2 is headquartered in Luxembourg. The Chief Executive Officer and the principal sales office are located in Switzerland and the Company maintains an executive presence in London. RM2’s existing manufacturing facility is located in Ontario, Canada. Attracting, training, retaining and motivating technical and managerial personnel, including individuals with significant technical expertise is a critical component of the future success of RM2’s business. RM2 may encounter difficulties in attracting or retaining qualified personnel. Managing from disparate locations can pose challenges in communication and decision-making. Continued growth may cause a significant strain on existing managerial, operational, financial and information systems resources. The performance of RM2 depends, to a significant extent, upon the abilities and continued efforts of its existing senior management as well as the recruitment of further senior management in line with the planned growth in operations. The loss of the services or failure to recruit key management personnel or the failure to retain or recruit key employees or the inability to effectively communicate across international offices could adversely affect RM2’s ability to maintain and/or improve its operating and financial performance. In common with many businesses, the success of RM2 after Admission will, to a significant extent, be dependent on the expertise and experience of the Directors and key senior management, the loss of one or more of whom could have a material adverse effect on RM2. Whilst RM2 has entered into service agreements with the Directors which will become effective on or before Admission, it does not currently have formal employment contracts in place with all of its senior management team. The retention of services of the Directors and senior management team cannot be guaranteed. (r) RM2’s disaster recovery plans may not be sufficient and if they are not then there could be a material adverse effect on its financial position RM2 depends on the performance, reliability and availability of its information technology and communications systems. Any damage to or failure of its systems could result in disruptions to RM2’s operations and websites, which could reduce its revenues and profits, and damage its brands. 41 Page RM2’s systems are vulnerable to damage or interruption from power loss, telecommunications failures, computer viruses, computer denial of service attacks or other attempts to harm its systems, natural disasters, including floods and fires, volcanic ash and vandalism, terrorist attacks or other acts. RM2’s disaster recovery plans may not adequately address every potential event and its insurance policies may not cover any loss in full or in part (including losses resulting from business interruptions) or damage that it suffers fully or at all. RM2 relies on third parties, including data centres and bandwidth providers, to host and operate its websites. Any failure or interruption in the services provided by these third parties could harm its operations and reputation. In addition, RM2 may have little or no control over these third parties, which increases its vulnerability to service problems. Any disruptions in the services provided by these parties or any failure of these providers to handle current or higher visitor traffic or transaction volumes could significantly harm RM2’s business. RM2 may in the future experience disruptions or delays in these services. If these providers were to suffer financial or other difficulties, their services could be interrupted or discontinued and replacement providers may be uneconomical or unavailable. Any of these events could have a material adverse effect on RM2’s business, operating profit and overall financial condition. (s) Levels of insurance carried by RM2 There can be no certainty that RM2’s insurance cover is adequate to protect against every eventuality and the occurrence of an event for which RM2 did not have adequate insurance cover could have a material adverse effect on RM2. (t) Political, economic, regulatory and legislative considerations Adverse developments in the political, legal, economic and regulatory environment may materially and adversely affect the financial position and business prospects of RM2. Political and economic uncertainties include, but are not limited to, expropriation, nationalisation, changes in interest rates, the retail prices index, changes in taxation and changes in law. Whilst RM2 strives to continue to take effective measures such as prudent financial management and efficient operating procedures, there is no assurance that adverse political, economic, legal and regulatory factors will not materially and adversely affect RM2. (u) Development of technology Continuing research on and development of RM2’s technology may be required and there can be no assurance that any of its future technology will be successfully developed or exploited. RM2 may encounter delays and incur additional R&D costs and expenses over and above those anticipated or allowed for by the Directors. (v) Unforeseen factors and developments RM2’s ability to implement its business strategy may be adversely affected by factors that it cannot currently foresee, such as unanticipated costs and expenses, technological change and severe economic downturn. All of these factors may necessitate changes to the business strategy described in this document. (w) Market acceptance and future funding Whilst the Directors believe that there are viable markets for RM2’s products and services, there can be no assurance that these will be generally adopted by RM2’s potential client base. Whilst the Directors believe that, taking into account the net proceeds of the Placing, RM2 has sufficient working capital for its present requirements, that is for at least 12 months from the date of Admission, there can be no assurance that RM2 would have sufficient resources to fund further development beyond that period. (x) Regulatory environment RM2’s operations may be subject to a variety of national, federal, provincial, state, foreign and local laws and regulations, including environmental, health and safety laws, regulations, treaties and conventions (together, “Regulations”). 42 Page This includes, inter alia, those controlling the discharge of materials into the environment, requiring removal and clean-up of environmental contamination, establishing certification, licensing, health and safety, taxes, labour and training standards, operation of equipment or otherwise relating to the protection of human health and the environment, and export control regulations. The amendment or modification of existing Regulations or the adoption of new Regulations curtailing or further regulating RM2’s business could have a material adverse effect on RM2’s operating results and financial condition. Whilst RM2 intends to work to comply with all applicable Regulations, it cannot predict the extent to which future earnings or capital expenditures may be affected by compliance with such new Regulations. In addition, RM2 may be subject to significant fines, penalties or liability if it does not comply with any such existing or future Regulations. There may be a change in the regulatory environment which may materially adversely affect RM2’s ability to implement successfully the strategy set out in this document. (y) Intellectual property and proprietary rights RM2 relies upon maintaining the confidentiality of the exact nature of the BLOCKPal manufacturing process and does not for example have any patents. The details of the manufacturing process are the Company’s most important intellectual property. The Company protects this intellectual property by ensuring that its relevant employees have confidentiality provisions in their employment contracts preventing them from disclosing the confidential information of the Group to anyone outside of the Group. RM2 ensures relevant suppliers have entered into non-disclosure agreements restricting disclosure by such suppliers of the confidential information of the Group. However, RM2 cannot be sure that other competitors will not infringe upon, violate, challenge or reverse engineer its intellectual property in the future. If RM2 is not able to adequately protect or enforce its intellectual property rights, its business, results of operations and financial condition may be materially adversely affected. RM2 is also subject to the risk that third parties may allege that RM2’s operations and use of technology infringes upon their intellectual property rights. RM2 cannot be sure that such litigation will not be brought against RM2 in the future and, if brought, whether RM2 would be successful in defending itself against such claims. Moreover, defending such claims may result in protracted litigation, which could result in substantial costs and the diversion of RM2’s resources, as a result of which RM2’s business, results of operations and financial condition may be adversely affected. Furthermore, RM2 customer contracts may contain indemnities, whereby RM2 may agree to indemnify its customers for third party intellectual property infringement claims and RM2 cannot be sure that it would have no liability to its customers in such circumstances. (z) Reliance on manufacturing sector for bulk of pallet orders RM2 is reliant on the manufacturing sector of the economy to produce goods in sufficient volumes to drive demand for pallets on which to transport those goods. A reduction in manufacturing output may lead to a reduction in the size of the pallet market and in turn RM2 may find it more difficult to obtain orders to produce or lease pallets. (aa) Increases in input costs RM2’s operations require raw materials, road transportation and water and electricity supply. Any increase in these input costs would affect the profitability of RM2 which may find it difficult to pass on such increased costs to potential customers. (bb) Electricity supply The pultrusion process which forms part of the pallet manufacturing process requires large amounts of electricity. The amount of electricity required cannot be obtained easily at other premises. Any electricity failure or outage would affect production of the pallets, risking a failure to meet contractual obligations. Furthermore if the current factory premises in Ontario, Canada were to become unavailable, the electricity requirement of the production process would limit the range of sites to which RM2 could switch production. 43 Page (cc) Contamination at the Canadian factory At the site adjacent to RM2 Canada’s factory, there is contamination in the groundwater (which has migrated onto RM2 Canada’s premises from a neighbouring site) in the form of dissolved phase petroleum hydrocarbons, polychlorinated biphenyls and trichloroethylene and its degradation products (including vinyl chloride)) (the “Contamination”) at concentrations exceeding the applicable Ontario Ministry of the Environment (the “MOE”) standards. These chemicals can potentially, if present in sufficient concentrations, have an impact on human health. RM2 Canada’s landlord has engaged the services of an environmental consultant to complete a risk assessment on the extent of Contamination present at RM2 Canada’s premises. This risk assessment remains on-going and ultimately is expected to be submitted to the MOE. However, the consultants have advised, as a preliminary view, that the levels of Contamination found at RM2 Canada’s site do not pose a risk to RM2 Canada’s workers. In addition, the previous owners of RM2 Canada’s premises carried out activities of plastic films manufacture and packaging, processes which can sometimes have an environmental impact. The MOE has a broad discretionary power to make orders under the Canadian Environmental Protection Act against land owners or occupiers including where contamination was caused by a previous occupier. As such, although RM2 has been advised that it is not likely, there is a risk that RM2 Canada could be held liable for the Contamination or any contamination at RM2 Canada’s premises arising from the activities of the former tenant. 3. RISKS RELATING TO THE COMPANY’S DOMICILE (a) Disclosure of interests in shares Under the Luxembourg Companies Law, shareholders in RM2 are not obliged to disclose their interests in a company in the same way as shareholders of certain public companies incorporated in the United Kingdom. In particular, the Disclosure and Transparency Rules do not apply. The Articles have been amended to incorporate provisions equivalent to those contained in the Disclosure and Transparency Rules, but these may be amended by a resolution of the Shareholders. (b) Takeovers As RM2 is not admitted to trading on a “regulated market”, it is not subject to any takeover laws in Luxembourg or elsewhere. 4. RISKS RELATING TO THE ORDINARY SHARES (a) Suitability Investment in the Ordinary Shares may not be suitable for all readers of this document. Readers are accordingly advised to consult a person authorised under FSMA who specialises in investments of this nature before making any investment decisions. (b) Investment in AIM-traded securities Investment in shares traded on AIM involves a higher degree of risk, and such shares may be less liquid, than shares in companies which are listed on the Official List. The AIM Rules for Companies are less demanding than those rules that govern companies admitted to the Official List. It is emphasised that no application is being made for the admission of RM2’s securities to the Official List or to any other investment exchange other than AIM. An investment in the Ordinary Shares may be difficult to realise. Prospective investors should be aware that the value of an investment in RM2 may go down as well as up and that the market price of the Ordinary Shares may not reflect the underlying value of RM2. Investors may therefore realise less than, or lose all of, their investment. (c) Share price volatility and liquidity The share price of quoted companies can be highly volatile and shareholdings can be illiquid. The price at which the Ordinary Shares are quoted and the price which investors may realise for their Ordinary Shares will be influenced by a large number of factors, some specific to RM2 and its operations and others which may affect quoted companies generally. These factors could include the performance of RM2, large purchases or sales of the Ordinary Shares, currency fluctuations, legislative changes and general economic, political, regulatory or social conditions. 44 Page (d) Access to further capital RM2 may require additional funds to respond to business challenges, enhancing existing products and services and further developing its sales and marketing channels and capabilities. Accordingly, RM2 may need to engage in equity or debt financings to secure additional funds. If RM2 raises additional funds through further issues of equity or convertible debt securities, existing shareholders could suffer significant dilution, and any new equity securities or convertible debt securities could have rights, preferences and privileges superior to those of current shareholders. Any debt financing secured by RM2 in the future could involve restrictive covenants relating to its capital raising activities and other financial and operational matters, which may make it more difficult for RM2 to obtain additional capital and to pursue business opportunities, including potential acquisitions. In addition, RM2 may not be able to obtain additional financing on terms favourable to it, if at all. If RM2 is unable to obtain adequate financing or financing on terms satisfactory to it, when required, its ability to continue to support its business growth and to respond to business challenges could be significantly limited or could affect its financial viability. (e) Dilution If available, future financings to provide required capital may dilute shareholders’ proportionate ownership in RM2. RM2 may raise capital in the future through public or private equity financings or by issuing debt securities convertible into Ordinary Shares, or rights to acquire these securities (which, in any such case, may not be made available to existing holders of Ordinary Shares). If RM2 raises significant amounts of capital by these or other means, that could cause dilution for RM2’s existing shareholders. Moreover, the further issue of Ordinary Shares could have a negative impact on the trading price and increase the volatility of the market price of the Ordinary Shares. RM2 may also issue further Ordinary Shares, or create further options over Ordinary Shares, as part of its employee remuneration policy, which could in aggregate create a substantial dilution in the value of the Ordinary Shares and the proportion of RM2’s share capital in which investors are interested. (f) Future sale of Ordinary Shares RM2 is unable to predict when and if substantial numbers of Ordinary Shares will be sold in the open market following Admission. Any such sales, or the perception that such sales might occur, could result in a material adverse effect on the market price of the Ordinary Shares. RM2 may require additional capital in the future which may not be available to it. (g) No prior trading market for Ordinary Shares Prior to Admission, there was no public market for the Ordinary Shares. There can be no assurance that an active market for (and hence liquidity in the trading of) the Ordinary Shares will develop upon Admission, or if developed, that such market will be sustained. (h) Exchange rate risk to investors RM2’s functional currency is US$. Fluctuations in currency could have an adverse effect on the value of an investor’s holdings in RM2 where the principal accounting currency of the investor is not US$ or where there are inverse fluctuations between Sterling, the currency in which the Ordinary Shares are quoted, and US$, the currency in which the Company’s results are reported. (i) Dividends There can be no assurance as to whether dividends will be paid in future or in what amount. Subject to compliance with the Luxembourg Companies Law and the Articles, the declaration, payment and amount of any future dividends are subject to the discretion of the Directors, and will depend on, inter alia, the Company’s earnings, financial position, cash requirements and availability of profits. A dividend may never be paid and, at present, there is no intention to pay a dividend in the short to medium term. The risks noted above do not necessarily comprise all of the risks potentially faced by RM2 and are not intended to be presented in any assumed order of priority. Although RM2 will seek to minimise the impact of the Risk Factors, investment in RM2 should only be made by investors able to sustain a total loss of their investment. Potential investors are strongly recommended to consult an investment adviser authorised under FSMA, who specialises in investments of this nature before making any decision to invest. 45 Page PART IV TAXATION The following information is intended only as a general guide to current UK tax legislation, the impact of Luxembourg tax on Shareholders resident in the UK for tax purposes, and published HM Revenue and Customs practice as it applies to holding or disposing of Ordinary Shares at the date of this document, all of which are subject to change, possibly with retrospective effect. It is intended only for Shareholders who are resident in the UK for tax purposes and who hold Ordinary Shares beneficially as investments. The comments do not address the position of certain classes of shareholder, such as dealers in securities. This section is not intended, and shall not be construed to be, legal or taxation advice to any particular Shareholder. Any Shareholder who is in any doubt as to their tax position, or who is subject to tax in a jurisdiction other than the UK, should consult their professional adviser. 1. Taxation of dividends UK 1.1 Individual Shareholders who are resident in the UK for tax purposes should generally be entitled to a tax credit in respect of any dividend received equal to one ninth of the amount of the dividend paid or ten per cent. of the combined amount of the tax credit and the dividend. The amount of the dividend received by such an individual Shareholder and the associated tax credit form part of the individual Shareholder’s income for UK tax purposes. 1.2 The rate of income tax on dividends is ten per cent. for individuals not liable to tax at a rate above the basic rate. The tax credit therefore discharges the income tax liability of such a Shareholder. 1.3 UK resident individuals who are higher rate taxpayers are liable to tax on dividends at the rate of 32.5 per cent., so that, after taking account of the tax credit, such Shareholders will have tax to pay equal to 25 per cent. of the net dividend received. 1.4 UK resident individuals that are subject to the additional rate of income tax of 45 per cent. are liable to tax on dividends at the rate of 37.5 per cent. This means that, after taking account of the tax credit, those taxpayers will have tax to pay on dividends equal to 30.56 per cent. of the net dividend received. 1.5 Special rules apply in respect of dividends received by trustees. Shareholders who hold their Ordinary Shares on trust should consult their professional adviser. 1.6 Subject to certain exceptions for traders, a UK resident corporate Shareholder will generally be exempt from corporation tax on any dividend paid by the Company, subject to certain anti-avoidance provisions. If the Company’s dividends are not exempt, they will be included in the UK resident corporate Shareholders’ profits chargeable to corporation tax and taxed at the appropriate rate of corporation tax (currently, in the 2013-14 financial year, a maximum of 23 per cent.). 1.7 The Company will not be required to withhold any UK tax on dividend payments in respect of the Ordinary Shares. Luxembourg – Taxation of non-resident Shareholders 1.8 Shareholders that are (i) non-residents of Luxembourg and (ii) are either (a) an individual Shareholder or (b) a corporate Shareholder without any permanent establishment in Luxembourg to which the Ordinary shares are attributable, are generally not liable to any Luxembourg income tax. Luxembourg – Withholding tax on dividends and credit in the UK 1.9 Dividends paid by the Company to its shareholders are normally subject to withholding tax in Luxembourg at a rate of 15 per cent. 46 Page 2. 3. 1.10 The Company is responsible for withholding such withholding tax. 1.11 If a Shareholder receives a dividend on Ordinary Shares and the dividend is paid subject to Luxembourg withholding tax, credit for such Luxembourg withholding tax may be available for set-off against a liability to UK corporation tax or UK income tax on the dividend. 1.12 The amount of such credit will normally be equal to the lesser of the amount withheld and the liability to UK tax on the dividend. Such credit will not normally be available for set-off against a Shareholder’s liability to UK tax other than on the dividend and, to the extent that such credit is not set off against UK tax on the dividend, the credit will be lost. Credit will not be available to the extent that the Luxembourg withholding tax can be minimised or repaid by taking reasonable steps under a double tax treaty or a provision of Luxembourg law. 1.13 Following Admission, the Company is intending to assess various options to undertake tax planning in Luxembourg that may potentially minimise the withholding tax on dividends on Ordinary Shares by, for example, the creation of a reserve from which it may be possible to pay distributions to Shareholders with no withholding tax. Creation of such a reserve would be subject to the approval of Shareholders in due course and therefore there is no certainty that it will be created. Capital gains 2.1 A disposal of Ordinary Shares by a Shareholder who is resident for tax purposes in the UK, may, depending upon the Shareholder’s circumstances and subject to available exemptions or reliefs, give rise to a chargeable gain or allowable loss for the purposes of the UK taxation of chargeable gains. 2.2 For UK resident individual Shareholders, any chargeable gain arising after taking account of reliefs and exemptions will be subject to capital gains tax at the rate of 18 per cent. or, for higher rate taxpayers, 28 per cent. Personal representatives and trustees will also pay capital gains tax at a flat rate of 28 per cent. 2.3 For UK resident Shareholders within the charge to corporation tax, an indexation allowance may be available to reduce the amount of the chargeable gain realised on a disposal of the Ordinary Shares. Some corporate Shareholders may qualify for the substantial shareholding exemption or other reliefs on a disposal of Ordinary Shares. Stamp duty and stamp duty reserve tax The following comments are intended as a guide only to the general UK stamp duty and Stamp Duty Reserve Tax (“SDRT”) position and do not relate to persons such as market makers, brokers, dealers, intermediaries, persons connected with depositary arrangements or clearance services or persons who enter into sale and repurchase transactions in respect of the Ordinary Shares or Depositary Interests, to whom special rules apply. 3.1 No UK stamp duty or SDRT will generally be payable in relation to the issue of Ordinary Shares by the Company. 3.2 UK stamp duty applies to documents executed in the UK or where there is any matter or thing to be done in the UK. UK SDRT applies, inter alia, to shares and securities transferred electronically through the UK Central Securities Depository, CREST. Shares and securities are generally excluded from the scope of SDRT if they are in a company which is not incorporated in the UK, not registered on a UK register and not paired with shares or securities in a company incorporated in the UK. 3.3 The transfer of Ordinary Shares in a company where the share register is held in the UK will generally give rise to a liability on the purchaser to stamp duty at the rate of 0.5 per cent. of the consideration (rounded up to the nearest multiple of £5), or, if an unconditional agreement to transfer such shares is not completed by a duly stamped transfer, SDRT, generally at the rate of 0.5 per cent. of the consideration. However, stamp duty only applies where the consideration for the transfer is £1,000 or more. 3.4 UK SDRT will generally be payable on an unconditional agreement to transfer Depositary Interests at a rate of 0.5 per cent. of the consideration paid. This is on the basis that the Ordinary Shares will need to be represented by Depositary Interests issued by the Depositary in order to be held in CREST and that the conditions for exemption from charge set out in the SDRT (UK Depositary Interests in Foreign Securities) Regulations 1999 are not satisfied. 47 Page 3.5 On 20 March 2013, it was announced in the Budget 2013 that the UK Government intends, following consultation, to abolish SDRT on shares quoted on AIM from April 2014. Although specific mention of depositary interests has not been made in the UK Government’s announcements, it is anticipated that any such abolition of SDRT would also apply to depositary interests quoted on AIM. 3.6 Shareholders should seek their own professional advice as to any stamp duty, SDRT or other tax consequences of the conversion of the Ordinary Shares from uncertificated to book-entry form, and vice versa. 3.7 No Luxembourg registration duties or similar taxes should be levied on the transfer of the Ordinary Shares. 48 Page PART V FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON RM2 Section A: Accountant’s report on the historical financial information on RM2 An insnct for growth The Directors RM2 International S.A. 5, rue de la Chapelle L‐1325 Luxembourg Transaction Advisory Services Grant Thornton UK LLP 30 Finsbury Square London EC2P 2YU T +44 (0)20 7383 5100 F +44 (0)20 7184 4301 www.grant‐thornton.co.uk 17 December 2013 Dear Sirs, RM2 International S.A. (the Company) and its subsidiary undertakings (together the Group) We report on the financial information set out in Part V Section B of the AIM Admission Document dated 17 December 2013 (the “Admission Document”), for the years ended 31 December 2010, 31 December 2011 and 31 December 2012 (the “Financial Information”). This Financial Information has been prepared for inclusion in the Admission Document on the basis of the accounting policies set out in note 2 of the Financial Information. This report is required by Paragraph (a) of Schedule Two of the AIM Rules for Companies and is given for the purpose of complying with that paragraph and for no other purpose. Responsibilities Save for any responsibility arising under Paragraph (a) of Schedule Two of the AIM Rules for Companies to any person as and to the extent there provided, to the fullest extent permitted by law we do not assume any responsibility and will not accept any liability to any other person for any loss suffered by any such other person as a result of, arising out of, or in connection with this report or our statement, required by and given solely for the purposes of complying Paragraph (a) of Schedule Two of the AIM Rules for Companies, consenting to its inclusion in the AIM Admission Document. The Directors of RM2 International S.A. are responsible for preparing the Financial Information in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards as adopted by the European Union. It is our responsibility to form an opinion on the Financial Information and to report our opinion to you. Basis of opinion We conducted our work in accordance with the Standards for Investment Reporting issued by the Auditing Practices Board in the United Kingdom. Our work included an assessment of evidence relevant to the amounts and disclosures in the Financial Information. It also included an assessment of the significant estimates and judgements made by those responsible for the Chartered Accountants Member firm within Grant Thornton International Ltd Grant Thornton UK LLP is a limited liability partnership registered in England and Wales: No. OC307742. Registered office: Grant Thornton House, Melton Street, Euston Square, London NW1 2EP A list of members is available from our registered office. Grant Thornton UK LLP is authorised and regulated by the Financial Services Authority for investment business. 49 Page preparation of the Financial Information and whether the accounting policies are appropriate to the entity’s circumstances, consistently applied and adequately disclosed. We planned and performed our work so as to obtain all the information and explanations which we considered necessary in order to provide us with sufficient evidence to give reasonable assurance that the financial information is free from material misstatement, whether caused by fraud or other irregularity or error. Opinion In our opinion, the Financial Information gives, for the purposes of the Admission Document, a true and fair view of the state of affairs of the Group as at 31 December 2010, 31 December 2011 and 31 December 2012 and of its losses, cash flows, recognised gains and losses and changes in equity for the periods then ended in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards adopted by the European Union and has been prepared in a form that is consistent with the accounting policies disclosed in the Financial Information. Declaration For the purposes of Paragraph (a) of Schedule Two of the AIM Rules for Companies we are responsible for this report as part of the Admission Document and declare that we have taken all reasonable care to ensure that the information contained in this report is, to the best of our knowledge, in accordance with the facts and contains no omission likely to affect its import. This declaration is included in the Admission Document in compliance with Schedule Two of the AIM Rules for Companies. Yours faithfully GRANT THORNTON UK LLP 50 Page Section B: Historical consolidated financial information on RM2 for the three years ended 31 December 2012 The financial information set out below of the Company for the three years ended 31 December 2012 has been prepared by the Directors on the basis set out in note 2. The accompanying notes represent an integral part of the financial information. The financial information contained within this section does not constitute statutory financial accounts within the meaning of section 434 of the Act. Consolidated statement of comprehensive income Continuing operations Revenue Cost of sales NOTES 2010 USD 2011 USD 2012 USD 15 – – – – – – Gross profit Selling and distribution expenses Administrative expenses Other operating expenses Other operating income 16 16 16 16 – (519,538) (4,256,133) (683,302) – – (871,067) (4,397,857) (3,815,808) 92,603 – (838,331) (7,772,484) (2,007,795) 2,326,259 Operating loss Impairment of financial asset Finance costs Finance income 9 16 16 (5,458,973) – (1,513,406) 265,604 (8,992,129) – (2,605,641) 29,110 (8,292,351) (13,500,000) (410,218) 909,013 (6,706,775) (11,568,660) (21,293,556) (1,489) (11,598) (16,556) (6,708,264) (11,580,258) (21,310,112) Loss before tax Income tax 17 Loss for the year Other comprehensive income Exchange difference on translation of foreign operations 528,105 99,090 (188,516) Other comprehensive income for the year, net of tax 528,105 99,090 (188,516) Total comprehensive income for the year (6,180,159) (11,481,168) (21,498,628) Loss for the year attributable to: Equity holders of the parent Non‐controlling interests (6,708,251) (13) (11,579,257) (1,001) (21,310,522) 410 (6,708,264) (11,580,258) (21,310,112) (6,180,146) (13) (11,480,167) (1,001) (21,499,038) 410 (6,180,159) (11,481,168) (21,498,628) (60.98) (100.38) (0.16) Total comprehensive income for the year attributable to: Equity holders of the parent Non‐controlling interests Earnings per share Basic and diluted earnings per share attributable to ordinary equity holders of the parent 20 51 Page Consolidated statement of financial position NOTES 2009 USD 2010 USD 2011 USD 2012 USD 6 7 8 9 4,233,074 – – – 15,429,775 1,583,240 21,272 – 21,566,767 1,593,255 33,390 – 9,611,640 1,597,054 39,233 851,587 4,233,074 17,034,287 23,193,412 12,099,514 – 1,422,106 8,708 1,770,523 – 980,251 50,150 3,151,394 – 2,643,964 46,418 15,852,154 – 2,543,640 4,755,051 864,402 3,201,337 4,181,795 18,542,536 8,163,093 7,434,411 21,216,082 41,735,948 20,262,607 100,020 10,388,066 (2,671,327) (661,842) 110,000 10,860,356 (9,379,578) (133,737) 122,860 55,857,496 (20,958,835) (34,647) 55,287,000 693,356 (42,269,357) (223,163) Equity attributable to equity holders of the parent Non‐controlling interests 7,154,917 – 1,457,041 70,755 34,986,874 69,754 13,487,836 70,164 Total equity 7,154,917 1,527,796 35,056,628 13,558,000 – 2,232,736 2,235,017 2,299,304 – 2,232,736 2,235,017 2,299,304 84,819 189,305 5,370 16,171,709 1,281,939 1,902 2,124,152 2,287,363 32,788 2,779,495 1,425,477 200,331 279,494 17,455,550 4,444,303 4,405,303 279,494 19,688,286 6,679,320 6,704,607 7,434,411 21,216,082 41,735,948 20,262,607 Assets Non-current assets Property, plant & equipment Investment property Intangible assets Other non‐current financial assets Current assets Inventories Trade and other receivables Other current financial assets Cash and cash equivalents 10 11 9 12 Total assets Equity and liabilities Equity Issued capital Share premium Retained earnings Foreign currency translation reserve Non-current liabilities Interest bearing loans and borrowings Current liabilities Interest bearing loans and borrowings Trade and other payables Current tax liabilities Total liabilities Total equity and liabilities 13 9 9 14 52 Page Consolidated statement of changes in equity ATTRIBUTABLE TO EQUITY HOLDERS OF THE PARENT FOREIGN CURRENCY NON‐ SHARE SHARE RETAINED TRANSLATION CONTROLLING TOTAL CAPITAL PREMIUM EARNINGS RESERVE INTERESTS EQUITY USD USD USD USD USD USD 100,020 – – 10,388,066 – – (2,671,327) (6,708,251) – (661,842) – 528,105 7,154,917 (6,708,251) 528,105 – (13) – 7,154,917 (6,708,264) 528,105 – 9,980 – – 472,290 – (6,708,251) – – 528,105 – – (6,180,146) 482,270 – (13) – 70,768 (6,180,159) 482,270 70,768 Transaction with owners 9,980 472,290 As at 31 December 2010 110,000 10,860,356 (9,379,578) Loss for the year Other comprehensive income – – – – Total comprehensive income – NOTES As at 1 January 2010 Loss for the year Other comprehensive income Total comprehensive income Capital increase Incorporation of a subsidiary 13 482,270 70,768 553,038 (133,737) 1,457,041 70,755 1,527,796 (11,579,257) – – 99,090 (11,579,257) 99,090 (1,001) – (11,580,258) 99,090 – (11,579,257) 99,090 (11,480,167) (1,001) (11,481,168) 12,860 44,997,140 – – 45,010,000 – 45,010,000 Transaction with owners 12,860 44,997,140 – – 45,010,000 – 45,010,000 As at 31 December 2011 122,860 55,857,496 (20,958,835) (34,647) 34,986,874 69,754 35,056,628 (Loss)/profit for the year Other comprehensive income – – – – (21,310,522) – – (188,516) (21,310,522) (188,516) 410 – (21,310,112) (188,516) Total comprehensive income – – (21,310,522) (188,516) (21,499,038) 410 (21,498,628) Capital increase Conversion of share premium to share capital 13 13 – – TOTAL USD 55,164,140 (55,164,140) – – – – – Transaction with owners 55,164,140 (55,164,140) – – – – – As at 31 December 2012 55,287,000 13,487,836 70,164 13,558,000 693,356 (42,269,357) (223,163) 53 Page Consolidated statement of cash flows NOTES Cash flows from operating activities Loss before tax Non-cash adjustment to reconcile profit before tax to net cash flows Impairment of non‐current assets Impairment of financial assets Amortisation and depreciation of non‐current assets Loss on receivables Provision for inventory obsolescence Finance income Finance expenses Unrealised foreign exchange losses/(gains) Net gain on disposal of PPE and intangible assets 2010 USD (6,706,775) 2011 USD 2012 USD (11,568,660) (21,293,555) 3,537,463 – – 13,500,000 58,563 179,500 – (113) 1,474,216 659,724 – 154,312 – – (169) 2,391,169 127,531 – 494,468 – 1,447,797 (265,964) 55,851 (130,625) (1,991,399) – 135,134 290,262 – (1,663,713) 16,320 (1,447,797) 102,433 189,190 (4,965) (1,292) (16,187) Net cash flows from operating activities (3,914,454) (7,007,039) (9,355,788) Cash flows from investing activities Net (purchase of)/proceeds from intangible assets Purchase of PPE under construction Net (purchase of)/proceeds from other PPE Purchase of investment property Purchase of investments Loans granted to third parties (24,272) (8,697,446) (1,769,935) (1,583,240) – (41,442) (14,517) (8,600,873) (161,606) (50,868) – 3,733 (8,243) (2,885,998) (1,238,125) (47,002) (60,587) (2,051,929) 6 6/7/8 Variation in working capital (Increase)/decrease in inventories (Increase)/decrease in trade and other receivables Increase/(decrease) in trade and other payables Income tax paid Interest received 756 Net cash flows from investing activities Cash flows from financing activities Issuance of capital Capital subscribed by non–controlling interest Proceeds from bank borrowings Proceeds from other and related party borrowings Repayment of other and related party borrowings – – 13 Net transaction costs paid Interest paid 44 14,722 (12,115,579) (8,824,087) 482,270 70,768 2,232,736 15,228,263 – 45,010,000 – – 1,161,000 (14,350,000) – – – 655,219 – (166,526) (3,079,925) – (55,851) 599,368 (599,855) (4,990) (6,277,162) Net cash flows from financing activities 17,409,192 28,574,549 Net change in cash and cash equivalents 1,379,159 12,743,423 (15,033,582) Increase/decrease in cash and cash equivalents Cash and cash equivalents at 1 January Exchange adjustment of cash and cash equivalents Cash and cash equivalents at 31 December 1,379,159 1,770,523 1,679 3,151,361 12,743,423 3,151,361 (42,700) 15,852,084 (15,033,582) 15,852,084 45,707 864,209 12 54 Page Notes to the consolidated financial information 1. Corporate information The Company is a limited company (Société Anonyme) incorporated and domiciled in Luxembourg with the registration number B132.740. The registered office is located at Rue de la Chapelle 5, L‐1235 Luxembourg. The Company is the ultimate parent entity of the Group. The Group is principally engaged in developing and selling shipping pallets and to provide related logistical services. 2. Basis of preparation This historical financial information comprises the consolidated financial information of the Group as at 31 December for each of the three years 2010, 2011 and 2012 and is prepared under the historic cost convention with the exception of certain items which are measured at fair value as disclosed in the accounting policies below. The historical financial information has been prepared solely for the purposes of the admission document. The accounting policies which follow set out the policies applied in preparing the historical financial information. The historical financial information is presented in USD which is also the functional currency of the Company. Statement of compliance The historical financial information has been prepared in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards (“IFRS”) as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board (“IASB”) and as adopted by the European Union (“EU”) and IFRIC interpretations. Basis of consolidation The consolidated financial information comprises the financial information of the Group and its subsidiaries. Subsidiaries are consolidated from the date of acquisition, being the date on which the Group obtains control, and continue to be consolidated until the date when such control ceases. The financial information of the subsidiaries is prepared for the same reporting period as the parent company, using consistent accounting policies. All intra‐group balances, transactions, unrealised gains and losses resulting from intra‐group transactions and dividends are eliminated in full. Total comprehensive income within a subsidiary is attributed to the non‐controlling interest even if it results in a deficit balance. Subsidiaries and business combinations Subsidiaries are all entities over which the Group has the power to govern the financial and operating policies generally accompanying a shareholding of more than one half of the voting rights. Subsidiaries are fully consolidated from the date on which control is transferred to the Group. They are de‐consolidated from the date that control ceases. The Group uses the purchase method of accounting to account for the acquisition of subsidiaries. The cost of an acquisition is measured as the fair value of the assets given, equity instruments issued and liabilities incurred or assumed at the date of exchange. Identifiable assets acquired and liabilities and contingent liabilities assumed in a business combination are measured initially at their fair values at the acquisition date, irrespective of the extent of any non‐controlling interest. The excess of the cost of the acquisition over the fair value of the Group’s share of the identifiable net assets acquired is recorded as goodwill. If the cost of acquisition is less than the fair value of the net assets of the subsidiary acquired, the difference is recognised directly in the statement of comprehensive income. Inter‐company transactions, balances and unrealised gains on transactions between group companies are eliminated. Unrealised losses are also eliminated unless the transaction provides evidence of an impairment of the asset transferred. Accounting policies of subsidiaries have been changed where necessary to ensure consistency with the policies adopted by the Group. The subsidiaries of the Group are listed in note 23. 55 Page 3. Summary of significant accounting policies The principal accounting policies are summarised below: Foreign currencies The Group’s consolidated financial information is presented in USD, which is also the parent company’s functional currency. For each entity the Group determines the functional currency and items included in the financial statements of each entity are measured using that functional currency. Transactions and balances Transactions in foreign currencies are initially recorded by the Group’s entities at their respective functional currency spot rates at the date the transaction first qualifies for recognition. Monetary assets and liabilities denominated in foreign currencies are translated at the functional currency spot rates of exchange at the reporting date. Differences arising on settlement or translation of monetary items are recognised in profit or loss. These are recognised in other comprehensive income until the net investment is disposed of, at which time, the cumulative amount is reclassified to profit or loss. Tax charges and credits attributable to exchange differences on those monetary items are also recorded in other comprehensive income. Non‐monetary items that are measured in terms of historical cost in a foreign currency are translated using the exchange rates at the dates of the initial transactions. Non‐monetary items measured at fair value in a foreign currency are translated using the exchange rates at the date when the fair value is determined. The gain or loss arising on translation of non‐monetary items measured at fair value is treated in line with the recognition of gain or loss on change in fair value of the item (i.e., translation differences on items whose fair value gain or loss is recognised in other comprehensive income or profit or loss are also recognised in other comprehensive income or profit or loss, respectively). Any goodwill arising on the acquisition of a foreign operation and any fair value adjustments to the carrying amounts of assets and liabilities arising on the acquisition are treated as assets and liabilities of the foreign operation and translated at the spot rate of exchange at the reporting date. Group companies On consolidation, the assets and liabilities of foreign operations are translated into USD at the rate of exchange prevailing at the reporting date and their income statements are translated at exchange rates prevailing at the dates of the transactions. The exchange differences arising on translation for consolidation are recognised in other comprehensive income. On disposal of a foreign operation, the component of other comprehensive income relating to that particular foreign operation is recognised in profit or loss. Going concern The financial information has been prepared assuming the Group will continue as a going concern. Under the going concern assumption, an entity is ordinarily viewed as continuing in business for the foreseeable future with neither the intention nor the necessity of liquidation, ceasing trading or seeking protection from creditors pursuant to laws or regulations. In assessing whether the going concern assumption is appropriate, management has considered the company’s existing working capital and management are of the opinion that the Group has adequate resources to undertake its planned programme of activities for the 12 months from the date of approval of the consolidated financial information. Property, plant and equipment Initial recognition and measurement Property, plant and equipment (“PPE”) are tangible assets used by the Group for its own production or supply of goods or services, or for administrative purposes and are expected to be used during more than one period. PPE is recognised when it is probable that future economic benefits associated with the asset will flow to the Group and if the cost can be measured reliably. 56 Page PPE is initially recognised at cost. Such cost includes the purchase price and all cost incurred in bringing the assets to the location and condition for their operation in the manner intended by management. The cost of the PPE also includes the borrowing costs for long‐term construction projects if the recognition criteria are met. The Group has recognised most of the inventory costs within the cost of the property, plant and equipment for which the inventories have been used in order to produce samples which are considered as part of the cost of the property, plant and equipment. When significant parts of property, plant and equipment will be required to be replaced, the Group will recognise such parts as individual assets with specific useful lives and depreciate them accordingly. Likewise, when a major inspection will be performed, its cost will be recognised in the carrying amount of the plant and equipment as a replacement if the recognition criteria is satisfied. All other repair and maintenance costs will be recognised in profit or loss as incurred. The present value of the expected cost for the decommissioning of an asset after its use will be included in the cost of the respective asset if the recognition criteria for a provision is met. Subsequent measurement PPE is subsequently measured at cost less any accumulated depreciation and any accumulated impairment losses. Depreciation is calculated on a straight‐line basis over the estimated useful lives of the assets as follows: Buildings Plant and equipment 30 years 3 to 20 years PPE under construction is not depreciated. An item of PPE and any significant part initially recognised is derecognised upon disposal or when no future economic benefits are expected from its use or disposal. Any gain or loss arising on derecognition of the asset (calculated as the difference between the net disposal proceeds and the carrying amount of the asset) is included in profit or loss when the asset is derecognised. The residual values, useful lives and methods of depreciation of PPE are reviewed at each financial year end and adjusted prospectively, if appropriate. Further explanation on management estimates and assumptions is disclosed in note 4. The Group has not applied revaluation on any of its PPE. Leases The determination of whether an arrangement is, or contains, a lease is based on the substance of the arrangement at the inception date. The arrangement is assessed for whether fulfilment of the arrangement is dependent on the use of a specific asset or assets or the arrangement conveys a right to use the asset or assets, even if that right is not explicitly specified in an arrangement. Group as a lessee Leases where a significant portion of the risks and rewards of ownership is retained by the lessor are classified as operating leases. Payments made under operating leases are charged to profit or loss on a straight‐line basis over the period of the lease. Leases of property, plant and equipment where the Group has substantially all the risks and rewards of ownership are classified as finance leases. Finance leases are capitalised at the lease’s commencement date at the lower of the fair value of the leased property or the present value of the minimum lease payments. Each lease payment is allocated between the liability and finance charges so as to achieve a constant rate on the finance balance outstanding. The corresponding rental obligations, net of finance charges, are included in long‐term and short‐term borrowings. The interest element of the finance cost is charged to the profit or loss over the lease period so as to produce a constant periodic rate of interest on the remaining balance of the liability for each period. The property, plant and equipment acquired under finance leases are depreciated over the shorter of the useful life of the asset or the lease term. The Group does not have any assets under financial lease. 57 Page Borrowing costs Borrowing costs directly attributable to the acquisition, construction or production of an asset that necessarily takes a substantial period of time to get ready for its intended use or sale are capitalised as part of the cost of the asset. All other borrowing costs are expensed in the period in which they occur. Borrowing costs consist of interest and other costs that an entity incurs in connection with the borrowing of funds. The group was in the start up phase during the three years ended 31 December 2012. Cash from borrowings was primarily used to explore opportunities, pay salaries and other operating expenses. No specific borrowings were made for the construction or production of an asset. Therefore, the Group did not capitalise any borrowing costs during any period up to this date. Investment property Investment properties are measured initially at cost, including transaction costs. Subsequent to initial recognition, the Group has decided to measure investment properties using the cost model. Investment properties are measured similarly to property, plant and equipment. The fair value, which reflects market conditions at the reporting date, is disclosed in the notes to the consolidated financial information. Investment properties are derecognised either when they have been disposed of or when they are permanently withdrawn from use and no future economic benefit is expected from their disposal. The difference between the net disposal proceeds and the carrying amount of the asset is recognised in the income statement in the period of derecognition. Transfers are made to or from investment property only when there is a change in use. For a transfer from investment property to owner‐occupied property, the deemed cost for subsequent accounting is the fair value at the date of change in use. If owner‐occupied property becomes an investment property, the Group accounts for such property in accordance with the policy stated under property, plant and equipment up to the date of change in use. Intangible assets Intangible assets acquired separately are measured on initial recognition at cost. The cost of intangible assets acquired in a business combination is its fair value as at the date of acquisition. Following initial recognition, intangible assets are carried at cost less any accumulated amortisation and accumulated impairment losses, if any. The useful lives of intangible assets are assessed as finite. Intangible assets with finite lives are amortised over the useful economic life and assessed for impairment whenever there is an indication that the intangible asset may be impaired. The amortisation period and the amortisation method for an intangible asset with a finite useful life are reviewed at least at the end of each reporting period. Changes in the expected useful life or the expected pattern of consumption of future economic benefits embodied in the asset is accounted for by changing the amortisation period or method, as appropriate, and are treated as changes in accounting estimates. The amortisation expense on intangible assets with finite lives is recognised in profit or loss in the expense category consistent with the function of the intangible assets. Intangible assets with indefinite useful lives are not amortised, but are tested for impairment annually, either individually or at the cash‐generating unit level. The assessment of indefinite life is reviewed annually to determine whether the indefinite life continues to be supportable. If not, the change in useful life from indefinite to definite is made on a prospective basis. Gains or losses arising from derecognition of an intangible asset are measured as the difference between the net disposal proceeds and the carrying amount of the asset and are recognised in profit or loss when the asset is derecognised. 58 Page Amortisation is calculated on the straight‐line method to write off the cost of each asset to their residual values, over their estimated useful life. The annual amortisation periods are as follows: Licences Other 3 to 5 years 2 to 5 years Research and development costs Research costs are expensed as incurred. Development expenditures on an individual project are considered as an intangible asset when the Group can demonstrate: • The technical feasibility of completing the intangible asset so that the asset will be available for use or sale. • Its intention to complete and its ability to use or sell the asset. • How the asset will generate future economic benefits. • The availability of resources to complete the asset. • The ability to measure reliably the expenditure during development. Following initial recognition of the development expenditure as an asset, the asset is carried at cost less any accumulated amortisation and accumulated impairment losses. Amortisation of the asset begins when development is complete and the asset is available for use. It is amortised over the period of expected future benefit. Amortisation is recorded in cost of sales. During the period of development, the asset is tested for impairment annually. To date no amounts have been capitalised in respect of the development phase of internal projects as management have assessed that they are unable to demonstrate that they have met all of the recognition criteria. Inventories Inventories are stated at the lower of cost or net realisable value. Costs incurred in bringing each product to its present location and condition are accounted for as follows: Raw materials: Purchase cost on a first in, first out basis. Finished goods and work in progress: Cost of direct materials and labour and a proportion of manufacturing overheads based on the normal operating capacity, but excluding borrowing costs. Net realisable value is the estimated selling price in the ordinary course of business, less estimated costs of completion and the estimated costs necessary to make the sale. When the net realisable value of stock is lower than its cost, provisions for impairment are created to reduce the value of the stock to its net realisable value. The cost of inventories is recognised as an expense in the period in which the related revenue is recognised. Impairment on non-financial assets Assets that are subject to amortisation and other non‐financial assets, such as inventory, are reviewed for impairment whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying amount may not be recoverable. An impairment loss is recognised for the amount by which the carrying amount of the asset exceeds its recoverable amount, which is the higher of an asset’s net selling price and value in use or fair value less cost to sell determined by using discounted cash flow method. For the purposes of assessing impairment, assets are grouped at the lowest levels for which there are separately identifiable cash flows (cash generating units). The key assumptions used in the computation of the value in use or fair value less cost to sell of an asset are detailed in the note on intangible assets. The future discounted cash flow method used to determine the value in use or fair value less cost to sell is usually, but not always, based on cash flow projections for the next 5 years. 59 Page Impairment losses of continuing operations, including impairment of inventories, are recognised in profit or loss in those expense categories consistent with the function of the impaired asset. For assets excluding goodwill, an assessment is made at each reporting date as to whether there is any indication that previously recognised impairment losses may no longer exist or may have decreased. If such indication exists, the Group estimates the asset’s or cash‐generating unit’s recoverable amount. A previously recognised impairment loss is reversed only if there has been a change in the assumptions used to determine the asset’s recoverable amount since the last impairment loss recognised. The reversal is limited so that the carrying amount of the asset does not exceed its recoverable amount, nor exceed the carrying amount that would have been determined, net of depreciation, had no impairment loss been recognised for the asset in prior years. Such reversal is recognised in profit or loss unless the asset is carried at a revalued amount, in which case the reversal is treated as a revaluation reserve. Financial instruments Financial assets (i) Initial recognition and measurement The Group classifies its financial assets in the following categories: at fair value through profit and loss, loans and receivables, held‐to‐maturity investments and available‐for‐sale. The classification depends on the purpose for which the financial assets were acquired. Management determines the classification of its financial assets at initial recognition and re‐evaluates this designation at every reporting date. All financial assets are recognised initially at fair value plus, in the case of investments not fair value through profit or loss, directly attributable transaction costs. The Group’s financial assets include cash and short‐term deposits, trade and other receivables, other current and non‐current assets which are classified in the category of loans and receivables and available‐for‐sale financial assets. The Group does not have held‐to‐maturity investments. (ii) Subsequent measurement ii.1. Financial assets at fair value through profit or loss: This category has two sub‐categories: “financial assets held for trading”, and those designated at fair value through profit and loss at inception. A financial asset is classified in this category if acquired principally for the purpose of selling in the short term or is so designated by management. This category includes derivative financial instruments entered into by the Group that are not designated as hedging instruments in hedge relationships as defined by IAS 39. Assets in this category are classified as current assets if they are either held for trading or are expected to be realised within 12 months of the balance sheet date. Financial assets at fair value through profit or loss are carried in the statement of financial position at fair value with changes in fair value recognised in finance income or finance costs in the statement of comprehensive income. The fair values of quoted investments are based on current bid prices. If the market for a financial asset is not active (and for unlisted securities), the Group establishes fair value by using valuation techniques. These include the use of recent arm’s length transactions, reference to other instruments that are substantially the same and discounted cash flow analysis, making maximum use of market inputs and relying as little as possible on entity‐specific inputs. The Group has no financial assets designated as held for trading. ii.2. Loans and receivables: Loans and receivables are non‐derivative financial assets with fixed or determinable payments that are not quoted in an active market. They are included in current assets except for maturities greater than 12 months after the balance sheet date. These are classified as non‐current assets. 60 Page After initial measurement, they are subsequently measured at amortised cost using the effective interest rate method (EIR), less impairment. Amortised cost is calculated by taking into account any discount or premium on acquisition and fees or costs that are an integral part of the EIR. The EIR amortisation is included in finance income in the statement of comprehensive income. The losses arising from impairment are recognised in the finance costs in the statement of comprehensive income. ii.3. Available-for-sale financial assets: Available‐for‐sale financial investments include equity and debt securities. Equity investments classified as available‐for‐sale are those, which are neither classified as held for trading nor designated at fair value through profit or loss. Debt securities in this category are those which are intended to be held for an indefinite period of time and which may be sold in response to needs for liquidity or in response to changes in the market conditions. After initial measurement, available‐for‐sale financial investments are subsequently measured at fair value with unrealised gains or losses recognised as other comprehensive income in the available‐for‐ sale reserve until the investment is derecognised, at which time the cumulative gain or loss is recognised in other operating income, or determined to be impaired, at which time the cumulative loss is reclassified to the statement of comprehensive income in finance costs and removed from available‐for‐ sale reserve. (iii) De-recognition A financial asset is derecognised when: The rights to receive cash flows from the asset have expired. The Group has transferred its rights to receive cash flows from the asset or has assumed an obligation to pay the received cash flows in full without material delay to a third party under a ‘pass‐through’ arrangement; and either (a) the Group has transferred substantially all the risks and rewards of the asset, or (b) the Group has neither transferred nor retained substantially all the risks and rewards of the asset, but has transferred control of the asset. When the Group has transferred its rights to receive cash flows from an asset or has entered into a ‘pass‐through’ arrangement, and has neither transferred nor retained substantially all of the risks and rewards of the asset nor transferred control of the asset, the asset is recognised to the extent of the Group’s continuing involvement in the asset. In that case, the Group also recognises an associated liability. The transferred asset and the associated liability are measured on a basis that reflects the rights and obligations that the Group has retained. Continuing involvement that takes the form of a guarantee over the transferred asset is measured at the lower of the original carrying amount of the asset and the maximum amount of consideration that the Group could be required to repay. (iv) Impairment of financial assets The Group assesses at each balance sheet date whether there is objective evidence that a financial asset or a group of financial assets is impaired. A financial asset or a group of financial assets is deemed to be impaired if, and only if there is objective evidence of impairment as a result of one or more events that have occurred after the initial recognition of the asset and that event has an impact on the estimated future cash flows of the financial asset or the group of financial assets that can be reliably estimated. Evidence of impairment may include, but is not limited to, indications that the debtors or a group of debtors are experiencing significant financial difficulty, default or delinquency in interest or principal payments. iv.1. Financial assets carried at amortised cost: For financial assets carried at amortised cost, the Group first assesses whether objective evidence of impairment exists individually for financial assets that are individually significant, or collectively for 61 Page financial assets that are not individually significant. If the Group determines that no objective evidence of impairment exists for an individually assessed financial asset, whether significant or not, it includes the asset in a group of financial assets with similar credit risk characteristics and collectively assesses them for impairment. Assets that are individually assessed for impairment and for which an impairment loss is, or continues to be, recognised are not included in a collective assessment of impairment. If there is objective evidence that an impairment loss has been incurred, the amount of the loss is measured as the difference between the assets carrying amount and the present value of estimated future cash flows (excluding future expected credit losses that have not yet been incurred). The present value of the estimated future cash flows is discounted at the financial assets original effective interest rate. If a loan has a variable interest rate, the discount rate for measuring any impairment loss is the current effective interest rate. The carrying amount of the asset is reduced through the use of an allowance account and the amount of the loss is recognised in the statement of comprehensive income. Interest income continues to be accrued on the reduced carrying amount and is accrued using the interest used to discount the future cash flows for the purpose of measuring the impairment loss. The interest income is recorded as part of finance income in the statement of comprehensive income. Loans together with the associated allowance are written off when there is no realistic prospect of future recovery and all collateral has been realised or has been transferred to the Group. If, in a subsequent year, the amount of the estimated impairment loss increases or decreases because of an event occurring after the impairment was recognised, the previously recognised impairment loss is increased or reduced by adjusting the allowance account. If a future write‐off is later recovered, the recovery is credited to finance costs in the statement of comprehensive income. iv.2. Available-for-sale financial investments: In the case of equity securities classified as available for sale, a significant or prolonged decline in the fair value of the security below its cost is considered as an indicator that the securities are impaired. ‘Significant’ is evaluated against the original cost of the investment and ‘prolonged’ against the period in which the fair value has been below its original cost. If any such evidence exists for available‐for‐sale financial assets, the cumulative loss – measured as the difference between the acquisition cost and the current fair value, less any impairment loss on that financial asset previously recognised in profit and loss – is removed from equity and recognised in the statement of comprehensive income. Impairment losses recognised on equity instruments are not reversed through the statement of comprehensive income. Increases in their value after impairment are recognised directly in other comprehensive income. In the case of debt instruments classified as available‐for‐sale, impairment is assessed based on the same criteria as financial assets carried at amortised cost. However, the amount recorded for impairment is the cumulative loss measured as the difference between the amortised cost and the current fair value, less any impairment loss on that investment previously recognised in the statement of comprehensive income. Future interest income continues to be accrued based on the reduced carrying amount of the asset, using the rate of interest used to discount the future cash flows for the purpose of measuring the impairment loss. The interest income is recorded as part of finance income in the statement of comprehensive income. If, in a subsequent year, the fair value of a debt instrument increases and the increase can be objectively related to an event occurring after the impairment loss was recognised in the statement of comprehensive income, the impairment loss is reversed through the statement of comprehensive income. 62 Page Financial liabilities (i) Initial recognition and measurement Financial liabilities are classified as financial liabilities at fair value through profit or loss, loans and borrowings, or as derivatives designated as hedging instruments in an effective hedge, as appropriate. The Group determines the classification of its financial liabilities at initial recognition. All financial liabilities are recognised initially at fair value and in the case of loans and borrowings, plus directly attributable transaction costs. The Group’s financial liabilities include trade and other payables, borrowings and long‐term payables. (ii) Subsequent measurement The measurement of financial liabilities depends on their classification as follows: ii.1. Financial liabilities at fair value through profit or loss Financial liabilities at fair value through profit or loss include financial liabilities held for trading and financial liabilities designated upon initial recognition as at fair value through profit or loss. Financial liabilities are classified as held for trading if they are acquired for the purpose of selling in the near term. This category includes derivatives financial instruments entered into by the Group that are not designated as hedging instruments in hedge relationships as defined by IAS 39. Separated embedded derivatives are also classified as held for trading unless they are designated as effective hedging instruments. Gains or losses on liabilities held for trading are recognised in the statement of comprehensive income. The Group has not designated any financial liabilities upon initial recognition as at fair value through profit or loss. ii.2. Loans and borrowings After initial recognition, interest bearing loans and borrowings are subsequently measured at amortised cost using the effective interest rate method (EIR). Gains and losses are recognised in the statement of comprehensive income when the liabilities are derecognised as well as through the effective interest rate method amortisation process. Amortised cost is calculated by taking into account any discount or premium on acquisition and fees or costs that are an integral part of the EIR. The EIR amortisation is included in finance costs in the statement of comprehensive income. Loans and borrowings are classified as current liabilities unless the Group has an unconditional right to defer the settlement of the liability for at least 12 months after the balance sheet date. (iii) De-recognition A financial liability is derecognised when the obligation under the liability is discharged or cancelled or expires. When an existing financial liability is replaced by another from the same lender on substantially different terms, or the terms of an existing liability are subsequently modified, such an exchange or modification is treated as a de‐recognition of the original liability and the recognition of a new liability, and the difference in the respective carrying amounts is recognised in the statement of comprehensive income. 63 Page Offsetting of financial instruments Financial assets and financial liabilities are offset and the net amount reported in the consolidated statement of financial position if, and only if, there is a currently enforceable legal right to offset the recognised amounts and there is an intention to settle on a net basis, or to realise the assets and settle the liabilities simultaneously. Fair value of financial instruments The fair values of quoted investments are based on current bid prices. If the market for a financial asset is not active (and for unlisted securities), the Group establishes fair value by using valuation techniques. These include the use of recent arm’s length transactions, reference to other instruments that are substantially the same and discounted cash flow analysis, making maximum use of market inputs and relying as little as possible on entity‐ specific inputs. Trade receivables Trade receivables are carried at original invoice amount less provision made for impairment of these receivables. A provision for impairment of trade receivables is established when there is objective evidence that the Group will not be able to collect all the amounts due according to the original terms of receivables. The amount of the provision is the difference between the carrying amount and the recoverable amount, being the present value of expected cash flows, discounted at the effective interest rate for similar borrowers. The amount of the provision is recognised in the statement of comprehensive income. Cash and cash equivalents Cash and cash equivalents are carried in the statement of financial position at fair value. For the purposes of the cash flow statement, cash and cash equivalents comprise of cash on hand and deposits held on call with banks having an original maturity of 3 months of less. In the statement of financial position, bank overdrafts are included in borrowings under current liabilities net of any related restricted cash. Taxes Current income tax Current income tax assets and liabilities for the current period are measured at the amount expected to be recovered from or paid to the taxation authorities. A provision is made for corporation tax for the reporting period using the tax rates that have been substantially enacted for each company at the reporting date in the country where each company operates and generate taxable income. Current income tax relating to items recognised directly in equity is recognised in equity and not in the statement of comprehensive income. Management periodically evaluates positions taken in the tax returns with respect to situations in which applicable tax regulations are subject to interpretations and establishes provisions where appropriate. Deferred income tax Deferred income tax is provided for using the liability method on all temporary differences arising from tax bases of assets and liabilities and the carrying amounts in the financial statements. The deferred tax is calculated on currently enacted tax rates that are expected to apply when the temporary differences reverse. Where an overall deferred taxation asset arises, it is only recognised in the financial statements where its recoverability is foreseen with reasonable certainty. Deferred income tax is provided on temporary difference arising on investments in subsidiaries except where the timing of the reversal of the temporary difference is controlled by the Group and it is probable that the temporary difference will not reverse in the foreseeable future. 64 Page Pensions and other post-employment benefits The Group does not operate any defined benefit pension plan nor provide certain additional post employment healthcare benefits to employees. Provisions, contingent assets and liabilities Provisions Provisions are recognised when the Group has a present legal or constructive obligation as a result of past events, it is probable that an outflow of resources will be required to settle the obligation, and a reliable estimate of the amount of the obligation can be made. Where the Group expects a provision to be reimbursed, for example under an insurance contract, the reimbursement is recognised as a separate asset but only when the reimbursement is virtually certain. The expense relating to any provision is presented in the statement of comprehensive income net of any reimbursement. Provisions are not recognised for future operating losses. Provisions are measured at the estimated expenditure required to settle the present obligation, based on the most reliable evidence available at the reporting date, including the risks and uncertainties associated with the present obligation. Where there are a number of similar obligations, the likelihood that an outflow will be required in settlement is determined by considering the class of obligations as a whole. Provisions are discounted to their present values, where the time value of money is material. Any reimbursement that the Group can be virtually certain to collect from a third party with respect to the obligation is recognised as a separate asset. However, this asset may not exceed the amount of the related provision. In those cases where the possible outflow of economic resources as a result of present obligations is considered improbable or remote, no liability is recognised. Contingent assets Contingent asset is a possible asset that arises from past events and whose existence will be confirmed only by the occurrence or non‐occurrence of one or more uncertain future events not wholly within the control of the entity. Contingent assets are not recognised in the consolidated financial information. However, when the realisation of income from the contingent asset is virtually certain, then the related asset is not a contingent asset and its recognition is appropriate. Contingent liabilities Contingent liability is a possible obligation that arises from past events and whose existence will be confirmed only by the occurrence or non‐occurrence of one or more uncertain future events not wholly within the control of the entity, or is a present obligation that arises from past events but is not recognised because it is not probable that an outflow of resources embodying economic benefits will be required to settle the obligation or the amount of the obligation cannot be measured with sufficient reliability. Contingent liabilities are not recognised in the consolidation financial statements. Equity, reserves and dividend payments Share capital represents the nominal value of shares that have been issued. Share premium includes any premiums received on issue of share capital. Any transaction costs associated with the issuing of shares are deducted from share premium, net of any related income tax benefits. Other components of equity include the following: • Foreign currency translation reserve – comprises foreign currency translation differences arising from the translation of financial statements of the Group’s foreign entities into USD. 65 Page Retained earnings include all current and prior period retained profits and losses. All transactions with owners of the parent are recorded separately within equity. Dividend distributions payable to equity shareholders are included in other liabilities when the dividends have been approved in a general meeting prior to the reporting date. Revenue Revenue is recognised to the extent that it is probable that the economic benefits will flow to the Group and the revenue can be reliably measured, regardless of when the payment is being made. Revenue is measured at the invoiced value for the sale of goods net of value added tax rebates and discounts which represents the fair value of the consideration received or receivable. The Group assesses its revenue arrangements against specific criteria in order to determine if it is acting as principal or agent. The Group has concluded that it is acting as a principal in all of its revenue arrangements. The following specific recognition criteria must also be met before revenue is recognised: Sales of goods Revenue from the sale of goods is recognised when significant risks and rewards of ownership of the goods have been transferred to the buyer and the collectability of the related receivables is reasonably assured, regardless of when the payment was made. The Group has not yet performed sales of goods to a third party as of the date of this consolidated financial information, except for the sale of samples. Interest income For all financial assets at amortised cost and interest bearing financial assets classified as available for sale, interest income is recorded using the effective interest rate method (EIR), which is the rate that exactly discounts the estimated future cash payments or receipts through the expected life of the financial asset or shorter period, where appropriate, to the net carrying amount of the financial asset. Interest income is included in finance income in the statement of comprehensive income. Rental income Rental income arising from operating leases on investment properties is accounted for on a straight‐line basis over the lease terms and included in revenue due to its operating nature. Rental income is recognised within other operating income as it is not considered as related to the primary activity of the Group. Segment reporting The Group has only one operating segment: production of pallets for transport and related logistical services. There was no revenue in the three years ended 31 December 2012. Geographical information The parent company is based in Luxembourg. The information for the geographical area of non‐current assets is presented for the most significant areas where the group has operations, being Luxembourg (country of domicile), the rest of Europe and North America. 66 Page Luxembourg Rest of Europe North America AS AT 31/12/2010 USD AS AT 31/12/2011 USD AS AT 31/12/2012 USD 6,348,819 3,403,333 7,282,135 5,025,942 3,392,396 14,775,074 2,333,842 3,655,153 6,463,932 17,034,287 23,193,412 12,452,927 Changes in accounting policies and disclosures Standards, amendments and interpretations that are not yet effective At the date of authorisation of these consolidated financial information, the following Standards and Interpretations had been issued by the IASB and adopted by the EU but not yet effective: APPLICABLE FOR FINANCIAL YEARS STANDARD/ BEGINNING ON INTERPRETATION CONTENT OR AFTER IAS 1 IFRS 1 IFRS 7 IFRS 10 IFRS 11 IFRS 12 IFRS 13 IAS 19 IAS 27 IAS 28 IAS 32 Presentation of financial statements (amendment) Government loans (amendment) Financial instruments: Disclosures (amendment) Consolidated financial statements Joint arrangements Disclosures of involvement with other entities Fair value measurement Employee benefits (revised) Separate financial statements Investments in associates and joint ventures Financial instruments: Presentation (amendment) 1 July 2012 1 January 2013 1 January 2013 1 January 2014 1 January 2014 1 January 2014 1 January 2013 1 January 2013 1 January 2013 1 January 2013 1 January 2014 The Directors do not anticipate that the adoption of these standards and interpretations will have a material impact on the consolidated financial information in the year of initial application. The Directors do not consider application of any of the amendments made to existing standards as a result of the 2011 annual improvements project will have a material effect on the consolidated financial information of the Group. Early adopted standards The Group did not early adopt any new or amended standards and does not plan to early adopt any of the standards issued not yet effective. 4. Significant accounting judgements, estimates and assumptions The preparation of financial statements in conforming with adopted IFRSs requires management to make judgments, estimates and assumptions that affect the application of policies and reported amounts of assets, liabilities, income and expenses. The estimates and assumptions are based on historical experience and other factors considered reasonable at the time, but actual results may differ from those estimates. Revisions to these estimates are made in the period in which they are recognised. Judgements In the process of applying the Group’s accounting policies, management has made the following judgements, which have the most significant effect on the amounts recognised in the consolidated financial information: 67 Page Non-current assets held for sale The Group has not discontinued operations during any period presented in this consolidated financial information. The Group has decided to dispose several non‐current assets as their carrying value will be principally recovered through sale transaction rather than continuing use. These assets are machinery in relation with the Persico project and investment in Mafic. The Group has determined that none of these assets could be classified as held‐for‐sale at any period ended as the Group could not determine the sale as highly probable due to the fact that the Group has neither committed to a plan to sell the asset and not entered into an active programme to locate a buyer, nor is actively marketing the assets for sale at a reasonable price. In relation to these assets, the Group has decided to record a value adjustment on the costs of property, plant and equipment related to the Persico project for USD 3,537,464. The investment in Mafic has been maintained at its cost value as the Group estimates the realisation value of the investment higher than its acquisition cost. Recognition of deferred tax assets The assessment of the probability of future taxable income against which deferred tax assets can be utilised is based on the Group’s latest approved forecast, which is adjusted for significant non‐taxable income and expenses and specific limits to the use of any unused tax loss or credit. The tax rules in the numerous jurisdictions in which the Group operates are also carefully taken into consideration. If a positive forecast of taxable income indicates the probable use of a deferred tax asset in the foreseeable future, especially when it can be utilised without a time limit, that deferred tax asset is usually recognised in full. The recognition of deferred tax assets that are subject to certain legal or economic limits or uncertainties is assessed individually by management based on the specific facts and circumstances. Research and development expenditure Research and development expenditure has been fully written off to the statement of comprehensive income. Management have taken into account the inherent risks in all research and development expenditure and specifically that expenditure being incurred by the business in the 3 years ended 31 December 2012 and have concluded that the requirements of IAS 38 to capitalise development expenditure have not been met. Receivable from PRC As a result of the resolution of the litigation between the Group and Plastics Research Corporation (“PRC”), the United States Arbitration Court has established a settlement agreement between both parties on 17 November 2012. As per the settlement agreement, PRC must pay USD 13,500,000 to RM2 as indemnity for the transfer of the equipment (the “Equipment”) to PRC. The receivable is repayable in several instalments starting two years after the settlement agreement date. During this period, PRC may only reimburse the interest accrued on the receivable. The management has estimated that the effective interest rate to amortise the receivable was 7 per cent. Due to delay in payment of the interest receivable by PRC, the management has estimated that there were significant uncertainties in relation to the future reimbursement of the capital amount. Therefore, management has decided to record full impairment of the outstanding nominal amount of the receivable. Also, the settlement agreement includes royalty payments to be made by PRC to the Group in relation to future sales made by PRC with the Equipment. The royalty to be paid is computed based on the quantity of manufactured items sold and the quantity of composite ground generated and sold by PRC during the seven years following the settlement agreement’s date. The maximum royalty to be paid to the Group amounts to USD 11,000,000. The management has also considered that there was very low probability that PRC will generate sales from the use of the machine and in consequence, the management has determined that the fair value of the royalty receivable was nil. Furthermore, the Group is not able to reliably estimate the amount of sales made or which will be made by PRC with the Equipment. 68 Page Estimates and assumptions The key assumptions concerning the future and other key sources of estimation uncertainty at the reporting date, that have a significant risk of causing a material adjustment to the carrying amounts of assets and liabilities within the next financial year, are described below. The Group based its assumptions and estimates on parameters available when the consolidated financial information was prepared. Existing circumstances and assumptions about future developments, however, may change due to market changes or circumstances arising beyond the control of the Group. Such changes are reflected in the assumptions when they occur. Apportionment of property, plant and equipment and investment property The Group holds a building property which is used for both Group administrative purpose and rental to third parties. Therefore, the management has determined that the building accounting should be split between the part used by the Group, classified as property, plant and equipment, and the part rented to third parties, classified as investment property. The initial cost of acquisition of the building is for both the building construction and the land. In determining the part of the acquisition cost related to the land, by default of split of cost upon acquisition, the management has made the assumption that 25 per cent. of the initial cost was related to the land. In determining the measurement of each part of the building (PPE and investment property), the management has determined the split based on the surface used for each purpose. Management has also determined that the depreciation should be made using the straight line method and over a useful life of thirty years. Due to the inability of the management to determine the residual value at the end of the useful life, the depreciation is computed on the entire value of the building cost. Impairment of inventory During the development of the machine, several samples were produced. Management has estimated for those samples which were not deemed to be part of the cost of property, plant and equipment that full impairment of these inventories should be recorded due to the inability of the Group to sell these samples. Depreciation Management review its estimate of useful lives of depreciable assets at each reporting date, based on the expected utility of the assets. Fair value of financial instruments Management apply valuation techniques to determine the fair value of financial instruments where active market quotes are not available. This requires management to develop estimates and assumptions based on market inputs, using observable data that market participants would use in pricing the instrument. Where such data is not observable, management uses its best estimate. Estimating fair values of financial instruments may vary from the actual prices that would be achieved in an arm’s length transaction at the reporting date. 5. Business combinations and acquisition of non-controlling interests During the periods covered by this consolidated financial information, the Group did not acquire any entity. However, the Group incorporated several entities which are included in this consolidated financial information. 69 Page 6. Property, plant and equipment LAND & BUILDING USD PLANT & EQUIPMENT USD CONSTRUCTION USD TOTAL USD Cost As at 1 January 2010 Additions Exchange differences – 1,659,544 – 116,561 97,828 10,712 4,119,681 9,490,001 – 4,236,242 11,247,373 10,712 As at 31 December 2010 Additions Disposals Exchange differences 1,659,544 143,074 – 1,696 225,101 22,875 (11,186) 129 13,609,682 9,616,415 – – 15,494,327 9,782,364 (11,186) 1,825 As at 31 December 2011 Additions Disposals Other/transfers Exchange differences 1,804,314 4,725 – – 51,382 236,919 358,021 (2,115,000) 8,088,579 6,431 23,226,097 2,515,145 (12,413,815) (8,088,579) 97,635 25,267,330 2,877,891 (14,528,815) – 155,448 As at 31 December 2012 1,860,421 6,574,950 5,336,483 13,771,854 – – – 3,168 55,563 5,821 – – – 3,168 55,563 5,821 Depreciation and impairment As at 1 January 2010 Depreciation charge for the year Exchange differences As at 31 December 2010 Depreciation charge for the year Impairment charge for the year Disposals Exchange differences – 45,443 – – (2,621) As at 31 December 2011 Depreciation charge for the year Exchange differences IN PROGRESS 64,552 63,116 – (3,788) (3,602) – – 3,537,463 – – 64,552 108,559 3,537,463 (3,788) (6,223) 42,822 46,828 2,389 120,278 404,305 6,129 3,537,463 – – 3,700,563 451,133 8,518 As at 31 December 2012 92,039 530,712 3,537,463 4,160,214 Net book value As at 31 December 2012 1,768,382 6,044,238 1,799,020 9,611,640 As at 31 December 2011 1,761,492 116,641 19,688,634 21,566,767 As at 31 December 2010 1,659,544 160,549 13,609,682 15,429,775 The Group has no restrictions on the realisability of its property, plant and equipment and no contractual obligations to either purchase, construct or develop property, plant and equipment or for repairs, maintenance and enhancements. As at 31 December 2012 the Group had several items of property, plant and equipment which were temporarily idle. The carrying amount of these items is USD 11,495,457 (2011: 0; 2010: 0). This amount corresponds to the machine for the production of pallets which have been completed and for which the production has not started. There was no amount as per prior periods as these machines were still in the construction phase. There were no borrowing costs capitalised during any period. Impairment of PPE The Group has recorded impairment on the construction in progress during the year 2011 in relation to the costs incurred for the Persico project. 70 Page The Group has decided to abandon the development of the project. As a result, and in the absence of potential market for the project developed, the Group has determined that the net realisable value of the project was nil. Therefore, the Group recorded impairment for USD 3,537,463 on the costs capitalised. Securities on property, plant & equipment for liabilities The Group has granted a security interest over the assets held in Canada (2012: USD 6,689,980; 2011: USD 4,194,084; 2010: nil) in return for the bridging loan facility (refer to note 26). The Group has granted a security interest over the property held in Switzerland in return for the CHF 2,100,000 bank loan (USD 2,704,000). 7. Investment property INVESTMENT PROPERTIES USD Cost As at 1 January 2010 Additions – 1,583,240 As at 31 December 2010 Additions Exchange differences 1,583,240 49,250 1,618 As at 31 December 2011 Exchange differences 1,634,108 47,002 As at 31 December 2012 1,681,110 Depreciation and impairment As at 1 January 2010 Depreciation charge for the year – – As at 31 December 2010 Depreciation charge for the year Exchange differences – 43,353 (2,500) As at 31 December 2011 Depreciation charge for the year Exchange differences 40,853 40,935 2,268 As at 31 December 2012 84,056 Net book value As at 31 December 2012 1,597,054 As at 31 December 2011 1,593,255 As at 31 December 2010 1,583,240 The investment property is a building used by the Group for both administrative purpose and for rental. The cost of the property related to the administrative purpose is classified within property, plant and equipment. The cost for the rental part is classified as investment property. 71 Page Results from investment property AS AT 31/12/2010 USD AS AT 31/12/2011 USD AS AT 31/12/2012 USD – 92,603 333,088 – – – Rental income from investment property: direct operating expenses (including repairs and maintenance) arising from investment property that generated rental income during the period: direct operating expenses (including repairs and maintenance) arising from investment property that did not generate rental income during the period: (66,007) (132,057) (113,507) (66,007) (39,454) 219,581 Fair value of investment property The investment property is measured at cost. The fair value of the property as at 31 December 2012 has been determined by Regie Chatel SA on 26 August 2013, an independent external appraiser. This valuation is the only external valuation made by the Group for the investment property. Regie Chatel SA is a specialist in valuing such investment properties. The fair value of the property has been determined using the rental income and the construction value. The valuation has been determined with the following primary inputs: 2012 Yield (%) Average price for new construction (m3) Land price (m2) Fair value determined for the part classified as investment property 7% 311.9 CHF/m3 250 CHF/m2 2,085,695 USD (1,904,907 CHF) This valuation is the first valuation performed on the property and for the purpose of this consolidated financial information. 72 Page 8. Intangible assets ACQUIRED LICENCES AND SIMILAR INTANGIBLE ASSETS USD Cost As at 1 January 2010 Additions – 24,272 As at 31 December 2010 Additions 24,272 14,518 As at 31 December 2011 Additions 38,790 8,243 As at 31 December 2012 47,033 Depreciation and impairment As at 1 January 2010 Depreciation charge for the year – 3,000 As at 31 December 2010 Depreciation charge for the year 3,000 2,400 As at 31 December 2011 Depreciation charge for the year 5,400 2,400 As at 31 December 2012 7,800 Net book value As at 31 December 2012 39,233 As at 31 December 2011 33,390 As at 31 December 2010 21,272 The Group has no intangible assets pledged as security for liabilities. The Group has no contractual commitment for the acquisition of intangible assets. 73 Page 9. Financial assets and liabilities AS AT 31/12/2010 USD AS AT 31/12/2011 USD AS AT 31/12/2012 USD Financial assets Available for sale investments Unquoted equity shares – – 60,587 Total available for sale investments – – 60,587 Total financial assets at fair value – – 60,587 837,005 2,635,031 2,320,836 – – 50,150 – – 46,418 4,451,000 247,704 56,347 Other current financial assets Cash and cash equivalents Total current financial assets Non-current Other receivables 50,150 3,151,394 3,201,544 46,418 15,852,154 15,898,572 4,755,051 864,402 5,619,453 – – 791,000 Total loans and receivables Total financial assets 4,038,549 4,038,549 18,553,603 18,553,603 8,731,289 8,791,876 Total current Total non-current 4,038,549 – 18,533,603 – 7,940,289 851,587 Financial liabilities at amortised cost Interest‐bearing loans and borrowings Trade and other payables 18,404,445 1,281,939 4,359,169 2,287,363 5,078,799 1,636,477 Total financial liabilities at amortised cost 19,686,384 6,646,532 6,715,276 Total financial liabilities 19,686,384 6,646,532 6,715,276 Total current Total non-current 17,453,648 2,232,736 4,411,515 2,235,017 4,415,972 2,299,304 Loans and receivables Trade and other receivables Loan note to Mafic PRC accrued interest Deposits Financial liabilities Available-for-sale investment – unquoted equity shares The available‐for‐sale financial assets consist of the investments in shares of non‐listed companies, which are valued based on non‐market observable information. The Group holds non‐controlling interests (between 3.5 per cent. and 10 per cent.) in entities where it has entered into business relations for the development of new technology for the creation of pallets. The fair value of the investment has been the deemed cost paid at acquisition. The management has not been able to determine effective fair value of these investments, and the management considers that any change in fair value would not be significant for the consolidated financial information. Loan notes The Group has loan note receivables with two entities: PRC and Mafic. 74 Page Loan notes PRC The Group entered into an agreement with Plastics Research Corporation (“PRC”) for the development and production of specific shipping pallets. The machine has been developed on land rented by PRC from a third party (the “Redlands Facility”). The development of the production facility has required the acquisition of equipment which is located at the Redlands Facility (the “Equipment”). In the course of the development of the Equipment, several disputes arose between the Group and PRC. The disputes were settled by the United States Arbitration Court on 11 November 2012. From the settlement of the disputes, a settlement and release agreement has been concluded on 15 November 2012 between both parties. As per the Settlement Agreement, it has been agreed that: • PRC has ownership and possession of all Equipment on the Redlands Facility. • PRC shall pay to RM2 SA the principal sum of USD 13,500,000 (the “Indebtedness”) as a non‐royalty payment. • PRC shall pay to RM2 SA royalties for the sales of pallet and composite compound up to USD 11,000,000 (the “Royalty payments”). The outstanding balance of the indebtedness as at 31 December 2012 amounts to USD 13,747,704 and includes interest of USD 247,704. The loan bears interest at the effective interest rate of 7% per annum and has a maturity date of 15 November 2019. Management has determined that there was significant risk on the recoverability of the capital amount of the Indebtedness for USD 13,500,000 and decided to record a full impairment on the investment (for further detail, refer to note 4). The impairment on the loans and receivables was incurred as the Group has estimated that the recoverability of the receivable resulting from the resolution of the litigation with PRC was uncertain as a result of the delinquent payment made by PRC. As at 31 December 2012, the carrying amount of the PRC loan notes is USD 247,704, which corresponds to the balance of accrued interests. As a result of the transfer of the Equipment by the Group to PRC in exchange for the payment of the receivables of USD 13,500,000, the Group has generated a gain on the derecognition of the Equipment of USD 906,399. Loan notes Mafic The Group has incurred costs related to the development of new technology for the production of pallets using Basalt fibre. During the development process, the Group determined that they did not want to use this fibre for the production of their pallets. The Group entered into negotiation with Mafic for the sale of the development costs incurred in relation to this project. An agreement has concluded with Mafic in September 2013. The Group recognised a loan note receivable with Mafic for USD 4,451,000 as at year end 2012. The receivable has been fully paid by September 2013. 75 Page Interest-bearing loans and borrowings EFFECTIVE MATURITY INTEREST DATE AS AT 31/12/2010 USD AS AT 31/12/2011 USD AS AT 31/12/2012 USD 2,232,736 2,235,017 2,299,304 2,232,736 2,235,017 2,299,304 33 963,083 15,208,593 70 2,124,082 – 193 2,779,302 – Total current interest-bearing loans and borrowings 16,171,709 2,124,152 2,779,495 Total interest-bearing loans and borrowings 18,404,445 4,359,169 5,078,799 RATE Non-current interest-bearing loans and borrowings CHF 2,100,000 Bank loan 2.4% 30 November 2015 Total non-current interest-bearing loans and borrowings Current interest-bearing loans and borrowings Bank overdraft (note 12) Shareholder current account DPE Bridge Facility Variable 0% 18% On‐demand On‐demand June 2011 CHF 2,100,000 bank loan The loan is secured by a mortgage on the building held by the Group in Switzerland for a total value of CHF 2,470,000 (USD 2,704,000) and by transfer of rental income to the lender. DPE Bridge Facility The Group had entered into a bridge facility with DPE for the financing of its operations on 30 June 2010. As a result of the Group restructuring operations in 2011, the bridge facility had been fully reimbursed during the year 2011. The loan was secured by property, plant and equipment held by RM2 USA with a carrying value of USD 6,689,980 as at 31 December 2012 (2011: USD 4,194,084; 2010: nil). The Group also issued the DPE Warrants on the same date to DPE granting to DPE the right to purchase up to 10 per cent. of the fully diluted share capital of the Company. The right exists as long as the outstanding warrant shares represent more than 5 per cent. of the share capital of the Company. The fair value of the warrants is immaterial. The number of Warrant Shares granted to DPE at each year end is as follows: Number of Warrant Shares AS AT 31/12/2010 AS AT 31/12/2011 AS AT 31/12/2012 6,109 12,816 12,514,656 The Group maintains sufficient authorised share capital in order to issue the Warrant Shares at any time. Hedging activities and derivatives The Group has not entered into any hedging activity during each period covered by the consolidated financial information. Fair values The Group estimates that the fair value of the financial assets and liabilities approximates their carrying amount as these are mainly composed of short‐term receivables and payables. 76 Page Fair value hierarchy The Group uses the following hierarchy for determining and disclosing the fair value of financial instruments by valuation technique: • Level 1: quoted (unadjusted) prices in active markets for identical assets or liabilities. • Level 2: other techniques for which all inputs that have a significant effect on the recorded fair value are observable, either directly or indirectly. • Level 3: techniques that use inputs that have a significant effect on the recorded fair value that are not based on observable market data. As at 31 December 2012, the Group held the following financial instruments carried at fair value in the statement of financial position: ASSETS MEASURED AT FAIR VALUE Available-for-sale financial asset: Equity shares AS AT 31/12/2012 USD LEVEL 1 USD LEVEL 2 USD LEVEL 3 USD 60,587 – – 60,587 The Group had no financial instruments at fair value as at 31 December 2011 and 2010. Reconciliation of fair value measurements of Level 3 financial instruments The Group carries unquoted equity shares as available‐for‐sale financial instruments classified as Level 3 within the fair value hierarchy. The Group has equity interests in two unlisted entities with which it entered into a research and collaboration agreement. A reconciliation of the beginning and closing balances including movements is summarised below: 10. MAFIC S.A. USD EQUIPMENT TRACKING LTD. USD TOTAL USD 1 January 2012 Purchases – 10,500 – 50,087 – 60,587 31 December 2012 10,500 50,087 60,587 Inventories The Group produced some sample items. The Group has determined that the recoverable value of those samples which were not deemed to be part of the cost of property, plant and equipment samples was nil and decided to make full impairment of the inventory cost. During the year ended 2012, the Group recorded a value adjustment on the inventory for USD 1,447,797 (2011: nil, 2010: nil). There was no cost of inventory recognised as an expense during any financial period as the Group has not made any sale transaction during these periods. 77 Page 11. Trade and other receivables AS AT 31/12/2010 USD AS AT 31/12/2011 USD AS AT 31/12/2012 USD Income tax receivables Other tax receivables Other receivables 8 206,291 630,706 8 920,930 1,714,093 2,118 1,362,630 956,088 Financial assets 837,005 2,635,031 2,320,836 Prepayments 143,246 8,933 222,804 Non-financial assets 143,246 8,933 222,804 Total trade and other receivables 980,251 2,643,964 2,543,640 The Group has no trade receivables as at any period ended due to the fact that the Group has not yet started the trading of the pallets produced by the machines. As a result, the Group has no provision for impairment of receivables. The balance of other receivables includes an advance payment made to STM related to the acquisition of a licence for the Mafic project (see note 9) for USD 1,000,000 as at 31 December 2012 (2011: USD 1,000,000; 2010: nil) and an advance payment made to PRC for nil in 2012 (2011: USD 631,788; 2010: USD 631,788). The other tax receivables primarily relate to Harmonised Sales Tax (VAT) balances due in Canada. 12. Cash and short-term deposits AS AT 31/12/2010 USD AS AT 31/12/2011 USD AS AT 31/12/2012 USD Cash at bank and in hand Short‐term deposits 3,084,448 66,946 15,502,055 350,099 555,580 308,822 Total cash and short-term deposits 3,151,394 15,852,154 864,402 Cash at banks earns interest at floating rates based on daily bank deposit rates. Short‐term deposits are made for varying periods of between one day and three months, depending on the immediate cash requirements of the Group, and earn interest at the respective short‐term deposit rates. At each period ended, the Group does not have any undrawn committed borrowing facilities. The Group has not pledged any part of its short‐term deposits to fulfil collateral requirements. The Group has no restricted cash at any period ended. For the purpose of the statement of cash flows, cash and cash equivalents comprise the following at 31 December: AS AT 31/12/2010 USD AS AT 31/12/2011 USD AS AT 31/12/2012 USD Cash at bank and in hand Short‐term deposits 3,084,448 66,946 15,502,055 350,099 555,580 308,822 Bank overdraft 3,151,394 (33) 15,852,154 (70) 864,402 (193) Total cash and cash equivalents 3,151,361 15,852,084 864,209 78 Page 13. Share capital and reserves On 3 August 2011, the Board of Directors of the Company decided to accept the subscription and issuance of 12,860 new shares equally distributed in each class of shares, with a nominal value of USD 1 per share for an aggregate amount of USD 12,860 combined with a share premium of USD 3,499 per share. As a result of the resolution of the Board of Directors, the share capital has increased by USD 12,860 and the share premium by USD 44,997,140. The capital and share premium increase of USD 45,010,000 has been subscribed in full and paid up in cash on 19 August 2011. On 20 January 2012, the Extraordinary General Meeting of the Company decided to increase the share capital of the Company by an amount of USD 55,164,140 through partial incorporation of the share premium into capital so as to raise its former amount of USD 122,860 to the amount of USD 55,287,000. The Extraordinary General Meeting also decided to reduce the par value of the shares of the Company from USD 1 per share to USD 0.45 per share by the issuance of 67,573,000 new shares equivalently distributed in each class of shares. The Extraordinary General Meeting decided to increase the authorised share capital of the Company by an amount of USD 67,340,143.50 so as to raise its current amount of USD 232,860 to the amount of USD 67,573,003.50 equivalently distributed in each class of shares with the same rights. As at 31 December 2012, each ordinary share issued has a nominal value of USD 0.45 and has been fully paid‐up. Authorised shares PAR VALUE SHARES USD PER SHARE At 1 January 2010 200,000 200,000 USD 1 At 31 December 2010 Capital increase dated 3 August 2011 200,000 32,860 200,000 32,860 USD 1 USD 1 At 31 December 2011 Increase of authorised share capital and reduction of par value per share dated 20 January 2012 232,860 232,860 USD 1 149,929,370 67,340,143.5 At 31 December 2012 150,162,230 67,573,003.5 USD 0.45 The authorised share capital is split equally into 10 classes of shares (from A to J) with the same rights. Ordinary shares issued and fully paid PAR VALUE SHARES USD PER SHARE At 1 January 2010 110,000 110,000 USD 1 At 31 December 2010 Capital increase dated 3 August 2011 110,000 12,860 110,000 12,860 USD 1 USD 1 At 31 December 2011 Conversion of share premium to share capital dated 20 January 2012 Reduction of par value per share dated 20 January 2012 122,860 122,860 USD 1 55,164,140 67,573,000 55,164,140 – USD 1 122,860,000 55,287,000 USD 0.45 At 31 December 2012 The share capital issued is split equally into 10 classes of shares (from A to J) with the same rights. 79 Page Share premium USD At 1 January 2010 10,860,356 At 31 December 2010 Capital increase dated 3 August 2011 10,860,356 44,997,140 At 31 December 2011 Conversion of share premium to share capital dated 20 January 2012 55,857,496 (55,164,140) At 31 December 2012 693,356 Warrants On 30 June 2010, the Group issued warrants to DPE granting to DPE the right to purchase up to ten per cent. of the fully diluted share capital of the Company (the “Warrant Shares”). The right exists as long as the outstanding warrant shares represent more than 5 per cent. of the share capital of the Company. The number of Warrant Shares granted to DPE at each year end is as follows: Number of Warrant Shares AS AT 31/12/2010 AS AT 31/12/2011 AS AT 31/12/2012 6,109 12,816 12,514,656 The fair value of the DPE Warrants is immaterial. The Group maintains sufficient authorised share capital in order to issue the Warrant Shares at any time. Nature and purpose of reserve Currency translation reserve: The currency translation reserve is used to record exchange differences arising from the translation of the subsidiaries’ financial statements in foreign currencies to the Group reporting currency. This reserve cannot be distributed to shareholders. Dividend distribution As a result of the accumulated losses generated by the Group, no dividend has been declared or paid. 14. Trade and other payables AS AT 31/12/2010 USD AS AT 31/12/2011 USD AS AT 31/12/2012 USD Trade payables Employee compensation payables Other tax payables Other payables 1,025,287 312 147,397 108,943 2,049,121 54 99,067 139,121 991,874 25,084 222,866 185,653 Total trade and other payables 1,281,939 2,287,363 1,425,477 Terms and conditions of the above financial liabilities: • Trade payables are non‐interest bearing and are normally settled on 30‐days terms. • Other payables are non‐interest bearing and have an average term of 30 days terms. • For explanation of the Group’s liquidity risk management processes, refer to Note 24. 80 Page 15. Revenue The Group has no revenue for any period presented in the consolidated financial information as the Group has not started the production and commercialisation of its products. 16. Other income and expenses Other operating income AS AT 31/12/2010 USD AS AT 31/12/2011 USD AS AT 31/12/2012 USD Net gain on disposal of PPE Rental income Other – – – – 92,603 – 1,991,399 333,088 1,772 Total other operating income – 92,603 2,326,259 The gain on disposal of PPE has been generated from the derecognition of the assets related to the PRC project as a result of the settlement agreement (USD 906,399) (see note 9), and a gain (USD 1,085,000) in relation to the transfer to Mafic of development costs on other projects which the Group has considered could not be used for their own purpose. Other operating expenses AS AT 31/12/2010 USD AS AT 31/12/2011 USD AS AT 31/12/2012 USD Direct operating expenses on rental‐earning investment properties Research and development costs Impairment on inventory Impairment on property, plant & equipment Net wealth tax Loss on receivables 66,007 488,644 – – (50,849) 179,500 132,057 125,627 – 3,537,464 20,660 – 113,508 281,425 1,447,797 – 165,065 – Total other operating expenses 683,302 3,815,808 2,007,795 The impairment on the inventory was incurred due to the inability of the Company to sell the sample items produced by the Group. The Group estimated that these items had a nil residual value. The impairment on the property, plant and equipment was incurred in relation to the decision of the Group to cancel the development of one production project. Due to the inability of the Group to find an acquirer for the machine, the Group has decided that impairment for the full amount of the machine was necessary. The net wealth tax relates primarily to the tax due by each Luxembourgish subsidiary on the net assets of the subsidiary. Finance income AS AT 31/12/2010 USD AS AT 31/12/2011 USD AS AT 31/12/2012 USD Interest income on loans and receivables 58 125 240,275 Total interest income 58 125 240,275 Net foreign exchange gain Other 265,491 55 28,941 44 643,049 25,689 Total finance income 265,604 29,110 909,013 81 Page Finance costs AS AT 31/12/2010 USD AS AT 31/12/2011 USD AS AT 31/12/2012 USD Interest at amortised costs on loans and borrowings 863,095 2,219,418 55,347 Total interest expenses 863,095 2,219,418 55,347 Net foreign exchange loss Transaction costs Other 39,190 599,855 11,266 214,472 166,526 5,225 354,367 – 504 1,513,406 2,605,641 410,218 AS AT 31/12/2010 USD AS AT 31/12/2011 USD AS AT 31/12/2012 USD 58,563 154,412 494,468 58,563 154,412 494,468 AS AT 31/12/2010 USD AS AT 31/12/2011 USD AS AT 31/12/2012 USD 435,726 56,472 27,340 727,280 100,806 42,981 696,050 101,339 40,942 458,332 39,065 – 659,459 51,486 – 2,134,873 155,647 7,813 1,016,935 1,582,012 3,136,664 11 13 82 AS AT 31/12/2010 USD AS AT 31/12/2011 USD AS AT 31/12/2012 USD 488,644 125,627 281,425 Total finance costs Amortisation and depreciation expenses Depreciation and amortisation expenses, included in: Administrative expenses Employee benefits expenses Included in selling and distribution expenses: Wages and salaries Social security costs Pension costs Included in administrative expenses: Wages and salaries Social security costs Pension costs Total employee benefits expenses Average number of full time employees Research and development costs Included in other operating expenses: 82 Page 17. Income taxes Income tax expenses The major components of income tax expense for each period are: AS AT 31/12/2010 USD AS AT 31/12/2011 USD AS AT 31/12/2012 USD Current income tax: Current income tax charge 1,489 11,598 16,556 Total current income tax: 1,489 11,598 16,556 Income tax expenses 1,489 11,598 16,556 A reconciliation between tax expense and the accounting loss multiplied by the domestic tax rate of each entity in its jurisdiction for each period is as follows: AS AT 31/12/2010 USD Loss before tax Theoretical income tax charge using applicable income tax rate Reconciliation to actual income tax charge Adjustment in respect of current income tax of previous year Unrecognised deferred tax assets on losses carried forward Non‐deductible expenses from: Other non‐deductible expenses Non‐taxable income from: Other non‐taxable income Income tax expenses AS AT 31/12/2011 USD AS AT 31/12/2012 USD (6,706,775) (11,568,660) (18,053,555) (1,677,596) (2,855,332) (4,534,594) – 2,449,996 (403) 2,983,342 (681) 8,003,846 (770,911) (130,024) (3,749,467) – (1,489) 14,015 297,452 (11,598) (16,556) Deferred taxes The Group has not recognised deferred tax assets on the tax losses carried forward as the Group has estimated that no sufficient future benefits would be generated in the near future to cover the losses. The tax losses for which no deferred tax asset has been recognised amount to USD 29,096,299 as at 31 December 2012 (2011: USD 21,448,604 and 2010: USD 11,826,954). If the Group was able to recognise all unrecognised deferred tax assets, the loss would decrease by USD 7,120,548 as at 31 December 2012 (2011: USD 5,385,173 and 2010: USD 2,945,057). 18. Pensions and other post-employment benefit plans The Group has not entered into any defined contribution plan and defined benefit plan for its employees. 19. Share based payments The Group has not entered into any type of share‐based payment plan with any of the Group’s employees. 20. Earnings per share Basic earnings per share amounts are calculated by dividing the net profit for the year attributable to ordinary equity holders of the parent by the weighted average number of ordinary shares outstanding during the year. 83 Page Diluted earnings per share amounts are calculated by dividing the net profit attributable to ordinary equity holders of the parent by the weighted average number of ordinary shares outstanding during the year plus the weighted average number of ordinary shares that would be issued on conversion of all the dilutive potential ordinary shares into ordinary shares. The following reflects the income and share data used in the basic and diluted earnings per share computations: AS AT 31/12/2010 USD Net loss attributable to ordinary equity holders of the parent for basic and diluted earnings Weighted average number of ordinary shares for basic earnings per share Effect of dilution: Warrant Shares to DPE Weighted average number of ordinary shares adjusted for the effect of dilution Loss per share (basic and diluted) (6,708,251) AS AT 31/12/2011 USD AS AT 31/12/2012 USD (11,579,257) (18,070,522) 110,000 115,358 112,631,905 6,109 12,816 12,514,656 116,109 128,174 125,146,561 (60.98) (100.38) (0.16) The Group issued new Warrant Shares to third party JKD in June 2013 granting 614,300 Warrant Shares each convertible in 1 share of the Company. Resulting from this transaction, the number of diluted shares has increased by 682,556 shares. For the years ended 31 December 2010, 2011 and 2012, the additional shares on exercise of outstanding warrants would decrease the basic loss per share and there is therefore no dilutive effect. 21. Segment reporting The Group presents the geographical area of it non–current assets other than financial instruments as follows: Luxembourg Rest of Europe North America AS AT 31/12/2010 USD AS AT 31/12/2011 USD AS AT 31/12/2012 USD 6,348,819 3,403,333 7,282,135 5,025,942 3,392,396 14,775,074 2,333,842 3,655,153 6,463,932 17,034,287 23,193,412 12,452,927 Non‐current assets for this purpose consist of property, plant and equipment, investment properties and intangible assets. 84 Page 22. Commitments and contingencies Operating lease commitments – Group as lessor The Group has entered into a commercial property lease on its investment property, consisting of the Group’s surplus space in the Switzerland office building. The end of the term of the non‐cancellable lease is 31 December 2021. Future minimum rentals receivable under non‐cancellable operating leases as at 31 December are as follows: Within one year After one year but not more than five years More than five years AS AT 31/12/2010 USD AS AT 31/12/2011 USD AS AT 31/12/2012 USD – – – 253,241 1,012,964 1,266,204 260,525 1,042,100 1,042,100 – 2,532,409 2,344,725 Operating lease commitments – Group as lessee The Group has entered into commercial leases for office spaces in London and New Jersey. These leases have an average life of between 6 months and 3 years with a renewal option included in the contracts. There are no restrictions placed upon the Group by entering into these leases. Future minimum rentals payable under non‐cancellable operating leases as at 31 December are as follows: Within one year After one year but not more than five years More than five years AS AT 31/12/2010 USD AS AT 31/12/2011 USD AS AT 31/12/2012 USD – – – – – – 405,476 1,855,903 222,000 – – 2,483,379 Contingent liabilities The Group has no contingent liabilities. DPE Warrants In relation to the Warrants issued by the Group to DPE, the holder of the warrant has the option to terminate the DPE Warrants at its discretion. Upon termination of the DPE Warrants, the Group will have to pay the holder an amount equal to the fair market value of the warrants. The holder may only terminate 25 per cent. of the Warrant Shares and only during the period from 31 December 2012 until 31 December 2017. The Group has the possibility, at its discretion, to repurchase the DPE Warrants as follows: • 50 per cent. of the warrants (first tranche); and • 25 per cent. additionally (second tranche). The first tranche of the termination right will terminate on 31 December 2014. The second tranche may only be exercised upon completion of the first tranche and will also terminate on 31 December 2014. 85 Page Royalties PRC The Group has the right to royalty receivables from PRC resulting from the sale of pallets manufactured and composite compound generated by using the equipment transferred to PRC as a result of the litigation between the Group and PRC. The royalty receivable would be computed as follows and in accordance with the following terms: • USD 4 per manufactured pallet sold by PRC (or through assignment given to contractor). • USD 0.10 per pound of composite ground generated using the equipment and sold by PRC to third party. Until the first anniversary date of the Settlement Agreement (15 November 2013), no Royalty Payments shall be due by PRC to the Group for the sale of pallets or compound composite. The maximum aggregated royalty payments which can be made by PRC to the Group amounts to USD 11,000,000. Upon the seventh anniversary date of the Settlement Agreement (15 November 2019), the Group shall not be entitled to any royalty payments from PRC. Due to inability of the Group to estimate the future royalty income from the Settlement Agreement, the value of the instrument in the consolidated financial information is deemed to be nil. Forward purchase of property, plant and equipment The Group has commitment in relation to forward purchase for the acquisition of property, plant and equipment, as follows: Forward purchase for acquisition of PPE AS AT 31/12/2010 USD AS AT 31/12/2011 USD AS AT 31/12/2012 USD 3,109,152 401,923 – These amounts correspond to forward purchase for future acquisitions in relation to the PRC project. 23. Related party disclosures Group subsidiaries The consolidated financial information includes the financial statements of the Company and its subsidiaries. The Group has the following subsidiaries included in this consolidated financial information: SUBSIDIARY NAME COUNTRY OF INCORPORATION 2012 % OF EQUITY INTEREST 2011 2010 RM2 S.A., including Swiss branch RM2 I.P. S.A. RM2 Holland B.V. RM2 Total Solutions International B.V. RM2 Europe Spółka z.o.o. RM2 USA Inc. Victoria Rises Ltd. RM2 Canada Inc. RM2 France S.à r.l. Luxembourg Luxembourg Netherlands Netherlands Poland United States of America United Kingdom Canada France 100% 100% 100% 100% 80% 100% 100% 100% 100% 100% 100% 100% 100% 80% 100% 100% 100% – 100% 100% 100% 100% 80% 100% 100% – – All subsidiaries held by the Company are consolidated. During the year 2010, the Group incorporated the subsidiary RM2 Europe Spółka z.o.o. and acquired 80 per cent. of the share capital. During the year 2011, the Group incorporated the subsidiary RM2 Canada Inc. 86 Page During the year 2012, the Group incorporated the subsidiary RM2 France S.à r.l. Transaction with related parties All transactions between the Company and the Group’s subsidiaries, and between Group’s subsidiaries, have been eliminated for the preparation of this consolidated financial information. AMOUNTS Parent: AMOUNTS INCOME WITH EXPENSES FROM OWED BY OWED TO RELATED PARTIES RELATED PARTIES RELATED PARTIES RELATED PARTIES YEAR USD USD USD USD 2012 2011 2010 – – – – – – – – – 2,779,302 2,124,083 963,083 Transactions with key management personnel There were no specific transactions between the Group and the key management personnel. The Group granted compensation to the key management personnel as follows: Short‐term employee benefits 24. AS AT 31/12/2010 USD AS AT 31/12/2011 USD AS AT 31/12/2012 USD 336,972 428,402 402,447 Financial risk management objectives and policies The Group’s financial liabilities comprise only loans and borrowings and trade and other payables. The main purpose of these financial liabilities is to finance the Group’s operations. The Group has loan and other receivables, trade and other receivables, and cash and short‐term deposits that arrive directly from its operations. The Group also holds available‐for‐ sale investments. The Group is exposed to market risk, credit risk and liquidity risk. The Group’s senior management oversees the management of these risks. The Board of Directors reviews and agrees policies for managing each of these risks which are summarised below. Market risks Market risk is the risk that the fair value of future cash flows of a financial instrument will fluctuate because of changes in market prices. Market prices comprise three types of market risk: interest rate risk, currency risk and other price risk, such as commodity price risk or equity price risk. Financial instruments affected by market risk include loans and borrowings, deposits and available‐for‐sale investments. The Group’s management has determined that the Group was not subject to the interest rate risk as all significant loans and receivables have been issued with fixed interest rate, to the commodity price risk as the production of pallets does not require raw material subject to market volatility, and to the equity price risk as the available‐for‐sale investments are exclusively made in unquoted equity instruments. The Group only has exposure to the foreign currency risk as a result of its operations in various countries and using different functional currencies. The sensitivity analyses in the following sections relate to the position as at 31 December 2012, 2011 and 2010. The sensitivity analyses have been prepared on the basis that the amount of net debt, the ratio of fixed to floating interest rates of the debt and derivatives and the proportion of financial instruments in foreign currencies are all constant and on the basis of the hedge designations in place at 31 December 2012. 87 Page The analyses exclude the impact of movements in market variables on the carrying values of pension and other post‐ retirement obligations, provisions, and the non‐financial assets and liabilities of foreign operations. Foreign currency risk Foreign currency risk is the risk that the fair value or future cash flows of a financial instrument will fluctuate because of changes in foreign exchange rates. The Group’s exposure to the risk of changes in foreign exchange rates relates primarily to the Group’s operating activities (when revenue or expense is denominated in a different currency from the Group’s presentation currency) and the Group’s net investments in foreign subsidiaries. The Group has no policy to manage its foreign currency risk as the Group’s management estimates the foreign currency risk as negligible. The Group has significant operations in the following currencies: United States Dollar (USD), Swiss Franc (CHF) and Canadian Dollar (CAD). The Group has other operations in the following currencies which are not significant for the Group: Euro (EUR), Polish Zloty (PLN) and Great British Pound (GBP). (i) Sensitivity analysis The following tables demonstrate the sensitivity to a reasonably possible change in the CHF and CAD exchange rates, with all other variables held constant. The impact on the Group’s profit before tax is due to changes in the fair value of monetary assets and liabilities including non‐designated foreign currency derivatives. The Group’s exposure to foreign currency changes for all other currencies is not material. The sensitivity analysis assumes a +/– 3 per cent. change of the USD/CHF exchange rate for each period covered by this consolidated financial information. This percentage has been determined based on the average market volatility in exchange rates in the previous 24 months. The variation of the USD/CAD exchange rate of the previous 24 months is less than 1 per cent. and therefore, it is not considered as a significant risk for the Group. Nevertheless, the Group has decided to present the sensitivity analysis using a theoretical variation of 3 per cent. in the exchange rate. EFFECT ON OTHER CHANGE IN CHF RATE YEAR 2012 2011 2010 +3% –3% +3% –3% +3% –3% EFFECT ON PROFIT COMPREHENSIVE BEFORE TAX INCOME USD USD 60,640 (64,256) 57,384 (60,806) 62,399 (66,120) 60,640 (64,256) 57,384 (60,806) 62,399 (66,120) EFFECT ON OTHER CHANGE IN CAD RATE YEAR 2012 2011 2010 +1% –1% +1% –1% +1% –1% EFFECT ON PROFIT COMPREHENSIVE BEFORE TAX INCOME USD USD (6,666) 6,801 (6,270) 6,397 – – (6,666) 6,801 (6,270) 6,397 – – 88 Page Credit risk Credit risk is the risk that a counterparty will not meet its obligations under a financial instrument or customer contract, leading to a financial loss. The Group is exposed to credit risk from its operating activities and from its financing activities, including deposits with banks and financial institutions, foreign exchange transactions and other financial instruments. Trade and other receivables The Group is not subject to any credit risk related to trade receivables as the Group has no trade receivables as at each period ended. The other receivables are mainly composed of tax receivables owed by the national institutions for which the Group consider that there is no risk of recoverability. The Group also have other receivables with Mafic (in 2012 and 2011) and PRC (in 2011 and 2010), net of impairment, for which they consider that there is no risk of recoverability as all these receivables have been recovered subsequently. Financial instruments and cash deposits The Group loans financial instruments are mainly represented by loan receivables owed by PRC and Mafic. The management has estimated that the recoverability of the PRC receivable was uncertain (see note 4) and has recorded impairment on the full nominal amount of the receivables. The Group does not consider that there is any risk of recoverability on the Mafic receivable as payment was received subsequent to 31 December 2012. Credit risk from balances with banks and financial institutions is not considered significant as the Group has made placements with approved counterparties. Ageing analysis of receivables The Group does not have overdue receivables except the interest on the PRC loans which is due as at 31 December 2012 and remains unpaid as at the period end for USD 120,000 (2011: nil; 2010: nil). The interest was subsequently collected. Liquidity risk The Group’s objective is to maintain a balance between continuity of funding and flexibility through the use of raising of capital via equity issues or bridging facilities. Longer term the Group will look to finance activities through bank and debt facilities. Concentration of risk Concentrations arise when a number of counterparties are engaged in similar business activities, or activities in the same geographical region, or have economic features that would cause their ability to meet contractual obligations to be similarly affected by changes in economic, political or other conditions. Concentrations indicate the relative sensitivity of the Group’s performance to developments affecting a particular industry. The Group do not consider that others are engaged in similar business activities, but do monitor the situation. 89 Page Maturity Profile The table below summarises the maturity profile of the Group’s financial liabilities based on contractual undiscounted payments. DUE ON Total financial liabilities: 31 December 2011 Non-current liabilities Interest-bearing loans and borrowings Bank borrowings Current liabilities Interest-bearing loans and borrowings Bank overdrafts Loans from other related parties Trade and other payables Trade payables Employee compensation payables Other tax payables Other payables Total financial liabilities: DUE BETWEEN DUE 3 AND 1 AND AFTER USD DUE WITHIN 3 MONTHS USD 12 MONTHS USD 5 YEARS USD 5 YEARS USD TOTAL USD – – – – – – 2,299,304 2,299,304 – – 2,299,304 2,299,304 2,779,495 193 – – – – – – – – 2,779,495 193 2,779,302 – – – 1,636,477 1,202,874 – – – – – – – – – 2,779,302 1,636,477 1,202,874 – – – 25,084 222,866 185,653 – – – – – – – – – 25,084 222,866 185,653 2,779,495 1,636,477 – 2,299,304 – 6,715,276 – – – – – – 2,235,017 2,235,017 – – 2,235,017 2,235,017 2,124,152 70 – – – – – – – – 2,124,152 70 2,124,082 – – – 2,287,363 2,049,121 – – – – – – – – – 2,124,082 2,287,363 2,049,121 – – – 54 99,067 139,121 – – – – – – – – – 54 99,067 139,121 2,124,152 2,287,363 – 2,235,017 – 6,646,532 DEMAND 31 December 2012 Non-current liabilities Interest-bearing loans and borrowings Bank borrowings Current liabilities Interest-bearing loans and borrowings Bank overdrafts Loans from other related parties Trade and other payables Trade payables Employee compensation payables Other tax payables Other payables DUE BETWEEN 90 Page DUE ON Total financial liabilities: 25. DUE BETWEEN DUE 3 AND 1 AND AFTER USD DUE WITHIN 3 MONTHS USD 12 MONTHS USD 5 YEARS USD 5 YEARS USD TOTAL USD – – – – – – 2,232,736 2,232,736 – – 2,232,736 2,232,736 963,116 33 – – 15,208,593 – – – – – 16,171,709 33 963,083 – – – – – 1,281,939 1,025,287 – 15,208,593 – – – – – – – – – – 963,083 15,208,593 1,281,939 1,025,287 – – – 312 147,397 108,943 – – – – – – – – – 312 147,397 108,943 963,116 1,281,939 15,208,593 2,232,736 – 19,686,384 DEMAND 31 December 2010 Non-current liabilities Interest-bearing loans and borrowings Bank borrowings Current liabilities Interest-bearing loans and borrowings Bank overdrafts Loans from other related parties Other loans and borrowings Trade and other payables Trade payables Employee compensation payables Other tax payables Other payables DUE BETWEEN Capital management The Group’s capital management objectives are: • to ensure the Group’s ability to continue as a going concern; and • to provide sufficient working capital to expand the business and provide adequate returns to shareholders. The Group monitors capital on the carrying value of its equity, and any share premium plus cash and cash equivalents and credit facilities as presented on the face of the statements of financial position. The Group manages the capital structure and makes adjustments to it in the light of changes in economic conditions. In order to maintain or adjust the capital structure, the Group may issue new shares, or in the future anticipates raising debt finance as appropriate for working capital. 91 Page 26. Transition to IFRS This is the first time that the Group has presented its consolidated financial information under IFRS. The accounting policies set out above have been applied in preparing the financial information for the years ended 31 December 2010, 31 December 2011 and 31 December 2012 and in the preparation of the opening IFRS statement of financial position at 1 January 2010. In preparing its opening IFRS statement of financial position, the Group has had to adjust amounts previously reported in the financial statements prepared in accordance with Luxembourg GAAP. An explanation of how the transition from Luxembourg GAAP to IFRS has affected the Group’s financial position, financial performance and cash flows at 1 January 2010 and 31 December 2012, being the Group’s most recent annual financial statements prepared in accordance with Luxembourg GAAP, are set out in the following tables and notes. Reconciliation of equity at 1 January 2010 Assets Non-current assets Property, plant and equipment Intangible assets LUXEMBOURG GAAP USD ADJUSTMENT1 USD 1,713,456 2,519,618 2,519,618 (2,519,618) IFRS USD 4,233,074 – 4,233,074 – 4,233,074 1,422,106 8,708 1,770,523 – – – 1,422,106 8,708 1,770,523 3,201,337 – 3,201,337 7,434,411 – 7,434,411 100,020 10,388,066 (2,671,327) (661,842) – – – – 100,020 10,388,066 (2,671,327) (661,842) 7,154,917 – 7,154,917 Current liabilities Interest bearing loans and borrowings Trade and other payables Current tax liabilities 84,819 189,305 5,370 – – – 84,819 189,305 5,370 Total liabilities 279,494 – 279,494 7,434,411 – 7,434,411 Current assets Trade and other receivables Other current financial assets Cash and cash equivalents Total assets Equity and liability Issued capital Share premium Retained earnings Foreign currency translation reserve Total equity Total equity Adjustment: (1) Reclassification of costs previously capitalised as Research and Development which do not meet the capitalisation criteria under IAS 38 and should be included as part of PPE. The transition to IFRS had no impact on the Group’s financial performance and cash flows at 1 January 2010. 92 Page Reconciliation of total comprehensive income for the year ended 31 December 2012 LUXEMBOURG GAAP USD ADJUSTMENT1 USD ADJUSTMENT2 USD IFRS USD Revenue Cost of sales – – – – – – – – Gross profit – – – – Selling and distribution expenses Administrative expenses Other operating expenses Other operating income (838,331) (7,515,994) (2,007,795) 2,326,259 – (256,490) – – – – – – (838,331) (7,772,484) (2,007,795) 2,326,259 Operating loss (8,035,861) (256,490) – (8,292,351) – 127,704 – (13,500,000) (410,218) 909,013 127,704 (21,293,556) – (16,556) 127,704 (21,310,112) Impairment of financial asset Finance costs Finance income (13,500,000) (537,922) 909,013 Loss before tax (21,164,770) Income tax Loss for the year (16,556) (21,181,326) – – – (256,490) – (256,490) Other comprehensive income Exchange differences on translation (188,516) – – (188,516) Other comprehensive income for the year (188,516) – – (188,516) 127,704 (21,498,628) Total comprehensive income for the year (21,369,842) (256,490) Adjustments: (1) Net costs previously capitalised under Luxembourg GAAP which do not meet capitalisation criteria under IFRS. (2) Net adjustment in respect of finance cost attributable to the PRC receivable using the effective interest rate method under IFRS. 93 Page Reconciliation of equity at 31 December 2012 LUXEMBOURG GAAP USD Assets Non-current assets Property, plant and equipment Investment property Intangible assets Other non‐current financial assets 8,640,825 – 2,863,592 723,883 12,228,300 Current assets Trade and other receivables Other current financial assets Cash and cash equivalents Total assets Equity and liability Issued capital Share premium Retained earnings Foreign currency translation reserve ADJUSTMENT1 USD (256,490) – – – (256,490) ADJUSTMENT2 USD – – – ADJUSTMENT3 USD ADJUSTMENT4 USD 2,824,359 – (2,824,359) (1,597,054) 1,597,054 – IFRS USD 9,611,640 1,597,054 39,233 127,704 – – 851,587 127,704 – – 12,099,514 2,543,640 4,755,051 864,402 – – – – – – – – – – – – 2,543,640 4,755,051 864,402 8,163,093 – – – – 8,163,093 20,262,607 20,391,393 (256,490) 127,704 – – 55,287,000 693,356 (42,140,571) – – (256,490) – – 127,704 – – – – 55,287,000 – 693,356 – (42,269,357) – – – (223,163) – (223,163) Equity attributable to equity holders of parent Non‐controlling interests 13,616,622 70,164 (256,490) – 127,704 – – – – – 13,487,836 70,164 Total equity 13,686,786 (256,490) 127,704 – – 13,558,000 Non-current liabilities Interest bearing loans and borrowings 2,299,304 – – – – 2,299,304 Current liabilities Interest bearing loans and borrowings Trade and other payables Current tax liabilities 2,779,495 1,425,477 200,331 – – – – – – – – – – – – 2,779,495 1,425,477 200,331 4,405,303 – – – – 4,405,303 6,704,607 – – – – 6,704,607 127,704 – – 20,262,607 Total liabilities Total equity 20,391,393 (256,490) Adjustments: (1) Net costs previously capitalised under Luxembourg GAAP which do not meet capitalisation criteria under IFRS. (2) Net adjustment in respect of finance cost attributable to the PRC receivable using the effective interest rate method under IFRS. (3) Reclassification of costs previously capitalised as Research and Development which do not meet the capitalisation criteria under IAS 38 and have been included as part of PPE under IFRS as these meet the capitalisation criteria of IAS 16. (4) Reclassification of PPE to investment property in accordance with IAS 40. 94 Page Section C: Interim review report on RM2 An insnct for growth The Directors RM2 International S.A. 5, rue de la Chapelle L‐1325 Luxembourg Transaction Advisory Services Grant Thornton UK LLP 30 Finsbury Square London EC2P 2YU T +44 (0)20 7383 5100 F +44 (0)20 7184 4301 www.grant‐thornton.co.uk 17 December 2013 Dear Sirs Independent review report to the members of RM2 International S.A. (the Company) and its subsidiary undertakings (together the Group) Introduction We have reviewed the consolidated interim financial statements of the Company for the six months ended 30 June 2013 which comprises interim consolidated statement of comprehensive income, interim consolidated statement of financial position, interim consolidated statement of cash flows and interim consolidated statement of changes in equity. We have read the other information contained in the interim financial statements, which comprises only the notes related to the interim financial statements and considered whether this contains any apparent misstatements or material inconsistencies with the information in the consolidated interim financial statements. This report is made solely to the Company’s members, as a body, in accordance with International Standard on Review Engagements (UK and Ireland) 2410, ‘Review of Interim Financial Information performed by the Independent Auditor of the Entity’. Our review work has been undertaken so that we might state to the Company’s members those matters we are required to state to them in an independent review report and for no other purpose. To the fullest extent permitted by law, we do not accept or assume responsibility to anyone other than the Company and the Company’s members as a body, for our review work, for this report, or for the conclusion we have formed. Directors’ responsibilities The interim consolidated financial statements are the responsibility of, and has been approved by, the directors. The AIM Rules of the London Stock Exchange require that the accounting policies and presentation applied to the financial information in the interim consolidated financial statements are consistent with those which will be adopted in the annual accounts having regard to the accounting standards applicable for such accounts. As disclosed in note 2, the annual financial statements of the Group are prepared in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards as adopted by the European Union. The financial information in the interim consolidated financial statements has been prepared in accordance with the basis of preparation in note 2. Our responsibility Our responsibility is to express to the Company a conclusion on the financial information in the interim consolidated financial statement based on our review. Chartered Accountants Member firm within Grant Thornton International Ltd Grant Thornton UK LLP is a limited liability partnership registered in England and Wales: No. OC307742. Registered office: Grant Thornton House, Melton Street, Euston Square, London NW1 2EP A list of members is available from our registered office. Grant Thornton UK LLP is authorised and regulated by the Financial Services Authority for investment business. 95 Page Scope of review We conducted our review in accordance with International Standard on Review Engagements (UK and Ireland) 2410, ‘Review of Interim Financial Information Performed by the Independent Auditor of the Entity’. A review of interim financial information consists of making enquiries, primarily of persons responsible for financial and accounting matters, and applying analytical and other review procedures. A review is substantially less in scope than an audit conducted in accordance with International Standards on Auditing (UK and Ireland) and consequently does not enable us to obtain assurance that we would become aware of all significant matters that might be identified in an audit. Accordingly, we do not express an audit opinion. Conclusion Based on our review, nothing has come to our attention that causes us to believe that the financial information in the interim consolidated financial statements for the six months ended 30 June 2013 is not prepared, in all material respects, in accordance with the basis of accounting described in note 2. Yours faithfully GRANT THORNTON UK LLP 96 Page Section D: Unaudited interim information on RM2 for the six months ended 30 June 2013 Interim consolidated statement of comprehensive income for the 6 months ended 30 June 2013 UNAUDITED 6 MONTHS UNAUDITED 6 MONTHS ENDED ENDED 30 JUNE 2012 USD 30 JUNE 2013 USD Continuing operations Revenue Cost of sales – – – – Gross profit – – NOTES Selling and distribution expenses Administrative expenses Other operating expenses Other operating income (411,326) (3,625,189) (222,482) 199,549 (410,588) (5,338,413) (571,477) 297,279 Operating loss (4,059,448) (6,023,199) Finance costs Finance income (2,264,606) 88,863 (3,268,635) 373,147 Loss before tax (6,235,191) (8,918,687) (2,528) (37,639) (6,237,719) (8,956,326) Income tax Loss for the period Other comprehensive income Exchange difference on translation of foreign operations (165,062) 368,399 Other comprehensive income for the period, net of tax (165,062) 368,399 Total comprehensive income for the period (6,402,781) (8,587,927) Loss for the period attributable to: Equity holders of the parent Non‐controlling interests (6,236,761) (958) (8,955,789) (537) (6,237,719) (8,956,326) (6,401,823) (958) (8,587,390) (537) (6,402,781) (8,587,927) (0.06) (0.07) Total comprehensive income for the period attributable to: Equity holders of the parent Non‐controlling interests Earnings per share Basic and diluted earnings per share attributable to ordinary equity holders of the parent 9 97 Page Interim consolidated statement of financial position as at 30 June 2013 UNAUDITED 30 JUNE 2012 USD UNAUDITED 30 JUNE 2013 USD 25,352,505 1,547,092 37,003 – 11,437,157 1,524,544 41,572 60,240 26,936,600 13,063,513 – 2,550,435 45,658 7,101,883 – 3,665,672 548,576 3,946,779 9,697,976 8,161,027 Total assets 36,634,576 21,224,540 Equity and liabilities Equity Issued capital Share premium Retained earnings Foreign currency translation reserve Warrant reserve 55,287,000 693,356 (27,195,596) (199,709) – 55,287,000 693,356 (51,225,146) 145,236 2,500,000 28,585,051 7,400,446 68,796 69,627 28,653,847 7,470,073 2,198,446 3,746,888 2,198,446 3,746,888 1,828,083 3,823,126 131,074 – 6,224,678 663,914 291,420 2,827,567 5,782,283 10,007,579 7,980,729 13,754,467 36,634,576 21,224,540 NOTES Assets Non-current assets Property, plant & equipment Investment property Intangible assets Other non‐current financial assets Current assets Inventories Trade and other receivables Other current financial assets Cash and cash equivalents Equity attributable to equity holders of the parent Non‐controlling interests Total equity Non-current liabilities Interest bearing loans and borrowings Current liabilities Interest bearing loans and borrowings Trade and other payables Current tax liabilities Derivative warrant liability Total liabilities Total equity and liabilities 6 7 8 98 Page Interim consolidated statement of changes in equity for the 6 months ended 30 June 2013 Attributable to equity holders of the parent FOREIGN NON‐ CURRENCY SHARE SHARE RETAINED TRANSLATION WARRANT CAPITAL PREMIUM EARNINGS RESERVE RESERVE USD USD USD USD TOTAL USD INTERESTS USD USD TOTAL EQUITY USD 122,860 55,857,496 (20,958,835) (34,647) – 34,986,874 69,754 35,056,628 Loss for the period Other comprehensive income – – – – (6,236,761) – – (165,062) – – (6,236,761) (165,062) (958) – (6,237,719) (165,062) Total comprehensive income – – (6,236,761) (165,062) – (6,401,823) (958) (6,402,781) – – – – – – – – – – – – – 28,585,051 68,796 28,653,847 13,558,000 UNAUDITED As at 1 January 2012 Conversion of share premium to share capital Transaction with owners 55,164,140 55,164,140 As at 30 June 2012 55,287,000 693,356 (27,195,596) (199,709) As at 1 January 2013 (55,164,140) (55,164,140) CONTROLLING 55,287,000 693,356 (42,269,357) (223,163) – 13,487,836 70,164 Loss for the period Other comprehensive income – – – – (8,955,789) – – 368,399 – – (8,955,789) 368,399 (537) – (8,956,326) 368,399 Total comprehensive income – – (8,955,789) 368,399 – (8,587,390) (537) (8,587,927) Issue of warrants – – – – 2,500,000 2,500,000 – 2,500,000 Transaction with owners – – – – 2,500,000 2,500,000 – 2,500,000 55,287,000 693,356 145,236 2,500,000 7,400,446 69,627 7,470,073 As at 30 June 2013 (51,225,146) 99 Page Interim consolidated statement of cash flows for the 6 months ended 30 June 2013 NOTES Cash flows from operating activities Loss before tax UNAUDITED 6 MONTHS ENDED 30 JUNE 2012 USD UNAUDITED 6 MONTHS ENDED 30 JUNE 2013 USD (6,235,191) (8,918,687) 185,707 39,855 (52) 27,281 (148,553) 326,311 354,581 (366,107) 2,894,762 357,281 (39,855) 93,529 1,664,201 (354,581) 577,968 (274,495) (7,916) (13,988) Net cash flows from operating activities (4,420,994) (5,416,955) Cash flows from investing activities Net purchase of/proceeds from intangible assets Purchase of PPE under construction Net purchase of/proceeds from other PPE Repayment of loan notes (4,814) (3,908,254) (89,166) 760 (3,540) – (2,467,480) 4,941,128 Non-cash adjustment to reconcile profit before tax to net cash flows Amortisation and depreciation Provision for inventory obsolescence Finance income Finance expenses Unrealised foreign exchange (gains)/losses Variation in working capital (Increase)/decrease in inventories (Increase)/decrease in trade and other receivables Increase/(decrease) in trade and other payables Income tax paid Interest received 52 Net cash flows from investing activities Cash flows from financing activities Proceeds from other and related party borrowings Net transaction costs paid Net interest paid (4,001,422) 2,836,215 (296,000) 6,232,160 – (27,281) Net cash flows from financing activities 366,107 (500,000) (32,705) (323,281) 5,699,455 Net change in cash and cash equivalents (8,745,697) 3,118,715 Increase/(decrease) in cash and cash equivalents Cash and cash equivalents at 1 January Exchange adjustment of cash and cash equivalents Cash and cash equivalents at 30 June (8,745,697) 15,852,084 (4,504) 7,101,883 3,118,715 864,209 (37,582) 3,945,342 8 100 Page Notes to the interim consolidated financial statements for the 6 months ended 30 June 2013 1 Corporate information RM2 International S.A. (the “Company”) is a limited company (Société Anonyme) incorporated and domiciled in Luxembourg with the registration number B132.740. The registered office is located at Rue de la chapelle 5, L‐1235 Luxembourg. The Company is the ultimate parent entity of the RM2 Group (the “Group”). The Group is principally engaged in developing and selling shipping pallets and in providing related logistical services. The financial statements do not constitute statutory accounts as defined in Section 404 of the Companies Act 2006. The unaudited interim consolidated financial statements do not constitute statutory accounts as defined in Section 404 of the Companies Act 2006. 2 Basis of preparation and accounting policies The unaudited interim consolidated financial information for the six months ended 30 June 2013 has been prepared following the recognition and measurement principles of IFRS as adopted by the European Union. The interim consolidated financial information does not include all the information and disclosures required in the annual financial information, and should be read in conjunction with the Group’s historical financial information for the years ended 31 December 2010, 31 December 2011 and 31 December 2012. The accounting policies and basis of preparation adopted are consistent with those followed in the preparation of the Group’s historical financial information for the years ended 31 December 2010, 31 December 2011 and 31 December 2012. None of the newly applicable IFRS standards and amendments had an impact on the Group’s interim consolidated financial statements. Early adopted standards The Group did not early adopt any new or amended standards and does not plan to early adopt any of the standards issued but not yet effective. 3 Significant accounting judgements, estimates and assumptions When preparing the interim consolidated financial information, management undertakes a number of judgements, estimates and assumptions about recognition and measurement of assets, liabilities, income and expenses. The actual results may differ from the judgements, estimates and assumptions made by management, and will seldom equal the estimated results. The judgements, estimates and assumptions applied in the interim consolidated financial information, including the key sources of estimation uncertainty, were the same as those applied in the Group’s historical financial information for the years ended 31 December 2010, 31 December 2011 and 31 December 2012. 4 Significant events and transactions of the period In June 2013, the Group entered into the following agreements with JKD Capital Partners I Ltd, a third party: • A loan agreement for a maximum facility of USD 15,000,000 of which USD 5,000,000 was drawn down during the period. The drawdown amount bears interest at 10 per cent. per annum. • A warrant agreement granting JKD the right to purchase 614,300 shares of the Company for a price of USD 0.01 per share. JKD may exercise its right starting at the earlier of (i) one week after the completion of the initial public offering of shares on the AIM exchange and (ii) 26 May 2014. The exercise of the Warrant Shares expires on 3 June 2014. The fair value of the warrants at the date of issue was determined to be $2,500,000 and resulted in a warrant reserve at 30 June 2013. 101 Page 5 Seasonality of operations The operations of the Group have not yet started, therefore there is no seasonality in the results presented by the Group. 6 Property, plant and equipment LAND & BUILDING USD PLANT & EQUIPMENT USD CONSTRUCTION TOTAL USD IN PROGRESS USD Cost As at 1 January 2012 Additions Other/transfers Exchange differences 1,804,314 3,528 – (28,487) 236,919 85,640 11,161,614 (3,730) 23,226,097 3,908,254 (11,161,614) (21,459) 25,267,330 3,997,422 – (53,676) As at 30 June 2012 1,779,355 11,480,443 15,951,278 29,211,076 As at 1 January 2013 Additions Exchange differences Other/transfer 1,860,421 7,607 (62,710) – 5,336,483 – (97,182) (1,701,838) 13,771,854 2,467,480 (373,049) – As at 30 June 2013 1,805,318 3,537,463 15,866,285 6,574,950 2,459,873 (213,157) 1,701,838 10,523,504 Depreciation and impairment As at 1 January 2012 Depreciation charge for the period Exchange differences 42,822 21,667 (1,307) 120,278 142,170 (4,522) 3,537,463 – – 3,700,563 163,837 (5,829) As at 30 June 2012 63,182 257,926 3,537,463 3,858,571 As at 1 January 2013 Depreciation charge for the period Exchange differences 92,039 23,565 (3,338) 530,712 281,043 (32,356) 3,537,463 – – 4,160,214 304,608 (35,694) As at 30 June 2013 112,266 779,399 3,537,463 4,429,128 Net book value As at 30 June 2013 1,693,052 9,744,105 – 11,437,157 As at 1 January 2013 1,768,382 6,044,238 1,799,020 9,611,640 As at 30 June 2012 1,716,173 11,222,517 12,413,815 25,352,505 As at 1 January 2012 1,761,492 116,641 19,688,634 21,566,767 102 Page 7 Investment property INVESTMENT PROPERTIES USD Cost As at 1 January 2012 Exchange differences 1,634,108 (26,739) As at 30 June 2012 1,607,369 As at 1 January 2013 Exchange differences 1,681,110 (54,929) As at 30 June 2013 1,626,181 Depreciation and impairment As at 1 January 2012 Depreciation charge for the period Exchange differences 40,853 20,670 (1,246) As at 30 June 2012 60,277 As at 1 January 2013 Depreciation charge for the period Exchange differences 84,056 20,503 (2,922) As at 30 June 2013 101,637 Net book value As at 30 June 2013 1,524,544 As at 1 January 2013 1,597,054 As at 30 June 2012 1,547,092 As at 1 January 2012 1,593,255 The investment property is a building used by the Group for both administrative purposes and for rental. The cost of the property related to the administrative purpose is classified within property, plant and equipment. The cost for the rental part is classified as investment property. 8 Cash and short-term deposits For the purpose of the statement of cash flows, cash and cash equivalents comprise the following at 30 June: 9 AS AT 30/06/2012 USD AS AT 30/06/2013 USD Cash at bank and in hand Short‐term deposits 6,817,404 284,479 3,658,839 287,940 Bank overdraft 7,101,883 – 3,946,779 (1,437) Total cash and cash equivalents 7,101,883 3,945,342 Earnings per share Basic earnings per share amounts are calculated by dividing the net profit for the year attributable to ordinary equity holders of the parent by the weighted average number of ordinary shares outstanding during the year. 103 Page Diluted earnings per share amounts are calculated by dividing the net profit attributable to ordinary equity holders of the parent by the weighted average number of ordinary shares outstanding during the year, plus the weighted average number of ordinary shares that would be issued on conversion of all the dilutive potential ordinary shares into ordinary shares. The following reflects the income and share data used in the basic and diluted earnings per share computations: UNAUDITED 6 MONTHS ENDED 30 JUNE 2012 USD Net loss attributable to ordinary equity holders of the parent for basic and diluted earnings Weighted average number of ordinary shares for basic earnings per share Effect of dilution: Warrant shares to DPE Warrant shares to JKD Weighted average number of ordinary shares adjusted for the effect of dilution Loss per share (basic and diluted) (6,236,761) UNAUDITED 6 MONTHS ENDED 30 JUNE 2013 USD (6,128,222) AS AT 30/06/2012 AS AT 30/06/2013 102,403,810 122,860,000 22,742,751 – 9,900,306 614,300 125,146,561 133,374,606 (0.06) (0.07) For the 6 months ended 30 June 2012 and 2013, the additional shares on exercise of outstanding warrants would decrease the basic loss per share and there is therefore no dilutive effect. 10 Subsequent events On 14 August 2013 the Company entered into an unsecured loan agreement with Floravell, a company controlled by John Walsh, which formalises previous loans made to the Company of US$2,778,083. Under this agreement interest of 2 per cent. per annum is payable by the Company to Floravell on the principal from 1 January 2013. The term of the loan ends on 31 December 2013. In September 2013 the Company entered into an interim finance facility totalling $4.7 million with six different unrelated parties with the principal and any accrued interest being repayable within three days of (i) Admission and (ii) 19 September 2014. The rate of interest on the outstanding principal is 10 per cent. per annum with any amount not paid on the date it is due accruing default interest at 12 per cent. per annum. In addition, on repayment of the principal, the Company must either, at its election: (i) issue to the loan note holder ordinary shares of a market equivalent to 25 per cent. of the initial principal or (ii) pay the loan note holder an amount equal to 25 per cent. of the principal. If the repayment of the principal occurs on or after 20 June 2014 this additional payment shall be increased to 30 per cent. of the principal. On 27 September 2013 the Company entered into an agreement with the shareholders of Equipment Tracking to acquire the entire issued share capital of Equipment Tracking which the Company did not already hold. Completion of the acquisition of Equipment Tracking occurred on 10 December 2013. The Company paid £2 million total consideration for the shares of Equipment Tracking Limited. Of this sum £125,000 had already been paid to the sellers as a non‐refundable deposit. On 27 September 2013 the Company reached an agreement with STM Technologies Inc whereby both parties agreed to terminate a previous commission sales agreement under which the Company had agreed to pay STM a royalty of $4 per pallet sold or rented to customers introduced to the Company by STM. As consideration for this termination the Company agreed to pay STM $2 million. 104 Page On 27 September 2013 the Company participated in a contribution in kind of 842,000 shares of MAFIC SA in order to incorporate and hold 100 per cent. of the issued share capital of Basalt Holding Sarl, a newly incorporated Luxembourg company. On 11 October 2013 the Company’s issued share capital was reorganised. The Company’s share capital was decreased by US$9,956,043 (to reflect absorption of historic losses and reimbursement in kind to Shareholders consisting of all the shares held by the Company in Basalt Holding S.a.r.l.). Linked to such decrease in issued share capital, the ordinary shares designated as J ordinary shares were cancelled. This took the Company’s total issued share capital to US$45,330,956 consisting of 110,574,000 ordinary shares of US$.0.45 each. Immediately following this, the nominal value of the ordinary shares was reduced from US$0.45 to US$0.01 following such reorganisation, the Company’s issued share capital was US$1,105,740, consisting of 110,574,000 ordinary shares of US$0.01 each. On 6 November 2013 the Company issued an additional 22,275,000 Ordinary shares for $0.01 per share for a total consideration of $222,750 taking the Company's total issued share capital to 132,849,000 Ordinary shares of $0.01 each. On 7 November 2013 the Company entered into an agreement with CVI CVF II Lux Securities Trading Sarl (“CarVal”) pursuant to which CarVal agreed to lend the Company $10 million. The Company must repay the full amount of the CarVal principal on the earlier of: completion of an IPO; or 7 November 2014. In addition, the Company must repay the principal together with an additional payment equal to 25 per cent. of the issue of the principal or if full repayment of the principal occurs more than nine months after the date of the agreement an amount equal to 30 per cent. of the principal. Interest is payable each month on the principal at a rate of 10 per cent. per annum. On 8 November 2013 an agreement was entered into between the Company and DPE amending the warrant agreement dated 22 May 2013 in respect of termination of the warrant. As a result, in the event the Company completes an IPO prior to 31 March 2014, simultaneously on completion of an IPO the rights of DPE to receive warrant shares shall immediately terminate and be replaced with an obligation by the Company to (i) pay DPE an aggregate amount equal to $40 million plus the nominal value of the DPE Shares and (ii) upon payment of the nominal value of the DPE Shares by DPE to the Company, to issue the DPE Shares to DPE. 105 Page PART VI FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON EQUIPMENT TRACKING Section A: Accountant’s report on the historical financial information on Equipment Tracking An insnct for growth The Directors RM2 International S.A. 5, rue de la Chapelle L‐1325 Luxembourg Transaction Advisory Services Grant Thornton UK LLP 30 Finsbury Square London EC2P 2YU T +44 (0)20 7383 5100 F +44 (0)20 7184 4301 www.grant‐thornton.co.uk 17 December 2013 Dear Sirs, Equipment Tracking Limited (the Company) We report on the financial information set out in Part VI Section B of the AIM Admission Document dated 17 December 2013 (the “Admission Document”), for the years ended 31 October 2010, 31 October 2011 and 31 October 2012 (the “Financial Information”). This Financial Information has been prepared for inclusion in the Admission Document on the basis of the accounting policies set out in note 1 of the Financial Information. This report is required by Paragraph (a) of Schedule Two of the AIM Rules for Companies and is given for the purpose of complying with that paragraph and for no other purpose. Responsibilities Save for any responsibility arising under Paragraph (a) of Schedule Two of the AIM Rules for Companies to any person as and to the extent there provided, to the fullest extent permitted by law we do not assume any responsibility and will not accept any liability to any other person for any loss suffered by any such other person as a result of, arising out of, or in connection with this report or our statement, required by and given solely for the purposes of complying with Paragraph (a) of Schedule Two of the AIM Rules for Companies, consenting to its inclusion in the AIM Admission Document. The Directors of RM2 International S.A. are responsible for preparing the Financial Information in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards as adopted by the European Union. It is our responsibility to form an opinion on the Financial Information and to report our opinion to you. Basis of opinion We conducted our work in accordance with the Standards for Investment Reporting issued by the Auditing Practices Board in the United Kingdom. Our work included an assessment of evidence relevant to the amounts and disclosures in the Financial Information. It also included an assessment of the significant estimates and judgements made by those responsible for the Chartered Accountants Member firm within Grant Thornton International Ltd Grant Thornton UK LLP is a limited liability partnership registered in England and Wales: No. OC307742. Registered office: Grant Thornton House, Melton Street, Euston Square, London NW1 2EP A list of members is available from our registered office. Grant Thornton UK LLP is authorised and regulated by the Financial Services Authority for investment business. 106 Page preparation of the Financial Information and whether the accounting policies are appropriate to the entity’s circumstances, consistently applied and adequately disclosed. We planned and performed our work so as to obtain all the information and explanations which we considered necessary in order to provide us with sufficient evidence to give reasonable assurance that the financial information is free from material misstatement, whether caused by fraud or other irregularity or error. Opinion In our opinion, the Financial Information gives, for the purposes of the Admission Document, a true and fair view of the state of affairs of the Company as at 31 October 2010, 31 October 2011 and 31 October 2012 and of its profits, cash flows, recognised gains and losses and changes in equity for the periods then ended in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards adopted by the European Union and has been prepared in a form that is consistent with the accounting policies disclosed in the Financial Information. Declaration For the purposes of Paragraph (a) of Schedule Two of the AIM Rules for Companies we are responsible for this report as part of the Admission Document and declare that we have taken all reasonable care to ensure that the information contained in this report is, to the best of our knowledge, in accordance with the facts and contains no omission likely to affect its import. This declaration is included in the Admission Document in compliance with Schedule Two of the AIM Rules for Companies. Yours faithfully GRANT THORNTON UK LLP 107 Page Section B: Historical consolidated financial information on Equipment Tracking for the three years ended 31 October 2012 The financial information of Equipment Tracking set out below for the three years ended 31 October 2012 has been prepared by the Directors of RM2 International S.A. on the basis set out in note 1. The accompanying notes represent an integral part of the financial information. The financial information contained within this section does not constitute statutory financial accounts within the meaning of section 434 of the Act. Statement of comprehensive income NOTES Continuing operations Revenue Administrative expenses 2 2010 USD 2011 USD 2012 USD 922,690 (779,024) 992,033 (881,715) 1,306,534 (1,065,832) Operating profit Finance Income Finance costs 4 5 143,666 35 (1,583) 110,318 21 (3,727) 240,702 20 (3,544) Profit before income tax Income tax 6 7 142,118 (27,003) 106,612 (20,171) 237,178 (41,358) 115,115 86,441 195,820 184 175 1,539 115,299 86,616 197,359 Profit for the year Effect of foreign exchange translation Total comprehensive income 108 Page Statement of financial position NOTES 2009 USD 2010 USD 2011 USD 2012 USD 8 75,052 123,307 108,193 107,936 75,052 123,307 108,193 107,936 83,858 12,536 100,758 55,845 111,412 66,969 251,520 61,277 96,394 156,603 178,381 312,797 171,446 279,910 286,574 420,733 165 16,495 3,194 165 41,454 3,377 165 26,117 3,553 165 128,295 5,092 19,854 44,996 29,835 133,552 12 12,226 18,471 18,574 15,516 12 13 8,284 108,902 22,180 58,949 129,666 27,827 40,702 177,196 20,267 34,156 195,471 42,038 139,366 216,442 238,165 271,665 Total liabilities 151,592 234,913 256,739 287,181 Total equity and liabilities 171,446 279,910 286,574 420,733 Assets Non-current assets Property, plant and equipment Current assets Trade and other receivables Cash and cash equivalents 9 10 Total assets Equity Called up share capital Retained earnings Other reserves 11 Total equity Liabilities Non-current liabilities Long term borrowings Current liabilities Current borrowings Trade and other payables Current tax liabilities 109 Page Statement of changes in equity 1 November 2009 Dividends paid CALLED UP RETAINED OTHER TOTAL SHARE CAPITAL EARNINGS RESERVES EQUITY USD USD USD USD 165 – 16,495 (90,157) 3,194 – 19,854 (90,157) Transactions with owners – (90,157) – (90,157) Profit for the year Effect of foreign exchange translation * – 115,115 – – 184 115,115 184 Total comprehensive income – 115,115 184 115,299 31 October 2010 Dividends paid 165 – 41,453 (101,777) 3,378 – 44,996 (101,777) Transactions with owners – (101,777) – (101,777) Profit for the year Effect of foreign exchange translation – – 86,441 – – 175 86,441 175 Total comprehensive income – 86,441 175 86,616 31 October 2011 Dividends paid 165 – 26,117 (93,642) 3,553 – Transactions with owners – (93,642) – – Profit for the year Effect of foreign exchange translation – – 195,820 – – 1,539 195,820 1,539 Total comprehensive income – 195,280 1,539 197,359 165 128,295 5,092 133,552 31 October 2012 29,835 (93,642) 110 Page Statement of cash flows 2010 USD 2011 USD 2012 USD Cash flows from operating activities Profit before tax Depreciation charges Loss on disposal of property, plant and equipment Increase in trade and other receivables Increase in trade and other payables Effects of foreign currency Interest paid Interest received 142,118 9,226 16,804 (16,900) 20,764 1,917 1,583 (34) 106,612 21,033 2,545 (10,654) 47,530 (433) 3,727 (21) 237,178 23,440 – (140,108) 18,275 2,440 3,544 (20) Cash generated from operations Interest paid Taxation paid 175,478 (1,583) (21,355) 170,339 (3,727) (27,732) 144,749 (3,544) (19,586) Net cash inflow from operating activities 152,540 138,880 121,619 Cash flows from investing activities Purchase of property, plant and equipment Proceeds from the disposal of property, plant and equipment Interest received (7,185) 17,735 34 (11,118) 3,262 21 (24,085) – 20 Net cash inflow/(outflow) from investing activities 10,584 (7,835) (24,065) Cash flows from financing activities Repayments of finance lease arrangements Dividends paid (29,658) (90,157) (18,144) (101,777) (27,067) (93,642) Net cash outflow from financing activities (119,815) (119,921) (120,709) Increase/(decrease) in cash and cash equivalents Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of period 43,309 12,536 11,124 55,845 (23,155) 66,969 Cash and cash equivalents at end of period 55,845 66,969 43,814 111 Page CORPORATE INFORMATION Equipment Tracking is a technology company providing software solutions to various industries. Equipment Tracking is a limited company domiciled in the United Kingdom and incorporated under registered number 05274087 in England and Wales. Equipment Tracking’s registered office is Ty Matthew House, Llys Edmund Prys, St Asaph, Denbighshire, LL17 0JA. 1. ACCOUNTING POLICIES BASIS OF PREPARATION This historical financial information comprises the financial statements of Equipment Tracking as at 31 October for each of the three years 2010, 2011 and 2012 and is prepared under the historic cost convention. The historical financial information has been prepared for the purposes of the acquisition of Equipment Tracking. The historical financial information has been prepared in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards (“IFRS”) as adopted by the European Union (“EU”), IFRIC interpretations and the Companies Act 2006 applicable to companies reporting under IFRS. The historical financial information has been prepared under the historical cost convention. The accounting policies which follow set out the policies applied in preparing the historical financial information. The historical financial information is presented in USD the functional currency of the acquiring Group. The company’s functional currency is Sterling. The information is shown in the functional currency of the acquiring group for better understanding of the company’s position in the new group. Revenue recognition Revenue is measured at the fair value of the consideration received or receivable and represents amounts receivable for services provided in the normal course of business, net of VAT. The company recognises revenue when the amount of revenue can be reliably measured; when it is probable that future economic benefits will flow to the entity; and when specific criteria have been met for each of the company’s activities, as described below. Revenue relating to software development that is contracted on a time and materials basis is recognised as the services are performed. Revenue relating to the sale of software licences is recognised over the period to which the license relates. Revenue from services provided is determined by management’s assessment of the percentage completed of each contract. Management determine the percentage of completion by considering the work performed to date based upon internal reports and agreed project milestones. Revenue in respect of the sales of pallets is recognised at the time that title to the goods passes. Revenue is measured at the fair value of the consideration received or receivable for the goods in the normal course of business net of VAT. Property, plant and equipment Depreciation is provided at the following annual rates in order to write off each asset over its estimated useful life. Fixtures, fittings and equipment Motor vehicles – 15% reducing balance – 25% reducing balance Property, plant and equipment are stated at cost less accumulated depreciation and any recognised impairment loss. Taxation Tax expense represents the sum of the current tax and deferred tax charge for the year. 112 Page Current tax The current tax payable is based on taxable profit for the year. Taxable profit differs from profit as reported in the Statement of Comprehensive Income because it excludes items of income or expense that are taxable or deductible in other periods and it further excludes items that are never taxable or deductible. The Company’s liability for current tax is calculated using tax rates that have been enacted or substantively enacted by the year end. Deferred tax Deferred taxes are provided in full, using the liability method, for all temporary differences arising between the tax bases of assets and liabilities and their carrying amounts in the Financial Statements. Deferred taxes are determined using tax rates that have been enacted or substantially enacted and are expected to apply when the related deferred tax asset is realised or the related deferred tax liability is settled. The principal temporary differences arise from depreciation or amortisation charged on assets and tax losses carried forward. Deferred tax assets relating to the carry forward of unused tax losses are recognised to the extent that it is probable that future taxable profit will be available against which the unused tax losses can be utilised. The carrying amount of deferred tax assets is reviewed at each balance sheet date and reduced to the extent that it is probable that sufficient taxable profits will be available to allow all or part of the asset to be recovered. Research and development Expenditure on research is written off in the year in which it is incurred. Development expenditure is written off in the same year unless the directors are satisfied as to the technical, commercial and financial viability of individual projects and the related costs can be measured reliably. In this situation, the expenditure is deferred and amortised within administration costs over the period from which the company is expected to benefit. To date no amounts have been capitalised in respect of the development phase of internal projects as management have assessed that they are unable to demonstrate that they have met all of the recognition criteria. Operating leases Operating lease payments are recognised as an expense on a straight‐line basis over the lease term, except if another systematic basis is more representative of the time pattern in which economic benefits will flow to the company. Contingent rentals arising under operating leases are recognised in the period in which they are incurred. Lease incentives and similar arrangements of incentives are taken into account when calculating the straight‐lined expense and spread over the lease term. Rentals paid under operating leases are charged to the income statement on a straight line basis over the period of the lease. Finance leases Assets held under finance leases are recognised as assets of the company at the fair value at the inception of the lease or if lower, at the present value of the minimum lease payments. The related liability to the lessor is included in the statement of financial position as a finance lease obligation. Lease payments are apportioned between interest expenses and capital redemption of the liability. Interest is recognised immediately in profit or loss, unless attributable to qualifying assets, in which case they are capitalised to the cost of those assets. Contingent rentals are recognised as expenses in the periods in which they are incurred. 113 Page Conversion of foreign currency Monetary assets and liabilities in sterling are translated into USD at the rate of exchange ruling at the balance sheet date. Transactions are translated at the average rate for the period. Non‐monetary assets having been translated are carried at their historical cost. Exchange differences are taken to into other comprehensive income and taken to other reserves. Critical accounting estimates and judgements The preparation of the financial statements in conformity with IFRS requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of revenue, expenses, assets and liabilities. The estimates and judgements are based on historical experience and other factors, including expectations of future events that are believed to be reasonable and constitute management’s best judgement at the date of the financial statements. In the future, actual experience could differ from those estimates. Further details of estimates and assumptions are set out in each of the relevant accounting policies and detailed notes to the financial statements. The principal judgements made by management that could have a significant impact upon the company’s financial results relate to the following: • the assertions in the preparation of the financial statements on a going concern basis; • the recognition of revenue on longer term contracts; • the treatment of product development costs; • the assessment and appropriateness of recognition of deferred tax assets; • the fair value of the financial instruments: and • the assessment of receivables for impairment. Financial Instruments Financial instruments are initially recognised at fair value. Fair value is the amount at which such an instrument could be exchanged in an arm’s‐length transaction between informed and willing parties. Derecognition of financial assets occurs when the rights to receive cash flows from the investments expire or substantially all of the risks and rewards of ownership have been transferred. An assessment for impairment is undertaken at least at each statement of financial position date whether or not there is objective evidence that a financial asset is impaired. Trade and other receivables are recognised initially at fair value and subsequently at amortised costs under the effective interest method. If collection is expected in one year or less (or in the normal operating cycle of the business if longer), they are classified as current assets. If not, they are presented as non‐current assets. Cash and cash equivalents comprise cash at bank and in hand as well as short term bank deposits. Financial liabilities are obligations to pay cash or other financial assets and are recognised when the company becomes party to the contractual provisions of the instrument. All financial liabilities are recorded initially at fair value, net of direct issue costs and subsequently measured at amortised cost using the effective interest method, less settlement payments. Interest related charges are recognised as an expense in finance costs in the income statement. Finance charges, including premiums payable on settlement or redemption and direct issue costs are charged to the income statement on an accruals basis using the effective interest method. They are added to the carrying amount of the instrument to the extent that they are not settled in the period in which they arise. Trade payables are obligations to pay for goods, services and fees that have been either acquired or incurred in the ordinary course of business. Amounts payable are classified as current liabilities if payment is due within one year or less (or in the normal operating cycle of the business if longer). If not they are presented as non‐current liabilities. 114 Page A financial liability is derecognised only when the obligation is discharged, cancelled or expires. Pension costs Pension contributions to defined contribution schemes are recognised as they fall due. 2. SEGMENT REPORTING Operating segments are based on internal reports about components of the company, which are regularly reviewed and used by the Board of Directors being the Chief Operating Decision Maker (“CODM”) for strategic decision making and resource allocation, in order to allocate resources to the segment and to assess its performance. The company’s operations are centred on software services to its customers. The business is structured as a single entity company and its financial reporting is set to report to the CODM information as a whole. Management therefore considers there to be only a single reporting segment covering the entire company although revenue analysis is provided below. Therefore additional analysis of the figures reported in these financial statements is neither appropriate nor necessary to enable users of the financial statements to evaluate the nature and financial effects of the business activities. An analysis of revenue is as follows: Software services and licences Pallet sales AS AT 31/10/10 USD AS AT 31/10/11 USD AS AT 31/10/12 USD 882,201 40,489 932,277 59,756 1,206,981 99,553 922,690 922,033 1,036,534 AS AT 31/10/10 USD AS AT 31/10/11 USD AS AT 31/10/12 USD 922,690 992,033 1,306,534 AS AT 31/10/10 USD AS AT 31/10/11 USD AS AT 31/10/12 USD 506,732 15,204 23,900 558,817 17,023 22,529 642,636 25,940 29,249 545,836 598,369 697,825 AS AT 31/10/10 USD AS AT 31/10/11 USD AS AT 31/10/12 USD 2 10 12 2 11 13 4 12 18 87,740 92,194 135,962 7,871 7,992 12,432 The geographical split of revenue is as follows: Europe 3. EMPLOYEES AND DIRECTORS Wages and salaries Social security costs Other pension costs The average monthly number of employees during the periods were as follows: Directors Administration and software developers Directors’ remuneration Directors’ pension contributions to money purchase schemes 115 Page 4. FINANCE INCOME AS AT 31/10/10 USD AS AT 31/10/11 USD AS AT 31/10/12 USD 35 21 20 AS AT 31/10/10 USD AS AT 31/10/11 USD AS AT 31/10/12 USD 1,578 5 3,723 4 3,389 155 1,583 3,727 3,544 AS AT 31/10/10 USD AS AT 31/10/11 USD AS AT 31/10/12 USD 16,804 5,616 3,610 9,226 2,545 6,582 14,451 21,033 – 9,508 14,382 23,440 AS AT 31/10/10 USD AS AT 31/10/11 USD AS AT 31/10/12 USD Current tax: Current tax on profits for the year 27,003 20,171 41,358 Taxation expense 27,003 20,171 41,358 Interest receivable 5. FINANCE COSTS Finance costs: Finance lease interest Bank interest 6. PROFIT BEFORE TAX The profit before tax is stated after charging: Loss on disposal of property, plant and equipment Depreciation – owned assets Depreciation – leased assets Operating leases 7. TAXATION Analysis of the tax charge 116 Page Factors affecting the tax charge The tax assessed for the year is lower than the standard rate of corporation tax in the UK. The difference is explained below: AS AT AS AT AS AT 31/10/10 31/10/11 31/10/12 USD USD USD Profit on ordinary activities before tax 8. 142,118 106,612 237,178 Profit on ordinary activities multiplied by the standard rate of corporation tax in the UK of 21%, 20.4% and 20% respectively 29,845 21,763 47,436 Effects of: Capital allowances for period in excess of depreciation Effects of non deductible expenditure Other differences (4,566) 3,684 (1,960) (1,517) 520 (595) (2,318) 787 (4,547) Total taxation 27,003 20,171 41,358 FIXTURES AND MOTOR VEHICLES USD TOTAL USD PROPERTY, PLANT AND EQUIPMENT EQUIPMENT USD Cost At 1 November 2009 Additions Disposals Exchange differences At 31 October 2010 Additions Disposals Exchange differences At 31 October 2011 Additions Exchange differences At 31 October 2012 57,459 7,185 – (1,676) 62,968 11,118 – 349 74,435 24,085 (355) 98,165 71,443 86,568 (58,690) (2,084) 97,237 – (10,728) 539 87,048 – (415) 86,633 128,902 93,753 (58,690) (3,760) 160,205 11,118 (10,728) 888 161,483 24,085 (770) 184,798 Depreciation At 1 November 2009 Charge for year Disposals Exchange differences At 31 October 2010 Charge for year Disposals Exchange differences At 31 October 2011 Charge for year Exchange differences At 31 October 2012 25,123 5,616 – (562) 30,177 6,582 – 198 36,957 9,058 (27) 45,988 28,727 3,610 (24,152) (1,464) 6,721 14,451 (4,922) 83 16,333 14,382 159 30,874 53,850 9,226 (24,152) (2,026) 36,898 21,033 (4,922) 281 53,290 23,440 132 76,862 Net book value As at 31 October 2010 32,791 90,516 123,307 As at 31 October 2011 37,478 70,715 108,193 As at 31 October 2012 52,177 55,759 107,936 117 Page Included within the net book value of USD107,936 is USD55,759 (2011: USD70,715, 2010: USD90,516) relating to assets held under finance lease agreements. The depreciation charged in the year in respect of such assets amounted to USD14,383 (2011: USD14,451, 2010: USD3,610). 9. TRADE AND OTHER RECEIVABLES Trade receivables Other debtors and prepayments Directors current accounts 10. AS AT 31/10/12 USD 88,437 3,270 9,051 106,695 4,717 – 251,520 – – 100,758 111,412 251,520 AS AT 31/10/10 USD AS AT 31/10/11 USD AS AT 31/10/12 USD 55,845 66,969 61,277 AS AT 31/10/10 USD AS AT 31/10/11 USD AS AT 31/10/12 USD 100 100 100 AS AT 31/10/10 USD AS AT 31/10/11 USD AS AT 31/10/12 USD 165 165 165 USD 31 OCTOBER 2011 USD 31 OCTOBER 2012 USD – 58,949 – 40,702 17,462 16,694 58,949 40,702 34,156 18,471 18,574 15,516 CALLED UP SHARE CAPITAL Number of shares in issue Ordinary shares of £1 each in issue at beginning and end of the year Nominal value of shares in issue Nominal value of shares in issue at beginning and end of the year 12. AS AT 31/10/11 USD CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS Cash at bank 11. AS AT 31/10/10 USD BORROWINGS Current: Bank overdrafts Finance lease agreements Non Current Finance lease agreements (repayable between two and five years) Interest rates are fixed for the term of the agreements which are payable by equal fixed monthly amounts. 118 Page 13. TRADE AND OTHER PAYABLES Trade payables Social security and other taxes Accruals and deferred income Directors current accounts AS AT 31/10/10 USD AS AT 31/10/11 USD AS AT 31/10/12 USD 34 40,661 88,822 149 26,748 57,934 87,842 4,672 18,837 68,883 64,484 43,267 129,666 177,196 195,471 AS AT 31/10/10 USD AS AT 31/10/11 USD AS AT 31/10/12 USD The ageing of the trade payables is detailed below: 0 to 30 days 31 to 60 days 61 to 90 days Over 90 days 14. 150 – – (116) 9,170 17,696 – (116) 16,987 (10) 79 1,781 34 26,748 18,837 AS AT 31/10/10 USD AS AT 31/10/11 USD AS AT 31/10/12 USD Amounts due from Directors E Groszek 9,051 – – Amounts due from Directors E Groszek J Ryan Y Walsh P Rowlands – 149 – – 3,861 811 – – 39,776 808 1,875 808 Total 149 4,672 43,267 RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS Directors current accounts No interest has been charged or credited to these loan amounts. 15. RISK MANAGEMENT General objectives, policies and procedures The directors have overall responsibility for the determination of the company’s risk management objectives and operating processes that ensure effective implementation of the policies set out below. Directors receive monthly reports through which they review the effectiveness of the processes put in place and the appropriateness of the objectives and policies they set. The overall objective of the directors is to set policies that seek to reduce risk as far as possible without unduly affecting the company’s competitiveness and flexibility. Further details of these policies are set out below: 119 Page Credit risk Credit risk is the risk of financial loss to a company if a customer or counterparty to a financial instrument fails to meet its contractual obligations. A company is mainly exposed to credit risk from credit sales. It is Equipment Tracking’s policy to assess the credit risk of new customers before entering contracts. Subject to this assessment, Equipment Tracking’s standard payment and delivery terms and conditions are offered. Purchase limits are established for each customer. The directors determine concentrations of credit risk through a monthly review of trade receivables’ ageing analysis. Customers placed as high risk are placed on a restricted customer list and future sales made on a prepayment basis, subject to the discretion of the directors and local management. Currency risks Equipment Tracking’s operations are located in the United Kingdom. Equipment Tracking’s transactions are primarily denominated in Sterling with little exposure to foreign currency risks. Due to the limited risks to the Equipment Tracking, forward exchange contracts are not considered necessary and are not used. The company does not operate foreign currency bank accounts. The translation risk on Equipment Tracking’s foreign exchange payables and receivables is considered to be immaterial due to their short‐term nature. Liquidity risk Liquidity risk arises from Equipment Tracking’s management of working capital and the finance charges and principal repayments on its debt instruments. Equipment Tracking’s policy is to ensure that it will always have sufficient cash to allow it to meet its liabilities when they become due. The Directors receive rolling 12 month cash flow projections on a monthly basis as well as information regarding cash investments. At the year end these projections indicated that the company expected to have sufficient liquid resources to meet its obligations under all reasonably expected circumstances and will not need to secure new facilities with the bank. Budgets are set by the directors, enabling Equipment Tracking’s cash requirements to be anticipated and any increase in facilities requires the approval of the board of directors. Capital management Equipment Tracking’s activities are of a type and stage of development where the most suitable capital structure is that of one almost entirely financed by equities. The directors will reassess the future capital structure when projects under development are sufficiently advanced. Equipment Tracking considers its capital to consist of share capital only. Equipment Tracking’s financial strategy is to utilise its resources and current trading revenue streams to further appraise and test the company’s research and development projects. Equipment Tracking keeps investors informed of its progress with its projects through regular announcements and raises additional equity finance at appropriate times. 120 Page Categories of financial instruments Equipment Tracking’s financial assets are classified as loans and receivables, and all of the company’s financial liabilities are classified as being measured at amortised cost. Financial assets Trade and other receivables Bank balances Total financial assets Non financial assets Other debtors and prepayments Total assets per statement of financial position Trade and other receivables Cash and cash equivalents Financial liabilities Trade and other payables Current borrowings Long term borrowings Total financial liabilities Non financial liabilities Social security and other taxes Current tax liabilities Total liabilities per statement of financial position Long term borrowings Current borrowings Trade and other payables Current tax liabilities 2010 USD 2011 USD 2012 USD 97,488 55,845 106,695 66,969 251,520 61,277 153,333 173,664 312,797 3,270 4,717 – 100,758 55,845 111,412 66,969 251,520 61,277 156,603 178,381 312,797 89,005 58,949 18,471 119,262 40,702 18,574 126,588 34,156 15,516 166,425 178,538 176,260 40,661 27,827 57,934 20,267 68,883 42,038 68,488 78,201 110,921 18,471 58,949 129,666 27,827 18,574 40,702 177,196 20,267 15,516 34,156 195,471 42,038 234,913 256,739 287,181 Disclosure of credit risk The directors consider that the carrying amount of trade and other receivables approximates to their value. The analysis of unimpaired trade receivables that are past due at the end of the period is detailed below: 0 to 30 days 30 to 60 days 60 to 90 days Over 90 days 31 OCTOBER 2010 GROSS USD 31 OCTOBER 2011 GROSS USD 31 OCTOBER 2012 GROSS USD 19,846 – – 79,559 17,951 784 – 142,699 6,278 29,845 – 19,846 98,294 178,822 121 Page 16. FINANCIAL COMMITMENTS Equipment Tracking leases all of its properties. The terms of property leases vary between properties, although they all tend to be tenant‐repairing with periodic rent reviews and break clauses. The total future minimum operating lease payments are due as follows: Not later than one year Later than one year and not later than five years 2010 USD 2011 USD 2012 USD 16,485 248,652 26,956 221,696 49,754 171,942 265,137 248,652 221,696 The minimum lease payment recognised as an expense in the year was USD 26,956 (2011: USD 16,485, 2010: USD 2,936). 17. CONTROLLING INTEREST E Groszek has ultimate control in Equipment Tracking due to her shareholding. 18. TRANSITION TO IFRS Equipment Tracking previously reported under UK GAAP. The transition to IFRS had no impact on the company’s financial position, financial performance and cash flows at 1 November 2009 and 31 October 2012 as there were no measurement differences between UK GAAP and IFRS. 122 Page Section C: Interim review report on Equipment Tracking An insnct for growth The Directors RM2 International S.A. 5, rue de la Chapelle L‐1325 Luxembourg Transaction Advisory Services Grant Thornton UK LLP 30 Finsbury Square London EC2P 2YU T +44 (0)20 7383 5100 F +44 (0)20 7184 4301 www.grant‐thornton.co.uk 17 December 2013 Dear Sirs Independent review report on Equipment Tracking Limited (the Company) Introduction We have reviewed the interim financial statements of the Company for the nine months ended 31 July 2013 which comprises statement of comprehensive income, statement of financial position, statement of cash flows and statement of changes in equity. We have read the other information contained in the interim financial statements, which comprises only the notes related to the interim financial statements and considered whether this contains any apparent misstatements or material inconsistencies with the information in the interim financial statements. This report is made solely to RM2 International S.A.’s members, as a body, in accordance with International Standard on Review Engagements (UK and Ireland) 2410, ‘Review of Interim Financial Information performed by the Independent Auditor of the Entity’. Our review work has been undertaken so that we might state to the RM2 International S.A.’s members those matters we are required to state to them in an independent review report and for no other purpose. To the fullest extent permitted by law, we do not accept or assume responsibility to anyone other than RM2 International S.A. and RM2 International S.A.’s members as a body, for our review work, for this report, or for the conclusion we have formed. Directors’ responsibilities The interim financial statements are the responsibility of, and has been approved by, the directors of RM2 International S.A. The AIM Rules of the London Stock Exchange require that the accounting policies and presentation applied to the financial information in the interim financial statements are consistent with those adopted in the annual accounts having regard to the accounting standards applicable for such accounts. As disclosed in note 1, the annual financial statements of the Company are prepared in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards as adopted by the European Union. The financial information included in the interim financial statements has been prepared in accordance with the basis of preparation in note 1. Our responsibility Our responsibility is to express to the Company a conclusion on the financial information in the interim financial statements based on our review. Chartered Accountants Member firm within Grant Thornton International Ltd Grant Thornton UK LLP is a limited liability partnership registered in England and Wales: No. OC307742. Registered office: Grant Thornton House, Melton Street, Euston Square, London NW1 2EP A list of members is available from our registered office. Grant Thornton UK LLP is authorised and regulated by the Financial Services Authority for investment business. 123 Page Scope of review We conducted our review in accordance with International Standard on Review Engagements (UK and Ireland) 2410, ‘Review of Interim Financial Information Performed by the Independent Auditor of the Entity’. A review of interim financial information consists of making enquiries, primarily of persons responsible for financial and accounting matters, and applying analytical and other review procedures. A review is substantially less in scope than an audit conducted in accordance with International Standards on Auditing (UK and Ireland) and consequently does not enable us to obtain assurance that we would become aware of all significant matters that might be identified in an audit. Accordingly, we do not express an audit opinion. Conclusion Based on our review, nothing has come to our attention that causes us to believe that the financial information in the interim financial statements for the nine months ended 31 July 2013 is not prepared, in all material respects, in accordance with the basis of accounting described in note 1. Yours faithfully GRANT THORNTON UK LLP 124 Page SECTION D: Unaudited interim information on Equipment Tracking for the nine months ended 31 July 2013 9 MONTHS NOTES Continuing operations Revenue Administrative expenses 2 9 MONTHS ENDED ENDED 31 JULY 2013 USD 31 JULY 2012 USD 1,096,324 (1,025,460) 973,951 (782,031) Operating profit Finance Income Finance costs 3 4 70,864 – (2,475) 191,920 29 (2,890) Profit before income tax Income tax 5 68,389 (13,271) 189,059 (38,316) Profit for the period 55,118 150,743 Effect of foreign exchange translation (6,208) Total comprehensive income 48,910 (3,093) 147,650 125 Page Interim statement of financial position as at 31 July 2013 NOTES Assets Non-current assets Property, plant and equipment Current assets Trade and other receivables Cash and cash equivalents 6 7 Total assets AS AT 31 JULY 2013 USD AS AT 31 JULY 2012 USD 148,139 101,479 148,139 101,479 238,834 34,211 291,443 35,591 273,045 327,034 421,184 428,513 Equity Called up share capital Retained earnings Other reserves 165 90,412 (1,116) 165 129,609 460 Total equity 89,461 130,234 8 35,814 – 8 9 33,653 209,460 52,796 56,309 184,785 57,185 295,909 298,279 Total liabilities 331,723 298,279 Total equity and liabilities 421,184 428,513 Liabilities Non-current liabilities Long term borrowings Current liabilities Current borrowings Trade and other payables Current tax liabilities 126 Page Interim statement of changes in equity for the 9 months ended 31 July 2013 1 November 2011 Dividends paid CALLED UP RETAINED OTHER TOTAL SHARE CAPITAL EARNINGS RESERVES EQUITY USD USD USD USD 165 – 26,117 (47,251) 3,553 – 29,835 (47,251) Transactions with owners – (47,251) – (47,251) Profit for the period Effect of foreign exchange translation – – 150,743 – – (3,093) 150,743 (3,093) Total comprehensive income – 150,743 (3,093) 147,650 31 July 2012 Dividends paid 165 – 129,609 (46,391) 460 – 130,234 (46,391) Transactions with owners – (46,391) – (46,391) Profit for the period Effect of foreign exchange translation – – 45,077 – – 4,632 45,077 4,632 Total comprehensive income – 45,077 4,632 49,709 165 – 128,295 (93,001) 5,092 – 133,552 (93,001) Transactions with owners – (93,001) – (93,001) Profit for the period Effect of foreign exchange translation – – 55,118 – – (6,208) 55,118 (6,208) Total comprehensive income – 55,118 (6,208) 48,910 165 90,412 (1,116) 89,461 31 October 2012 Dividends paid 31 July 2013 127 Page Interim statement of cash flows for the nine months ended 31 July 2013 9 MONTHS Cash flows from operating activities Profit before tax Depreciation charges Decrease/(increase) in trade and other receivables Increase in trade and other payables Effects of foreign currency Interest paid Interest received Cash generated from operations Interest paid Taxation paid 9 MONTHS ENDED ENDED 31 JULY 2013 USD 31 JULY 2012 USD 68,389 17,701 12,685 13,989 (1,984) 2,475 – 113,255 (2,475) – 189,059 16,585 (180,031) 7,588 (1,628) 2,890 (29) 34,434 (2,890) – Net cash inflow from operating activities 110,780 31,544 Cash flows from investing activities Purchase of property, plant and equipment Interest received (16,819) – (12,734) 29 Net cash outflow from investing activities (16,819) (12,705) Cash flows from financing activities Repayments of finance lease arrangements Dividends paid (15,054) (93,001) (15,068) (47,251) Net cash outflow from financing activities (108,055) (62,319) (14,094) 43,814 29,720 (43,480) 66,969 23,489 Decrease in cash and cash equivalents Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of period Cash and cash equivalents at end of period 128 Page GENERAL INFORMATION Corporate information Equipment Tracking is a technology company providing software solutions to various industries. Equipment Tracking is a limited company domiciled in the United Kingdom and incorporated under registered number 05274087 in England and Wales. Equipment Tracking’s registered office is Ty Matthew House, Llys Edmund Prys, St Asaph, Denbighshire, LL17 0JA. The unaudited interim consolidated financial statements do not constitute statutory accounts as defined in Section 404 of the Companies Act 2006. 1. BASIS OF PREPARATION AND ACCOUNTING POLICIES The unaudited interim financial information for the nine months ended 31 July 2013 has been prepared following the recognition and measurement principles of IFRS as adopted by the European Union. The interim financial information does not include all the information and disclosures required in the annual financial information, and should be read in conjunction with Equipment Tracking’s historical financial information for the years ended 31 October 2010, 31 October 2011 and 31 October 2012. The accounting policies and basis of preparation adopted are consistent with those followed in the preparation of Equipment Tracking’s historical financial information for the years ended 31 October 2010, 31 October 2011 and 31 October 2012. None of the newly applicable IFRS standards and amendments had an impact on Equipment Tracking’s interim consolidated financial statements. Early adopted standards Equipment Tracking did not early adopt any new or amended standards and does not plan to early adopt any of the standards issued but not yet effective. SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING JUDGEMENTS, ESTIMATES AND ASSUMPTIONS When preparing the interim financial information, management undertakes a number of judgements, estimates and assumptions about recognition and measurement of assets, liabilities, income and expenses. The actual results may differ from the judgements, estimates and assumptions made by management, and will seldom equal the estimated results. The judgements, estimates and assumptions applied in the interim financial information, including the key sources of estimation uncertainty, were the same as those applied in Equipment Tracking’s historical financial information for the years ended 31 October 2010, 31 October 2011 and 31 October 2012. 2. SEGMENT REPORTING Operating segments are based on internal reports about components of the company, which are regularly reviewed and used by the Board of Directors being the Chief Operating Decision Maker (“CODM”) for strategic decision making and resource allocation, in order to allocate resources to the segment and to assess its performance. Equipment Tracking’s operations are centred on software services to its customers. The business is structured as a single entity company and its financial reporting is set to report to the CODM information as a whole. Management therefore considers there to be only a single reporting segment covering the entire company although revenue analysis is provided below. Therefore additional analysis of the figures reported in these financial statements is neither appropriate nor necessary to enable users of the financial statements to evaluate the nature and financial effects of the business activities. 129 Page An analysis of revenue is as follows: 9 MONTHS TO 31 JULY 2013 USD 9 MONTHS TO 31 JULY 2012 USD 1,084,644 11,680 895,766 78,185 1,096,324 973,951 9 MONTHS TO 31 JULY 2013 USD 9 MONTHS TO 31 JULY 2012 USD 1,096,324 973,951 9 MONTHS TO 31 JULY 2013 USD 9 MONTHS TO 31 JULY 2012 USD – 29 9 MONTHS TO 31 JULY 2013 USD 9 MONTHS TO 31 JULY 2012 USD 2,303 172 2,890 – 2,475 2,890 9 MONTHS TO 31 JULY 2013 USD 9 MONTHS TO 31 JULY 2012 USD Current tax: Current tax on profits for the period 13,271 38,316 Taxation expense 13,271 38,316 Software services and licences Pallet sales The geographical split of revenue is as follows: Europe 3. FINANCE INCOME Interest receivable 4. FINANCE COSTS Finance costs: Finance lease interest Bank interest 5. TAXATION Analysis of the tax charge 130 Page Factors affecting the tax charge The tax assessed for the year is lower than the standard rate of corporation tax in the UK. The difference is explained below: 6. 9 MONTHS TO 31 JULY 2013 USD 9 MONTHS TO 31 JULY 2012 USD Profit on ordinary activities before tax 68,389 189,059 Profit on ordinary activities multiplied by the standard rate of corporation tax in the UK of 20% 13,678 37,812 Effects of: Capital allowances for period in excess of depreciation Effects of non deductible expenditure Other differences (1,146) 739 – Total taxation 13,271 38,316 9 MONTHS TO 31 JULY 2013 USD 9 MONTHS TO 31 JULY 2012 USD 238,834 – 286,852 4,591 238,834 291,443 9 MONTHS TO 31 JULY 2013 USD 9 MONTHS TO 31 JULY 2012 USD 34,211 35,591 9 MONTHS TO 31 JULY 2013 USD 9 MONTHS TO 31 JULY 2012 USD 4,491 29,162 12,102 44,207 33,653 56,309 35,814 – TRADE AND OTHER RECEIVABLES Trade receivables Other debtors and prepayments 7. CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS Cash at bank 8. (258) 762 – BORROWINGS Current Bank overdrafts Finance lease agreements Non Current Finance lease agreements (repayable between two and five years) Interest rates are fixed for the term of the agreements which are payable by equal fixed monthly amounts. 131 Page 9. TRADE AND OTHER PAYABLES Trade payables Social security and other taxes Accruals and deferred income Directors current accounts 9 MONTHS TO 31 JULY 2013 USD 9 MONTHS TO 31 JULY 2012 USD 46,773 62,913 58,789 40,985 39,573 59,815 78,226 7,170 209,460 184,784 132 Page PART VII ADDITIONAL INFORMATION 1. Responsibility statements The Directors, whose names and functions are set out on page 4 of this document, and the Company, accept responsibility, both individually and collectively, for all of the information contained in this document and for the Company’s compliance with the AIM Rules for Companies. To the best of the knowledge and belief of the Directors and the Company (who have taken all reasonable care to ensure that such is the case) the information contained in this document is in accordance with the facts and does not omit anything likely to affect the import of such information. To the extent that information has been sourced from a third party, this information has been accurately reproduced and, as far as the Directors are aware and are able to ascertain from information published by that third party, no facts have been omitted which may render the reproduced information inaccurate or misleading. 2. Incorporation and registration 2.1 The Company, whose registered office is at, 5, rue de la Chapelle, L‐1325 Luxembourg, Grand Duchy of Luxembourg was incorporated and registered in Luxembourg under the Luxembourg Companies Law on 23 October 2007 as a société anonyme with registration number B 132 740. 2.2 The principal headquarters of the Company is 5 rue de la Chapelle, L‐1325 Luxembourg, Grand Duchy of Luxembourg. The telephone number at this address is + 352 27 44 96 53. The address of the Company’s corporate website on which the information required by Rule 26 of the AIM Rules for Companies can be found is www.rm2.com. 2.3 The principal activity of the Company is to act as a holding company. There are no exceptional factors which have influenced the Company’s activities. 2.4 The Company is governed by its Articles and the principal legislation under which the Company operates is the Luxembourg Companies Law and the regulations made thereunder. The corporate governance regime applicable to the Company in Luxembourg is the Luxembourg Companies Law and the Company complies with such corporate governance regime. 2.5 The Company has no commercial name other than its registered name and does not operate under any other name. 2.6 The Company’s auditors are Grant Thornton Lux Audit S.A., which is a member of the Insitut des Réviseurs d’Entreprises. The address of Grant Thornton Lux Audit S.A. is 89A, Pafebruch, L‐8308 Capellen, Luxembourg. 2.7 The accounting reference date of the Company is 31 December. 2.8 The Company has no administrative, management or supervisory bodies other than the Board, the Audit Committee, and the Remuneration Committee. In the past, the Company has had a number of other committees including a committee to administer the 2012 Plan. The functions of these committees are being transferred to the Audit Committee and Remuneration Committee, as appropriate. 2.9 The liability of the members of the Company is limited to the amount, if any, unpaid on the shares respectively held by them. 2.10 Save as disclosed in this document, there are no undertakings in which the Company holds a proportion of the capital that is likely to have a significant effect on the assessment of its own assets and liabilities, financial position or profits. 3. Group organisation 3.1 A structure chart showing the Group structure is set out below showing each of the Subsidiaries and the percentage of shares held: 133 Page RM2 International S.A. Corporate Chart RM2 International S.A. RM2 Europe Sp. Z.o.o. Poland RM2 Total Solutions International B.V. (f.k.a. Victoria Rises B.V.) NL RM2 Holland B.V. NL RM2 S.A. RM2 Canada, Inc. (fna 7636156 Canada Inc.) CAN Victoria Rises, Ltd. RM2 France sarl RM2 Total Solutions, Inc. DE, USA FR RM2 IP S.A. LUX UK LUX RM2 S.A. (Swiss Branch) CH RM2 USA Inc. DE, USA Equipment Tracking Ltd. UK 3.2 RM2 S.A. was incorporated in Luxembourg on 7 January 2009. RM2 S.A. is 100 per cent. owned by the Company. The focus of RM2 S.A. is making international sales on behalf of the Group. 3.3 IP Co was incorporated in Luxembourg on 20 September 2011. IP Co is 100 per cent. owned by the Company. IP Co was established to hold intellectual property; however, the Group’s intellectual property is, in fact, primarily owned by RM2 S.A.. IP Co is a dormant company. 3.4 RM2 Holland was incorporated in the Netherlands on 25 October 2007. RM2 Holland is 100 per cent. owned by the Company. The primary role of RM2 Holland is to act as an intermediate holding company. 3.5 Total Solutions Netherlands was incorporated in the Netherlands on 25 October 2007. Total Solutions Netherlands is 100 per cent. owned by the Company. The primary role of Total Solutions Netherlands is to act as an intermediate holding company. 3.6 RM2 Poland was incorporated in Poland on 13 December 2011. RM2 Poland is 100 per cent. owned by the Company. RM2 Poland is a dormant company. 3.7 RM2 Canada was incorporated on 30 August 2010. RM2 Canada is 100 per cent. owned by RM2 Holland. The Group’s main manufacturing and distribution facility is leased by RM2 Canada from a third party and is located at Mississauga in Ontario, Canada. 3.8 RM2 France was incorporated in France on 11 May 2011. RM2 France is 100 per cent. owned by RM2 Holland. RM2 France provides legal support to the rest of the Group. 3.9 VRL was incorporated in the United Kingdom on 5 May 2009. VRL is 100 per cent. owned by Total Solutions Netherlands. VRL is a satellite service office of the Group. 3.10 Equipment Tracking was incorporated on 29 October 2004. Equipment Tracking is owned by Total Solutions Netherlands. 3.11 Total Solutions Inc was incorporated in Delaware on 30 October 2009. Total Solutions Inc is 100 per cent. owned by Total Solutions Netherlands. Total Solutions Inc administers the Group’s pooling business. 3.12 RM2 Swiss Branch was registered in Switzerland as a branch of RM2 S.A. on 6 August 2009. RM2 Swiss Branch operates as a sales unit of the Group and purchases a number of goods for processing in the Group’s manufacturing facilities. 134 Page 3.13 RM2 USA was incorporated in Delaware on 25 May 2010. RM2 USA is 100 per cent. owned by RM2 S.A. The focus of RM2 USA is making sales in North America on behalf of the Group. 4. Share capital 4.1 The issued share capital of the Company at the date of this document and on Admission is/will be: Existing At Admission US$ 1,561,827 3,162,437.51 NUMBER OF ORDINARY SHARES 156,182,775 316,243,751 4.2 The par value of each Ordinary Share is US$0.01. There are currently 156,182,775 Ordinary Shares (including 12,308,775 Restricted Shares) in issue. The Company does not have any issued Ordinary Shares that are not fully paid up. 4.3 The Company’s authorised share capital is currently US$6,842,734.56. 4.4 In the period covered by the financial information set out in Part V of this document, there have been the following changes to the Company’s issued share capital. (a) Before 15 March 2010, the Company’s issued share capital was 100,020 ordinary shares of US$1.00 each, divided equally into ten classes, each class being designated with an identifying letter in a series from A‐J. On 15 March 2010, the Company issued 9,970 ordinary shares (comprising an issue of 10 ordinary shares of US$1.00 at a price per ordinary share of US$46,231 and an issue of 9,960 ordinary shares at a price per ordinary share of US$1.00), taking the Company’s total issued share capital to 109,990 ordinary shares of US$1.00 each. (b) On 14 June 2010, the Company issued ten ordinary shares at a price per ordinary share of US$999, taking the Company’s total issued share capital to 110,000 ordinary shares of US$1.00 each. (c) On 19 August 2011, the Company issued 12,860 ordinary shares at a price per ordinary share of US$3,499, taking the Company’s total issued share capital to 122,860 ordinary shares of US$1.00 each. (d) On 10 February 2012, the nominal value of each ordinary share was reduced from US$1.00 to US$0.45. The ordinary shares were subdivided in a ratio of 1 to 1,000 through the creation of 122,737,140 additional ordinary shares which were issued to shareholders on a pre‐emptive basis, taking the Company’s total issued share capital to 122,860,000 ordinary shares of US$0.45 each. The Company’s share premium was then converted, taking the Company’s total issued share capital to US$55,287,000, consisting of 122,860,000 ordinary shares of US$0.45 each. (e) On 11 October 2013, the Company’s issued share capital was reorganised. The Company’s share capital was decreased by US$9,956,043 (to reflect absorption of historic losses and reimbursement in kind to shareholders consisting of all the shares held by the Company in Basalt Holding S.a.r.l.). Linked to such decrease in issued share capital, the ordinary shares designated as J ordinary shares were cancelled. This took the Company’s total issued share capital to US$45,330,956 consisting of 110,574,000 ordinary shares of US$0.45 each. Immediately following this, the nominal value of the ordinary shares was reduced from US$0.45 to US$0.01. Following such reorganisation, the Company’s issued share capital was US$1,105,740, consisting of 110,574,000 ordinary shares of US$0.01 each. (f) On 6 November 2013, the Company issued an additional 22,275,000 ordinary shares taking the Company’s total issued share capital to 132,849,000 ordinary shares of US$0.01 each. (g) On 14 November 2013, the Company’s shareholders resolved to reorganise the Company’s share capital such that, with effect from Admission, each of the classes of ordinary share designated as A‐I be converted into a single class of ordinary share, being the Ordinary Shares. (h) On 26 November 2013, 11,025,000 Ordinary Shares were issued to certain officers, Directors and key employees of the Company, taking the Company's total issued share capital to 143,874,000 Ordinary Shares. 135 Page (i) On 3 December 2013, 12,308,775 Restricted Shares were granted to certain Directors, taking the Company’s total issued share capital to 156,182,775 Ordinary Shares. 4.5 In addition, the Company has issued options and warrants, details of which are set out in paragraphs 6 and 12 of this Part VII. 4.6 The Directors may issue Ordinary Shares in the Company, within the limit of the Company’s authorised share capital from time to time and subject to Shareholders’ rights of pre‐emption under the Luxembourg Companies Law (in the manner described in more detail described in paragraph 11.3 of this Part VII). The Ordinary Shares are freely transferable. 4.7 The Ordinary Shares all rank pari passu with one another, having an equal right to participate in any dividend, distribution or return of capital and having equal voting rights. 4.8 On Admission, the Company will issue 155,903,548 Placing Shares pursuant to the Placing. 4.9 The New Ordinary Shares will be issued pursuant to the authorities and powers set out in paragraph 11.3 of Part VII of this document. 4.10 The New Ordinary Shares will rank pari passu in all respects with the Existing Ordinary Shares, including the right to vote and to receive dividends and other distributions declared, made or paid after Admission. 4.11 The Directors shall, subject always to the Luxembourg Companies Law and any other applicable laws and regulations and the facilities and requirements of CREST and the Articles, have the power to implement and/or approve any arrangements they may, in their absolute discretion, think fit in relation to (without limitation) the evidencing of title to and transfer of interests in shares in the Company in the form of Depositary Interests or similar interests, instruments or securities, and to the extent such arrangements are so implemented, no provision of the Articles shall apply or have effect to the extent that it is in any respect inconsistent with the holding or transfer thereof or the Ordinary Shares represented thereby. The Directors may from time to time take such actions and do such things as they may, at their absolute discretion, think fit in relation to the operation of any such arrangements. 4.12 The Ordinary Shares are in registered form and in book‐entry form. Following Admission, Ordinary Shares may be delivered, held and settled in CREST by means of the creation of Depositary Interests, details of which are set out in paragraphs 12(m) and 12(o) of this Part VII. A register of Ordinary Shares will be maintained by the Registrar and a register of Depositary Interests will be maintained by the Depositary. 4.13 Save as disclosed in this document and as at the date of this document: (a) no share or loan capital of the Company has been issued or is proposed to be issued; (b) there are no outstanding convertible securities, exchangeable securities or securities with warrants issued by the Company; (c) there are no Ordinary Shares in the Company not representing capital; (d) there are no Ordinary Shares in the Company held by the Company itself or by its Subsidiaries; (e) there are no acquisition rights and/or obligations over authorised but unissued share capital of the Company or undertakings to increase the share capital of the Company; (f) no person has any preferential subscription rights for any share capital of the Company; (g) no commissions, discounts, brokerages or other special items have been granted by the Company since its incorporation in connection with the issue or sale of any Ordinary Shares or loan capital of the Company; and (h) no share or loan capital of the Company is under option or agreed conditionally or unconditionally to be put under option and no commissions, discounts, brokerages or other special terms have been granted by the Company since its incorporation in connection with the issue or sale of any share or loan capital of the Company. 136 Page 4.14 The Ordinary Shares have no redemption or conversion provisions. 4.15 Save as described in this document, the Company has not, nor has any member of the Group, declared any dividends within the period covered by the historical financial information set out in Part V. 5. Significant Shareholders 5.1 As at the date of this document, save for the persons set out below, the Directors are not aware of any beneficial holding of Ordinary Shares representing three per cent. or more of the Company’s issued share capital nor, so far as the Directors are aware, are there any persons who, directly or indirectly, jointly or severally, exercise control over the Company: AT THE DATE OF THIS DOCUMENT NO OF ORDINARY SHAREHOLDER SHARES Invesco Asset Management Limited1 44,550,000 John Walsh 20,052,6802 Domestic Private Equity Investors, LLC 15,809,9783 Matthew Gilfillan 5,094,000 1 2 3 IMMEDIATELY ADMISSION PERCENTAGE SHAREHOLDING FOLLOWING PERCENTAGE SHAREHOLDING NO OF ORDINARY SHARES 28.52 12.84 127,088,000 20,052,680² 40.19 6.34 10.12 3.26 11,090,702 5,094,000 3.51 1.61 The shares held by Invesco Asset Management Limited are owned by the following three funds: 1. Invesco Perpetual High Income Fund, a sub fund of the Invesco Perpetual UK Investment Series Investment Company with Variable Capital, Company Number IC231; 2. Invesco Perpetual Income Fund, a sub fund of the Invesco Perpetual UK 2 Investment Series Investment Company with Variable Capital, Company Number IC221; and 3. Invesco Perpetual UK Equity Pension Fund, a life fund of Invesco Perpetual Life Limited, Company Number 3507379. Includes 6,552,680 Restricted Shares Pursuant to the DPE Warrants described in paragraph 12(b) of Part VII 5.2 The voting rights attaching to the Ordinary Shares are set out in paragraph 11.13 of this Part VII. Significant Shareholders in the Company do not have different voting rights to other holders of Ordinary Shares. 6. Share options and Restricted Shares 6.1 The 2013 Plan Pursuant to the Company’s current employee share option plan (the “2013 Plan”), the Company has granted options over 1,917,000 Ordinary Shares (“2013 Options”) to 18 of the Group’s key employees (“2013 Optionholders”). One third of the total number of 2013 Options granted to each 2013 Optionholder vests on each of the first three anniversaries of the date of Admission, subject to on each such anniversary the 2013 Optionholder being an employee of the Group and not having given notice to terminate their employment. Once the 2013 Options have vested, the exercise price per 2013 Option is the Placing Price. 6.2 Restricted Shares Certain Directors have been granted Restricted Shares as set out in paragraph 7.2 of this Part VII. A Director holding Restricted Shares shall not sell, transfer, mortgage, charge, encumber or otherwise dispose of any of his Restricted Shares as long as certain performance conditions are not fully satisfied (the “Performance Conditions”). The Performance Conditions are linked to the volume weighted average quoted price of the Ordinary Shares (the “Average Price”) for a consecutive 30 day period (the “Relevant Period”). If the Average Price is 50 per cent. higher than the Placing Price for the Relevant Period, the Performance Condition in respect of one third of the Director’s Restricted Shares shall be fulfilled. If the Average Price is 75 per cent. higher than the Placing Price for the Relevant Period, the Performance Condition in respect of a further one third of the Director’s Restricted Shares shall be fulfilled. If the Average Price is 100 per cent. higher than the Placing Price for the Relevant Period, the Performance Condition in respect of the final third of the Director’s Restricted Shares shall be fulfilled. If any Performance Conditions are not fully satisfied by 19 November 2023, the Director shall transfer any of his remaining Restricted Shares to the Company at a purchase price equal to the nominal value of the Restricted Shares, being US$0.01 each. 137 Page 6.3 Authority to grant further options and Restricted Shares The Directors are authorised to grant further options over Ordinary Shares, and/or Restricted Shares, up to a further aggregate amount of US$62,053.86 as part of future equity incentive arrangements. However, no such further grants have been approved or made as at the date of this document. 7. Directors’ shareholdings and other interests 7.1 The beneficial interests of each of the Directors or any member of their family (as defined in the AIM Rules for Companies) in the share capital of the Company at the date of this document and immediately following Admission are expected to be as follows: AT THE DATE OF IMMEDIATELY ADMISSION THIS DOCUMENT NAME Ian Molson John Walsh Ashavani Mohindra Jan Dekker Charles Duro Sir Stuart Rose Amaury de Seze Paul Walsh NO. OF ORDINARY SHARES* 3,951,340 20,052,680 2,034,000 2,124,000 315,000 819,085 819,085 819,085 % SHAREHOLDING 2.53 12.84 1.3 1.36 0.2 0.52 0.52 0.52 FOLLOWING NO. OF ORDINARY SHARES* 3,951,340 20,052,680 2,034,000 2,124,000 315,000 819,085 819,085 1,103,176 % SHAREHOLDING 1.25 6.34 0.64 0.67 0.10 0.26 0.26 0.35 * Includes Restricted Shares held by relevant Director as detailed in paragraph 7.2 below. 7.2 On Admission, the Directors and their families (as described in the AIM Rules for Companies) will have the following Restricted Shares: NAME Ian Molson John Walsh Ashavani Mohindra Jan Dekker Charles Duro Sir Stuart Rose Amaury de Seze Paul Walsh DATE OF GRANT 19 November 2013 19 November 2013 – – 19 November 2013 19 November 2013 19 November 2013 19 November 2013 NUMBER OF RESTRICTED SHARES 3,276,340 6,552,680 – – 22,500 819,085 819,085 819,085 7.3 The Directors and applicable employees (as defined in the AIM Rules for Companies) have agreed not to dispose of any interest in Ordinary Shares for a period of one year from Admission pursuant to the terms of the Lock‐in Arrangements, details of which are summarised in paragraph 12(l) of this Part VII. Each such Locked‐In Shareholder has agreed, for a further year, only to dispose of any interest in Ordinary Shares through Cenkos in order to maintain an orderly market for the Ordinary Shares. 7.4 Save as disclosed in this document, none of the Directors has any interest, whether beneficial or non‐beneficial, in the issued share capital or loan capital of any member of the Group. 7.5 Save as disclosed in this document there are no outstanding loans granted by any member of the Group to any of the Directors and there are no guarantees provided or security given by any member of the Group for the benefit of any of the Directors. 7.6 Save as set out above in this Part VII, no Director nor any member of his family (as defined in the AIM Rules for Companies) has a related financial product (as defined in the AIM Rules for Companies) referenced to the Ordinary Shares being admitted. 138 Page 7.7 The date when each Director was appointed to the Board of the Company (notwithstanding that they may have been directors of other companies in the group before such date) is set out below: NAME Ian Molson John Walsh Ashavani Mohindra Jan Dekker Charles Duro Sir Stuart Rose Amaury de Seze Paul Walsh 8. DATE OF APPOINTMENT 11 October 2013 5 March 2009 11 October 2013 18 December 2008 23 October 2007 11 October 2013 14 November 2013 11 October 2013 Directors’ service agreements and letters of appointment Service Agreement of John Walsh 8.1 On 6 November 2013 the Company entered into a service agreement with John Walsh. Mr Walsh is employed to act as the Chief Executive Officer on a full time basis. Mr Walsh is entitled to a basic salary of £250,000 per annum, which he may receive for services to any Group Company. In addition, Mr Walsh is entitled to participate in any discretionary bonus scheme which the Board may determine, in its absolute discretion, from time to time. The Company may deduct any amounts Mr Walsh owes to the Company from his salary or bonus payments. In addition to the entitlements under his service agreement, Mr Walsh has been granted Restricted Shares as set out in paragraph 7.2 of this Part VII. 8.2 Either party may terminate Mr Walsh’s employment by giving 12 months’ written notice. The Company may elect to pay Mr Walsh in lieu of notice. The Company may terminate Mr Walsh’s contract with immediate effect in certain circumstances, including if Mr Walsh is convicted of a criminal offence, becomes bankrupt, or on grounds of gross misconduct. Notwithstanding the notice provisions relating to his employment, Mr Walsh may not resign as a director of the Company (or of any Group Company) without the prior approval of the Board. 8.3 Mr Walsh has also given certain non‐compete and non‐solicitation covenants covering 12 months following termination of his employment. Mr Walsh has also given certain customary covenants including in respect of confidentiality and ownership of intellectual property. Mr Walsh’s employment with the Group, under a previous contract, commenced on 26 October 2007. Service Agreement of Ashavani Mohindra 8.4 On 16 October 2013 VRL entered into a service agreement with Ashavani Mohindra. Mr Mohindra is employed to act as Chief Financial Officer for the Group on a full time basis. Mr Mohindra has, in addition, been appointed to the Board of the Company. Mr Mohindra is entitled to a basic salary of £150,000 per annum which he may receive for his services to any Group Company. In addition, Mr Mohindra is entitled to participate in any discretionary bonus scheme which the Board may determine, in its absolute discretion, from time to time. The Company may deduct any amounts Mr Mohindra owes to the Company from his salary or bonus payments. 8.5 Either party may terminate Mr Mohindra’s employment by giving 12 months’ written notice. The Company may elect to pay Mr Mohindra in lieu of notice. The Company may terminate Mr Mohindra’s contract with immediate effect in certain circumstances, including if Mr Mohindra is convicted of a criminal offence, becomes bankrupt, or on grounds of gross misconduct. Notwithstanding the notice provisions relating to his employment, Mr Mohindra may not resign as a director of the Company (or of any Group Company) without the prior approval of the Board. 8.6 Mr Mohindra has also given certain non‐compete and non‐solicitation covenants covering 12 months following termination of his employment. Mr Mohindra has also given certain customary covenants including in respect of confidentiality and ownership of intellectual property. Mr Mohindra’s employment with VRL, under a previous contract commenced on 5 May 2009. 139 Page Mandate agreements for the appointment of the Non-Executive Directors 8.7 The Company has entered into mandate agreements with each of the Non‐Executive Directors (the “Appointment Letters”) each of which is, save as set out below, in identical form. 8.8 Pursuant to the Appointment Letters, each Non‐Executive Director other than Ian Molson is entitled to a director’s fee of US$80,000 per annum, paid quarterly in arrears. Ian Molson is entitled to a director’s fee of US$160,000 per annum, paid quarterly in arrears. In addition, certain Non‐Executive Directors have been granted Restricted Shares as set out in paragraph 7.2 of this Part VII. 8.9 Under the terms of the appointment, each Non‐Executive Director is appointed for an initial one year term, ending on the date of the Company’s annual general meeting to approve the 2013 annual accounts. The appointment may be terminated earlier by either party giving two months’ written notice. In addition, the Company may terminate the appointment early in certain customary circumstances including dishonesty, gross misconduct or where the Non‐ Executive Director commits any act which brings the Company into disrepute. 8.10 The Appointment Letter does not specify a minimum time commitment. However, each Non‐Executive Director confirmed that he was able to allocate sufficient time to meet the expectations generally expected of a Non‐Executive Director and confirmed that he had notified the Board of other business commitments and had declared any potential conflicts. The Company may require a Non‐Executive Director to relinquish any external position if the Board believes such positions compromise his ability to carry out the role. Each Non‐Executive Director has covenanted not, during the appointment or for one year thereafter, to be employed or engaged by, or acquire a material financial interest in, any entity which competes with the Group. Each Non‐Executive Director has also given undertakings as to, amongst other things, confidentiality and ownership of intellectual property. 9. Additional information on the Board Save as set out below, none of the Directors is, nor has been within the five years prior to the publication of this document, a partner in any partnership. Save as set out below, none of the Directors has held directorships of a company, wheresoever incorporated, within the five years prior to the date of this document. Within the five years prior to the publication of this document, the Directors hold or have held the following directorships or partnerships: CURRENT PAST NAME Ian Molson DIRECTORSHIPS/PARTNERSHIPS DIRECTORSHIPS/PARTNERSHIPS Alphatec Spine Inc. Cayzer Continuation PCC Ltd Central European Petroleum Ltd Healthpoint LLC The Royal Marsden NHS Foundation Trust The Royal Marsden Cancer Charity Lennox Investment Management LLP Sapphire Industrials Corp. Scient’x World Gold Systems Limited John Walsh RM2 Plc RM Squared Limited Ashavani Mohindra Victoria Rises Ltd RM2 Plc RM Squared Limited 140 Page CURRENT PAST NAME Sir Stuart Rose DIRECTORSHIPS/PARTNERSHIPS DIRECTORSHIPS/PARTNERSHIPS A. Levy & Son Limited No Exclusions Limited Wheb LLP Stylemania Ltd Dorsub (DPR) Limited (Ireland) Ocado Group plc Blue Inc Dressipi Fat Face Group Limited The Oasis Healthcare Group Limited Soak & Sleep Holdings Limited Soak & Sleep Limited Booker plc Arcadia Group Marks and Spencer plc Paul Walsh Avanti Communications Group Plc Unilever Plc FedEx Corporation United Spirits Limited Centrica Plc Diageo Plc Jan Dekker Pamoja Business Holding SA John Taylor Corporate Therabel Europe Limited Zap Holding SA Therabel Pharmaceuticals Limited Sopal International SA Therabel Pharma NV RM2 S.A. RM2 IP S.A. RM2 Total Solutions International B.V. RM2 Holland B.V. Oxbow Sulphur & Fertiliser S.a.r.l. Amaury de Seze Carrefour S.A BW Group Erbe S.A. Groupe Bruxelles Lambert Imerys Publicis Group Suez Environnement Company PAI Partners S.A.S Pargesa Holding S.A. Thales Industriel Marcel Dassault S.A.S. Gras Savoye S.C.A Power Financial Corporation Charles Duro 3M Management SA 6543 Luxembourg S.A. Agregat S.A. Alissia SA Amanthus SA Aquarius International SA Astonia S.A. ATF Investissements SA Avaton SARL B.O.A Participants Bahnhof Holdings S.A. Barnley Properties SA Bemol SA Arun Immobiliere SA Ast Investments SA Beyond SA Bluedream SA Brothers Holding SA Butterfly Participation SA Caprice SA Ceigems SA Cim Global SA Cygnus SA Dellen Participation SA Dreamline Participation SA Empha SA 141 Page CURRENT NAME DIRECTORSHIPS/PARTNERSHIPS Charles Duro (Cont.) BHL S.A. Bluet S.A. Bolero Investments S.A. Bouganvillea SA Caelum SARL Carthesio Holding SA Casuarina SA Ceigems S.A. Cenoby SA Chateau Neuf Investment SA CM Capital Markets SA Combourg SA Compagnie Financiere Francaise S.A. Compass Rose SA Gutty S.A. Dellen Participation SA Delphin Participation SA Diamarys SARL Drei Fluegel SA Eagle River SA Ecomulsion Fuel Solutions SA Ecomulsion Holdings SA Epazote SA European Resorts S.A. Ferlim S.A. Fie SA Fin Claude SA Financiere De Diekirch Fininvest SARL Finvela SA Four J's Development Tools Holding SA Francois 1ER Investment & Property GCB Coal Holding SA Global Offshore S.A. Greisendall S.A. Greisendall Holding S.A. Gresis SA H.F.I. S.A. Happyness Holding S.A. Hoffman & Clark Investments SA ICEC Holding SARL ICEC Holding 2 SARL Ideology S.A. IFG Continent Holding SA Inforad Holding SA Japi SA J‐Fin SA J‐Group Invest SA Joint Bulk Investors S.A. Kangaroo Invest SA Koenigsallee LP S.a.r.l Koenigsallee LP II S.a.r.l Koenigsallee LP III S.a.r.l PAST DIRECTORSHIPS/PARTNERSHIPS Enrc Investments Sàrl E.R.D. Financiere SA Far Sud SA Fin Group SA Gear Investments & Properties SA Giar SA Halter SA Hawthorn Participation SA Hazon SA H.L. Heavy Load SA Immolux Holding SA Imperial Life Finance Sàrl Innovision Holding SA Interimmobiliere SA International Trade Service SA Inter Republic SA Investmarket Holding SA ISG Immobiliere SA I.T. Consult SA J2CG SA Kairos Estate SA Koine Hestia SA (MCV) Koenigsallee Fixtures Sàrl (MCV) Koenigsallee GP Sàrl Kyriel SA Latione SA Lubaz SA Lux Board SA Mafic SA Marsango Financiere SA Marine Investments SA Merc‐Invest SA Moorsee Investments SA Neptunia SA New Land SA Open Invest SA Padouhann SA Palladiana Investment SA Rafael Productions SARL Randea SA Red‐Real Estate Developments SA Restart SA RM2 Partners SA Rm Trading Lux SA Ruban Bleu Holding SA Russia Contact Center SA SIA World SA SET Management Sàrl SDI Societe de Developpement Immobilier SA Sirej SA Stargate SA Steel Lux SA Tarco Oil International SA 142 Page CURRENT NAME DIRECTORSHIPS/PARTNERSHIPS Charles Duro (Cont.) Koenigsallee LP IV S.a.r.l Koenigsallee LP V S.a.r.l Kroon Shipping International S.A. La Capite S.A. Lady Holding S.A. La Grande Viree SA Limpiditi SA LRD SA Luxbus SA Luxco 66 sarl Machiavelli re SA Manestan S.A. Martingale SA Mazel SA MMB S.A. Nilimmo SA Northern Stone S.A. Novaplot SARL Nova Spirit Invest SA NYSA Horizont SA Oikia Holding SA Overware S.A. Oxbow Luxembourg SARL Oxbow Luxembourg Latinamerica Holding SARL Oxbow Suphur & Fertiliser Palan S.A. Pamoja Business Holdings SARL Pamoja Education Holdings SARL Pamoja Holdings LUX 1 SARL Placements Financiers et Industriels S.A. Preinvestment Holding SA Red Cedar SARL Rey Project International SA RM2 SA RM2 IP SA Romarine SA Royal Flush SA Ruggell SA Saler S.A. San Carlos Systems SA Savannah Investments SA Savox S.A. Savox International S.A. Savox Investments S.A. SBS (Luxembourg) Holding SARL SBT Star Bulk & Tankers A.G. Scolbel Participations SA Sheik Coast S.A. Shipping et Industry S.A. Siriade SA Sirius Holding SA Siro SA So.Co.Mai S.A. PAST DIRECTORSHIPS/PARTNERSHIPS Thermic Investments SA Trentelacs SA Valuable Assets SA Viking Capital SA Viking River Cruises SA Vitale Holding SA Vittoria Participations SA Winni SA World Company SA 143 Page CURRENT NAME DIRECTORSHIPS/PARTNERSHIPS Charles Duro (Cont.) So.De.Co LUX S.A. Softpar S.A. Spirit of Adventure S.A. Spirit of Discovery SA Spirit of the Enterprise S.A Sunray Investment SA Superplast S.A. Ta Venture SA THA SA Thaleya SA Thermidor SA Therabel Sarl Tradewi SA Travinter S.A. Trentelacs S.A. Two Stars SA Verbena Investissements SA Vetrelli S.A. Viking Croisieres S.A. Watford S.A. Webfinance S.A. Welku S.A. Zapfi International SA Zapfi Network International SA Zapfunding SARL Zapholding SA Zunis S.A. Leman Holding A/S Leman International System Transport A/S Nauta S.A. Viking Capital S.A. Viking River Cruises LTD PAST DIRECTORSHIPS/PARTNERSHIPS The full names of each of the Directors are: John James Walsh, Robert Ian Molson, Paul Steven Walsh, Sir Stuart Alan Rawson Rose, Jan Arie Dekker, Charles Jean Marie Duro, Ashavani Kumar Mohindra, and Amaury Daniel de Seze. 9.1 Save as disclosed in this document, no Director has: (a) any unspent convictions in relation to indictable offences; (b) had a bankruptcy order made against him or entered into an individual voluntary arrangement; (c) been a director of a company which has been placed in receivership, compulsory liquidation, creditors’ voluntary liquidation, administration or company voluntary arrangement or which entered into any composition or arrangement with its creditors generally or any class of its creditors whilst he was a director of that company or within the 12 months after he ceased to be a director of that company; (d) been a partner in any partnership placed into compulsory liquidation, administration or partnership voluntary arrangement where such Director was a partner at the time of or within the 12 months preceding such event; (e) been subject to the receivership of any asset of such Director or of a partnership of which the Director was a partner at the time of or within 12 months preceding such event; or 144 Page (f) received public criticisms by statutory or regulatory authorities (including designated professional bodies) and no Director has been disqualified from acting as a director of a company or from acting in the management or conduct of the affairs of any company. 9.2 Ian Molson was a non‐executive director of EFDEX, Inc. which was put into insolvent liquidation on 15 September 2000 and wound up on 20 January 2003. 9.3 Save as disclosed in this document, no Director has been interested in any transaction with the Company which was unusual in its nature or conditions, or significant to the business of the Company during the current financial year which remains outstanding or unperformed. 10. Employees As at 31 December 2012, the Group had 51 employees. As at 30 June 2013, being the latest date for which full figures are available, the Group employed 77 staff. Equipment Tracking, which became part of the Group following completion of the agreement described in paragraph 12(h) of Part VII, had 22 employees, as at the latest date for which figures are available. 11. Articles of Association The Articles, which were adopted by the Shareholders, conditional on Admission, in their current amended and restated form pursuant to a resolution passed at an extraordinary general meeting of the Company held on 14 November 2013, contain provisions which are summarised below in this paragraph 11. 11.1 Duration The Company is formed for an unlimited duration. 11.2 Authorised share capital The authorised share capital of the Company is set at US$6,842,734.61. This may be increased from time to time by a resolution of the Shareholders passed at an extraordinary meeting of Shareholders at which at least one half of the share capital of the Company is represented (unless at an adjourned meeting) and by a majority of at least two thirds of the votes cast (a “Special Majority”). 11.3 Alteration of share capital All Ordinary Shares (which term for the purposes of this paragraph 11 includes any shares of any other class in the share capital of the Company from time to time) shall be issued by the Company as fully paid‐up and in registered form. Ordinary Shares may not be converted into bearer shares. No Ordinary Shares may be issued by the Company if such issue would result in the issued share capital of the Company exceeding the authorised share capital of the Company from time to time. Within the limits of the overall authorised capital, the Board is authorised and empowered to issue new Ordinary Shares, grant options exercisable into Ordinary Shares or rights to subscribe for or convert any instruments into Ordinary Shares, against payment in cash or in kind, by contribution of claims, by capitalisation of reserves (including in favour of new Shareholders) or in any other manner determined by the Board. Under the Luxembourg Companies Law Shareholders are entitled to preferential subscription rights in respect of the issuance of Ordinary Shares by the Company for cash (i.e. Shareholders hold pre‐emptive rights to subscribe for Ordinary Shares issued by the Company for cash). The Board is, however, under the Articles authorised to issue such new Ordinary Shares (or grant options exercisable into Ordinary Shares or rights to subscribe for or convert any instruments into Ordinary Shares) up to the limit of the authorised share capital by cancelling or limiting the existing Shareholders’ preferential right to subscribe for the new Ordinary Shares (or options exercisable into new Ordinary Shares, or instruments convertible into new Ordinary Shares) (with the effect that such Ordinary Shares can be issued on a non pre‐ emptive basis): (a) in relation to an employee share option scheme up to the amount of US$62,053.86; and 145 Page (b) in respect of the issue of the New Ordinary Shares in relation to Admission. The authorisations referred to above will expire on the fifth anniversary of the publication of the Articles in their current form in the Luxembourg official gazette (Mémorial) and can be renewed in accordance with the applicable legal provisions. 11.4 Reductions of share capital The issued share capital and the authorised capital of the Company may be reduced from time to time by a resolution of the Shareholders passed at an extraordinary meeting by way of a Special Majority. In the case of a reduction of issued share capital, if the reduction is to be carried out by means of a repayment to Shareholders, creditors whose claims predate the publication in the Mémorial of the minutes of the Shareholders’ meeting deciding the capital reduction may, within 30 days from such publication, apply for the constitution of security to the judge presiding at the chamber of the Tribunal d’Arrondissement. The president may only reject such an application if the creditor already has adequate safeguards or if such security is unnecessary, having regard to the assets of the Company. No payment may be made or waiver given to the Shareholders until such time as the creditors have obtained satisfaction or until the judge presiding at the chamber of the Tribunal d’Arrondissement has ordered that their application should not be acceded to. 11.5 Variation of rights The rights attached to Ordinary Shares may be varied with the approval of Shareholders in general meeting by way of Special Majority (as applied separately to each class of Ordinary Shares in the case of more than one class). 11.6 Ownership of Ordinary Shares The Company is obliged to maintain a register of Shareholders containing details of each Shareholders’ shareholding. Ownership of Ordinary Shares shall be established by an entry in the register. 11.7 Indirect holdings of Ordinary Shares Where Ordinary Shares are recorded in the register of Shareholders on behalf of one or more persons (the “Indirect Holders”) in the name of a securities settlement system or the operator of such a system or in the name of a professional depositary of securities or any other depositary (such systems, professionals or other depositaries being referred to hereinafter, for the purposes of this paragraph, as “Depositaries” and each a “Depositary”) or of a sub‐depositary designated by one or more Depositaries, the Company, subject to its having received from the Depositary with whom those Ordinary Shares are kept in account a certificate in proper form, will permit the Indirect Holders to exercise the rights attaching to those Shares, including admission to and voting at Shareholders’ meetings, and shall consider those persons to be the Shareholders. The Company will make payments, by way of dividends or otherwise, in cash, shares or other assets only into the hands of the Depositary or sub‐depositary recorded in the register of Shareholders of the Company or in accordance with their instructions, and that payment shall release the Company from any and all obligations for such payment. 11.8 Transfers of Ordinary Shares The Ordinary Shares of the Company are free from restrictions on transfer subject to the provisions below. Transfers shall, save in the circumstances set out below in this paragraph 11.8, be carried out by means of a declaration of transfer entered in the share register of the Company, dated and signed by the transferor and the transferee or by their duly authorised representatives, and in accordance with the rules on the assignment of claims laid down in article 1690 of the Luxembourg Civil Code. The Company may accept and enter in the register a transfer on the basis of correspondence or other documents recording the agreement between the transferor and the transferee. 146 Page The Board may, subject to any applicable law, permit Ordinary Shares to be held in uncertificated form and to be transferred without an instrument of transfer by means of a Depositary (including, without limitation, CREST). Where Ordinary Shares are permitted to be transferred by means of a Depositary and the Company is entitled under any applicable law, the Articles or any applicable regulations to sell, transfer, dispose of, forfeit, accept the surrender of or otherwise enforce a lien over an Ordinary Share held in uncertificated form without an instrument of transfer, the Company shall be entitled, subject to any applicable law, the Articles, any applicable regulations and the facilities and requirements of the Depositary: (a) to require the holder of that uncertificated Ordinary Share by notice to change that Ordinary Share into certificated form within the period specified in the notice and to hold that Ordinary Share in certificated form so long as required by the Company; (b) to require the holder of that uncertificated Ordinary Share by notice to give any instructions necessary to transfer title to that Ordinary Share by means of the Depositary within the period specified in the notice; (c) to require the holder of that uncertificated Ordinary Share by notice to appoint any person to take any step, including, without limitation, the giving of any instructions by means of the Depositary, necessary to transfer that Ordinary Share within the period specified in the notice; and (d) to take any action that the Board considers appropriate to achieve the sale, transfer, disposal of, forfeiture or surrender of that Ordinary Share or otherwise to enforce a lien in respect of it. The Directors shall, subject always to any applicable law and the facilities and requirements of any Depositary concerned and the Articles, have power to implement and/or approve any arrangements they may, in their absolute discretion, think fit in relation to the evidencing of title to and transfer of interests in Ordinary Shares in the capital of the Company in the form of depositary interests or similar interests, instruments or securities, and to the extent such arrangements are so implemented, no provision of the Articles shall apply or have effect to the extent that it is in any respect inconsistent with the holding or transfer thereof or the Ordinary Shares in the capital of the Company represented thereby. The Directors may from time to time take such actions and do such things as they may, in their absolute discretion, think fit in relation to the operation of any such arrangements. 11.9 Takeovers Compulsory Sale If a person (the “Offeror”) makes an offer, being an offer on terms which are the same in relation to all the Ordinary Shares to which the offer relates and, as a result of making that offer, the Offeror has by virtue of acceptances of the offer acquired or contracted to acquire not less than nine‐tenths in value of the Ordinary Shares to which the offer relates, the Offeror may by written notice to the Company require the Company as agent for the Offeror to serve notices (each a “Compulsory Purchase Notice”) on the holders of Ordinary Shares to which the offer relates who have not accepted such offer (the “Minority Shareholders”) requiring them to sell such Ordinary Shares at the same price per share offered to any person identified by the Offeror. The Company shall serve the Compulsory Purchase Notices forthwith and for 28 days from the service of the Compulsory Purchase Notice the Minority Shareholders shall not be entitled to transfer their Ordinary Shares to anyone except the Offeror (or any other person identified by the Offeror). The Offeror shall complete the purchase of all Ordinary Shares in respect of which a Compulsory Purchase Notice has been given at the same time and in any event no later than 21 days from the date of the serving of such Compulsory Purchase Notice. The consideration shall be payable in cash by cheque in full without any set off. The Directors shall not register any transfer to the Offeror and the Offeror shall not be entitled to exercise or direct the service of any rights in respect of any Ordinary Shares to be transferred to the Offeror until in each case the Offeror has fulfilled all his payment obligations. If in any case a Minority Shareholder, on the expiration of 28 days from the service of the Compulsory Purchase Notice, shall not have transferred his Ordinary Shares to the person identified by the Offeror, the Directors may authorise another person to execute and deliver on his behalf any necessary transfer in favour of the Offeror or the person identified by the Offeror and provided the Company has received the purchase money in respect of such Ordinary Shares, the Directors 147 Page shall thereupon (subject to the transfer being duly stamped) cause the name of the Offeror (or the person identified by the Offeror) to be entered into the register of Shareholders as the holder of the relevant Ordinary Shares. The Company shall hold the purchase money in trust for the Minority Shareholder but shall not be bound to earn or pay interest thereon. The receipt by the Company of the purchase money shall be a good receipt for the price for the relevant Ordinary Shares but the Offeror shall not be discharged from procuring that the Company applies the money in payment to the Minority Shareholder which shall be made against delivery by the Minority Shareholder of the certificate in respect of the relevant shares or an indemnity in respect of the same. After the name of the Offeror (or the person identified by the Offeror) has been entered in the register of Shareholders in purported exercise of any aforesaid powers the validity of the proceedings shall not be questioned by any person. Compulsory purchase If an Offeror makes an offer, being an offer on terms which are the same in relation to all the Ordinary Shares to which the offer relates and, as a result of making that offer, the Offeror has by virtue of acceptances of the offer acquired or contracted to acquire not less than 90 per cent. in value of all voting Ordinary Shares in the Company and which carry not less than 90 per cent. of all voting rights in the Company, any Minority Shareholder may by written notice to the Offeror (“Compulsory Sell-out Notice”) require him to acquire the Ordinary Shares held by such Minority Shareholder at the same price per Ordinary Share offered to any person identified by the Offeror. A Compulsory Sell‐out Notice may not be delivered by a Minority Shareholder after the end of the period which is three months from the end of the period within which the offer can be accepted. The Offeror shall complete the purchase of all Ordinary Shares in respect of which a Compulsory Sell‐out Notice has been given at the same time and in any event no later than 21 days from the date of the service of such Compulsory Sell‐out Notice. The consideration shall be payable in cash or by cheque in full without any set off. The Directors shall not register any transfer to the Offeror and the Offeror shall not be entitled to exercise or direct the service of any rights in respect of any Ordinary Shares to be transferred to the Offeror until in each case the Offeror has fulfilled all such payment obligations. After the name of the Offeror (or the person identified by the Offeror) has been entered in the register of Shareholders in purported exercise of any aforesaid powers the validity of the proceedings shall not be questioned by any person. 11.10 Disclosure of voting rights in Ordinary Shares To enable the Company to comply with its disclosure obligations under Rule 17 of the AIM Rules for Companies, the provisions of rule 5 of the Disclosure Rules and Transparency Rules (“DTR 5”) relating to the requirement of a company’s shareholders to disclose their total proportion of voting rights (as defined in DTR 5) are incorporated into the Articles. Notwithstanding the time limits for disclosure set out in DTR 5, the Company is required by Rule 17 of the AIM Rules to announce without delay the information contained in any notification made by a person pursuant to the Articles which reflect rules set out in DTR 5. Under DTR 5 a person must notify a company to which DTR 5 applies of the percentage of its voting rights he holds as a shareholder or through his direct or indirect holding of certain financial instruments (or a combination of such holders) if the percentage of those voting rights reaches, exceeds or falls below three per cent. and each one per cent. thereafter up to 100 per cent. as a result of an acquisition or disposal of shares or such financial instruments. The Directors shall keep a register recording the information contemplated above provided by Shareholders (the “Register of Substantial Interests”) and shall procure that, whenever the Company receives information from a person in consequence of the fulfilment of a disclosure obligation imposed on him by the Articles, that information is within three business days thereafter written up in the Register of Substantial Interests against that person’s name, together with the date of the inscription. The Register of Substantial Interests shall be kept at the registered office of the Company or at any other place determined by the Directors. 11.11 Directors The Board must consist of at least three Directors but no more than 11 Directors. Directors need not be Shareholders. The Directors are appointed for a duration determined by the Shareholders’ meeting which may not exceed three years and in case no duration is specified by the Shareholders’ meeting the relevant Director(s) shall be deemed appointed for 148 Page one year. Directors may be removed at any time, with or without cause, by a resolution of the Shareholders (and may be appointed by a resolution of Shareholders). In the event of a vacancy arising for a member of the Board previously appointed by the Shareholders, because of death, retirement or otherwise, the remaining Directors may elect, by majority vote, a person who is willing to act as a Director to fill such vacancy until the next Shareholders’ meeting which will be asked to ratify such election. Unless otherwise decided by the Shareholders by ordinary resolution, the Company may pay to the Directors for their services as Directors such amount of aggregate fees as the Board decides. Such fee is distinct from any salary, remuneration or other amount payable to him pursuant to other provisions of the Articles or of a service agreement in relation to any of the executive directors or otherwise and accrues from day to day. A Director is entitled to be reimbursed all reasonable travelling, hotel and other expenses properly incurred by him in the performance of his duties as Director. The quorum necessary for deliberating or acting validly is half of the Directors present in person or represented by proxy. All questions and decisions arising at a meeting of the Board are determined by a majority of votes cast. The Board shall elect a chairman from among its members from time to time. In case of an equality of votes the chairman has a second or casting vote. Any Director having an interest in a transaction submitted for approval to the Board conflicting with that of the Company, shall advise the Board thereof and cause a record of his statement to be included in the minutes of the meeting. He may not take part in these deliberations. At the next following Shareholders’ meeting, before any other resolution is put to vote, a special report shall be made on any transactions in which any of the Directors may have had an interest conflicting with that of the Company. The Board may establish various committees which may include non Board members and shall establish all such committees as may be required by applicable law or the AIM Rules for Companies. The Board may delegate certain of its powers, authorities and discretions (with power to sub‐delegate) to such committee as it thinks fit. 11.12 Auditors The Company shall have one or more statutory auditors appointed by vote of the Shareholders’ meeting for a maximum duration of six years (in case the statutory auditors are elected without mention of the term of their mandate, they are deemed to be elected for six years from the date of their election) except where Luxembourg law requires that the Company appoints one or more independent auditors (réviseur(s) d’entreprises agréé(s)). The independent auditor(s) is/are appointed for a determined period amongst the members of the Institut des Réviseurs d’Entreprises. 11.13 Shareholders and general meetings The Shareholders shall be liable for the total amount of their Ordinary Shares. Subject to the provisions concerning the reduction of the subscribed capital, Shareholders may not be released from their obligation to pay‐up their contribution. Every transferor shall have a right of recourse jointly and severally against his immediate transferees and the subsequent transferees. The general meeting of Shareholders shall represent the entire body of Shareholders of the Company. It shall have the broadest powers to order, carry out or ratify acts relating to the operations of the Company. The Board as well as the statutory auditors may convene a Shareholders’ meeting. The Board shall be obliged to convene it so that it is held within a period of one month if Shareholders representing at least ten per cent. of the Company’s share capital require so in writing with an indication of the agenda. Convening notices for every Shareholders’ meeting (a “Convening Notice”) shall contain the agenda and shall take the form of announcements published twice, with a minimum interval of eight days, and eight days before the meeting, in the Mémorial and in a Luxembourg newspaper. Convening Notices for Shareholders’ meetings will also be published in accordance with all applicable laws and in particular the on‐going disclosure and stock exchange requirements to which 149 Page the Company is subject (including the AIM Rules for Companies). The Convening Notice will also be sent to each Shareholder and published on the Company’s website (together with certain other relevant information). Shareholders representing at least ten per cent. of the Company’s share capital may: (i) request the addition of one or several items to the agenda of any Shareholders’ meeting; and (ii) table draft resolutions for items included or to be included on the agenda of a Shareholders’ meeting. Such requests must be received by the Company at least five days before the date of the relevant Shareholders’ meeting. Unless otherwise provided for by law, all decisions by the annual or an extraordinary Shareholders’ meeting shall be taken by simple majority of the votes cast, regardless of the proportion of the capital represented by Shareholders attending the meeting. An extraordinary Shareholders’ meeting convened to amend any provisions of the Articles or any other matter expressly provided for in the Articles, including, without limitation thereto, to alter the share capital of the Company, shall not validly deliberate unless at least one half of the capital is represented and the agenda indicates the proposed amendments to the Articles. If the first of these conditions is not satisfied, a second meeting may be convened, in the manner prescribed by the Articles, by means of notices published twice, at 15 days interval at least and 15 days before the meeting in the Mémorial and in two Luxembourg newspapers. Such Convening Notice shall reproduce the agenda and indicate the date and the results of the previous meeting. The second meeting shall validly deliberate regardless of the proportion of the capital represented. At both meetings, resolutions, in order to be adopted, must be carried by at least two‐thirds of the votes cast. Where there is more than one class of Ordinary Shares and the resolution of the Shareholders’ meeting is such as to change the respective rights thereof, the resolution must, in order to be valid, fulfil the conditions as to attendance and majority laid down in the Articles with respect to each class. Each holder of Ordinary Shares shall have one vote in respect of each Ordinary Share held by him. The right of a Shareholder to participate in a Shareholders’ meeting and exercise voting rights attached to its Ordinary Shares is determined by reference to the number of Ordinary Shares held by such Shareholder at midnight (00.00) on the day falling three days before the date of the Shareholders’ meeting (the “Record Date”). Each Shareholder shall, on or before the Record Date, indicate to the Company its intention to participate at the Shareholders’ meeting. Each Shareholder may vote through voting forms sent by post (or by facsimile or email or any other form approved by the Board) to the Company’s registered office or to the address specified in the Convening Notice. A Shareholder may be represented at any Shareholders’ meeting by proxy (who need not be a Shareholder). The annual general meeting of Shareholders shall be held in Luxembourg at the registered office of the Company, or at such other place in Luxembourg as may be specified in the notice of meeting on the last Friday of May at 11.00 a.m. If such day is a legal holiday in Luxembourg, the annual general meeting shall be held on the next following business day. The annual general meeting may be held outside Luxembourg if, in the absolute and final judgement of the Board, exceptional circumstances so require. 11.14 Distributions Each year at least five per cent. of the net profits must be allocated to the legal reserve account. This allocation is no longer mandatory if and as long as such legal reserve amounts to at least one tenth of the capital of the Company. After allocation to the legal reserve, the Shareholders’ meeting determines the appropriation and distribution of the available distributable funds. The Board is authorised and may resolve to declare and pay interim dividends in accordance with the following provisions: (a) interim accounts shall be drawn‐up showing that the funds available for distribution are sufficient; (b) the amount to be distributed may not exceed total profits made since the end of the last financial year for which the annual accounts have been approved (where applicable), plus any profits carried forward and sums drawn 150 Page from reserves available for this purpose, less losses carried forward and any sums to be placed to reserve pursuant to the requirements of the law or of the Articles; (c) the decision of the Board to distribute an interim dividend may not be taken more than two months after the date at which the interim accounts referred to under paragraph (a) above have been made up; and (d) in their report to the Board, the statutory auditors or the réviseur(s) d’entreprises agréé(s) shall verify whether the above conditions have been satisfied. Where the payments on account of interim dividends exceed the amount of the dividend subsequently decided upon by the Shareholders’ meeting, they shall, to the extent of the overpayment, be deemed to have been paid on account of the next dividend. Except for cases of reductions of subscribed capital, no distributions to Shareholders may be made when on the closing date of the last accounting year the net assets as set out in the annual accounts are, or following such a distribution would become, lower than the amount of the subscribed capital plus the reserves which may not be distributed under Luxembourg law or by virtue of the Articles. The amount of a distribution to Shareholders may not exceed the amount of the profits at the end of the last accounting year plus any profits carried forward and any amounts drawn from reserves which are available for that purpose, less any losses carried forward and sums to be placed to reserve in accordance with the law or the Articles. The term “distribution” includes in particular the payment of dividends and of interest relating to Ordinary Shares. Any distribution made in infringement of this provision must be returned by the Shareholders who have received it if the Company can prove that the Shareholders knew of the irregularity of the distributions made in their favour or could not, in the circumstances, have been unaware of it. 11.15 Notice and communications Any notice, document or information to be sent or supplied by the Company may be sent or supplied in hard copy form, in writing, by fax, in electronic form or by means of publication on the Company’s website, except where otherwise provided for or required by the Articles or any other applicable law. 11.16 Dissolution The Company may be dissolved by a decision of the Shareholders’ meeting voting with the same quorum as for the amendment of the Articles. Should the Company be dissolved, the liquidation will be carried out by one or more liquidators appointed by the Shareholders’ meeting. On a voluntary winding up of the Company the liquidator may divide among the Shareholders in kind the whole or any part of the assets of the Company, whether or not the assets consist of property of one kind or of different kinds. For this purpose the liquidator may set the value he deems fair on a class or classes of property, and may determine on the basis of that valuation and in accordance with the then existing rights of Shareholders how the division is to be carried out between Shareholders or classes of Shareholders. The liquidator may not, however, distribute to a Shareholder without his consent an asset to which there is attached a liability or potential liability for the owner. Application for dissolution of the Company for just cause may, however, be made to the court. Except in the case of dissolution by court order, dissolution of the Company may take place only pursuant to a resolution adopted by the Shareholders’ meeting by Special Majority. To the fullest extent permitted by law every person who is or was a Director or other officer of the Company (other than any person (whether or not an officer of the Company) engaged by the Company as auditor) shall be and shall be kept indemnified out of the assets of the Company against all costs, charges, losses and liabilities incurred by him in relation to the Company or its affairs provided that such indemnity shall not apply in respect of any liability incurred by him/her: (a) to the Company or to any associated company; (b) to pay a fine imposed in criminal proceedings; 151 Page (c) to pay a sum payable to a regulatory authority by way of a penalty in respect of non compliance with any requirement of a regulatory nature (howsoever arising); (d) in defending any criminal proceedings in which he is convicted; (e) in case of fraud, gross negligence or wilful misconduct; (f) in defending any civil proceedings brought by the Company, or an associated company; or (g) refusal by a court to grant him relief. To the extent permitted by law, the Board may purchase and maintain insurance for the benefit of a person who is or was a Director or other officer of the Company indemnifying them and keeping them indemnified against liability which may lawfully be insured against by the Company. 11.17 Summary The above is a summary of certain provisions of the Articles, the full provisions of which are available on the Company’s website, www.rm2.com. 12. Material contracts The following contracts, not being contracts entered into in the ordinary course of business, have been entered into by the Group and are, or may be, material: Financing agreements (a) JKD Capital agreements (i) Letter agreement regarding a bridge facility On 4 June 2013, the Company entered into a letter agreement (the “JKD Bridge Facility Letter Agreement”), as amended on 29 October 2013, regarding a bridge facility in which JKD Capital Partners I Limited (“JKD”) agreed to provide a committed bridge facility (the “JKD Bridge Facility”) of up to US$10,000,000. The Company has made two drawdowns under the JKD Bridge Facility. Each drawdown was conditional, amongst other things, on JKD being provided with certain security (the “Security”), including the Pledge Agreement described below. Following the amendment of the JKD Bridge Facility Letter Agreement on 29 October 2013, this Security was released in full. The obligations on the Company to repay amounts drawn down under the JKD Bridge Facility are set out in the JKD Promissory Notes (described below). Upon repayment of the JKD Promissory Notes, JKD is entitled to receive an additional fee of US$2,500,000. As described elsewhere in this document, it is intended that all amounts owing to JKD will be fully repaid and discharged using the proceeds of Admission. If the Company does not complete an IPO by 7 January 2014, the Company has agreed to grant a pledge over the shares in each of its material Subsidiaries and any intercompany debt obligations pari passu in favour of JKD and the Company’s other lenders. The Company has given customary warranties in the JKD Bridge Facility Letter Agreement as to power and capacity, enforceable obligations, non‐breach of any other agreements to which it is bound and that the obligations it owes to JKD rank pari passu to all other debt obligations of the Company. In addition, the Company has given a warranty that, at the date the Security was released, no creditors of the Company held security in respect of the Company and that the Company had outstanding indebtedness for borrowed money of no more than US$27,500,000. The Company has given an undertaking not to incur any further indebtedness for borrowed money prior to the repayment of the JKD Promissory Notes. 152 Page Mead Park Advisors LLC received a fee of US$500,000 from the Company upon initial drawdown under the JKD Bridge Facility. (ii) Promissory notes issued to JKD Pursuant to the JKD Bridge Facility, on 4 June 2013 and 31 July 2013, the Company executed promissory notes of US$5,000,000 each in favour of JKD (the “JKD Promissory Notes”) representing two draw downs under the JKD Bridge Facility. All amounts owing pursuant to the JKD Promissory Notes must be repaid by 3 June 2014 (the “Maturity Date”). Voluntary prepayments may be made at any time. The entire amount outstanding under the JKD Promissory Notes must be repaid within three business days of Admission. Interest on all unpaid principal under the JKD Promissory Notes is payable at a rate of ten per cent. per annum (or at a 12 per cent. per annum rate if the Company is in default of its payment obligations). Interest may (other than when due at the Maturity Date or pursuant to an acceleration), at the Company’s election, be added to the principal amount due. The Company has, in the JKD Promissory Notes, given customary warranties as to, among other things, corporate standing, power and capacity, enforceable obligations and non‐breach of any other agreements to which it is bound. The Company has also given covenants including to preserve and maintain its legal existence (and that of its subsidiaries) and all of its material rights, privileges, licences and franchises. A breach of warranty or covenant, or a failure to pay any principal sum outstanding which is not paid within three business days of the due date, constitute an event of default (an “Event of Default”), triggering an immediate right for JKD to accelerate all sums due under the JKD Promissory Note. As described elsewhere in this document, it is intended that the JKD Promissory Notes be fully repaid and discharged using the proceeds of Admission. (iii) Pledge Agreement On 4 June 2013, John Walsh and the Company executed a pledge agreement (the “Pledge Agreement”) in favour of JKD in respect of all John Walsh’s beneficially owned shares in the Company (the “JW Shares”) and all John Walsh’s rights and claims towards the Company (including dividends and any other benefits deriving from John Walsh’s ownership of the JW Shares). The Pledge Agreement was terminated and released by virtue of the amendment to the JKD Bridge Facility Letter Agreement on 29 October 2013. This is a related party agreement for the purposes of the AIM Rules for Companies. (b) Domestic Private Equity Investors, LLC (“DPE”) agreements (i) DPE Warrant Agreement On 30 June 2010, the Company entered into an agreement (the “DPE Warrant Agreement”) with DPE by which the Company granted warrants to DPE (the “DPE Warrants”) equivalent to ten per cent. of the Company’s fully diluted share capital on a post exercise basis. The DPE Warrant Agreement was amended on 19 August 2011, on 22 May 2013 and on 8 November 2013. The description below refers to the DPE Warrant Agreement as it is amended. The DPE Warrants are exercisable after 31 March 2014, subject to certain customary acceleration rights, for example on a material disposal or a merger by the Company, and early termination provisions where either the Company or DPE can, in certain circumstances, require part of the DPE Warrants to be bought out. However, the Company does not intend to exercise its early termination rights as, in the event the Company completes an IPO prior to 31 March 2014, simultaneously on completion of such IPO the rights of DPE to receive 153 Page shares in respect of the DPE Warrants shall immediately terminate and be replaced with an obligation by the Company: (i) to pay DPE an aggregate amount equal to US$40,000,000 plus the nominal value of the DPE Shares; and (ii) upon payment of the nominal value of the DPE Shares by DPE to the Company, to issue the DPE Shares to DPE. Upon such payment and issuance, the DPE Warrant Agreement shall be terminated in its entirety. The DPE Letter Agreement (described below) which contains certain restrictions on the Company in favour of DPE, shall be terminated upon Admission. (ii) Letter agreement dated 17 June 2010 The Company, John Walsh and Jane Walsh entered into a letter agreement (the “DPE Letter Agreement”) with DPE on 17 June 2010. The DPE Letter Agreement provides that for so long as DPE and its affiliates hold 5 per cent. of the ‘equity interests’ of the Company, (it being expressly stated that ‘equity interests’ includes the holding of warrants), the Company will not take (and John Walsh and Jane Walsh shall procure that the Company does not take) decisions in respect of certain prescribed matters without DPE’s prior written consent. The list of prescribed matters (each a “Prescribed Matter”) includes: (aa) a merger or consolidation of the Company; the sale, transfer or leasing of any of the Group’s material assets; or the dissolution or liquidation of any material company in the Group (except that any merger or sale, transfer or lease of assets within the Group shall not constitute a Prescribed Matter); (bb) an acquisition by the Company or any member of the Group that owns assets of a book value of US$500,000 or more (a “Material Subsidiary”), of any business or property or capital stock of a value of more than US$25,000,000; (cc) causing any share split or share divide of the Ordinary Shares; (dd) issuing new shares of the Company except to employees or management pursuant to stock option plans; and (ee) amending the Articles in such a way as the changes are adverse to DPE. The Company, John Walsh and Jane Walsh have given other customary representations and warranties in the DPE Letter Agreement including as to power and capacity, due execution and non‐breach of any other agreement to which John Walsh, Jane Walsh and the Company is party. Neither the Company, John Walsh nor Jane Walsh may assign their rights under the DPE Letter Agreement. DPE may assign its rights with the prior written consent of the Company (not to be unreasonably withheld). Where DPE’s prior written consent is required to permit Admission, such consent has been provided by DPE in the amendment to the DPE Warrant Agreement dated 8 November 2013. The DPE Letter Agreement is being terminated with effect from Admission. (c) CarVal interim financing arrangements On 7 November 2013, the Company entered into a letter agreement (the “CarVal Letter Agreement”) with CVI CVF II Lux Securities Trading S.a.r.l. (“CarVal”), pursuant to which CarVal agreed to lend the Company US$10,000,000 (the “CarVal Loan”). On 8 November 2013, CarVal advanced the CarVal Loan to the Company. The Company gave certain customary representations and warranties including as to power and capacity, enforceable obligations, and non‐breach of any other agreements to which it is bound. The representations and warranties are given at the time of initial draw down and on each date when interest is due under the CarVal Loan (as described in the CarVal Promissory Note below). On 7 November 2013, the Company issued a promissory note (the “CarVal Promissory Note”) to CarVal in respect of the full amount of the CarVal Loan (the “CarVal Principal”). The Company must repay the full amount of the CarVal Principal on the earlier of: completion of an IPO (which includes Admission); or 7 November 2014 (the “CarVal Maturity Date”). On the CarVal Maturity Date, the Company must repay the Carval Principal together with an additional payment (the “CarVal Additional Payment”) equal to 25 per cent. of the issue of the 154 Page CarVal Principal (or, if full repayment of the CarVal Principal occurs more than nine months after the date of the CarVal Promissory Note an amount equal to 30 per cent. of the CarVal Principal). Interest is also payable each month on the CarVal Principal at a rate of ten per cent. per annum (or a higher default rate of interest if the Company is in default under the CarVal Promissory Note). If the Company repays part of any other non‐ordinary course indebtedness (subject to certain exceptions) owed to other lenders and entered into before the CarVal Promissory Note (“Interim Debt”), the Company is obliged to repay CarVal an equivalent proportion of the CarVal Principal at the same time. The Company gave certain undertakings to CarVal for the duration of the CarVal Promissory Note including (each subject to specified exceptions) that it will not enter into any merger, acquisition, sale or establish any joint venture, that no Group Company shall grant any security over its assets, that no Group Company shall incur non‐ ordinary course indebtedness, that no Group Company shall issue any shares (other than pursuant to Admission) and that no Group Company shall pay a dividend. The CarVal Promissory Note provides that if Admission does not occur by 7 January 2014, the Company shall execute security over the shares in each of the Subsidiaries, over all of the Group’s material assets and properties and an assignment of receivables, claims and any intra group debt in favour of both CarVal and the providers of the Interim Debt. The CarVal Promissory Note stipulates certain events of default (each a “CarVal Default”) including non‐payment of the CarVal Principal, or cross default under any non‐ordinary course indebtedness and a reduction in the percentage of shares or ownership the Company directly or indirectly holds in RM2 Canada, Equipment Tracking and RM2 Swiss Branch. Upon the occurrence of a CarVal Default (which is not remedied within a specified grace period), CarVal may demand immediate repayment of the CarVal Principal (together with interest) and the CarVal Additional Payment. (d) Subscription Agreement by Invesco (“Invesco Subscription Agreement”) On 22 October 2013, Invesco Asset Management Limited (“IAML”) (acting as agent for and on behalf of certain of its funds) agreed to subscribe for an additional 22,275,000 Ordinary Shares (the “New Invesco Shares”). IAML paid a subscription price of US$222,750 in consideration for issue of the New Invesco Shares. Pursuant to the Invesco Subscription Agreement, the Company gave a number of customary representations and warranties including, amongst others, in respect of the Company’s power and capacity, its issued and authorised share capital, outstanding options and warrants and its outstanding debt obligations. In addition, the Company warranted that it was not in breach of any of the material contracts to which the Company had been a party in the two years prior to the Invesco Subscription Agreement. (e) Interim financing agreements (together, the “Interim Finance Agreements”) (i) Floravell Loan On 14 August 2013 the Company entered into an unsecured loan agreement with Floravell (the “Floravell Loan”). The Floravell Loan was repaid in its entirety on 26 September 2013. Floravell is an entity controlled by the family of John Walsh. The Floravell Loan formalised loans made to the Company with a value of US$2,778,082.52 (the “Floravell Principal”). Under the terms of the Floravell Loan interest of two per cent. per annum was payable by the Company on the Floravell Principal from 1 January 2013 (with interest and the Florvell Principal to be repaid by 31 January 2014). This is a related party agreement for the purposes of the AIM Rules for Companies. (ii) Christopher Carter Interim Facility and promissory note On 18 September 2013, the Company entered into an interim facility letter with Christopher Carter (“CC”) under the terms of which CC agreed to loan to the Company the sum of US$1,000,000 (the “CC Principal”), with such loan being evidenced by a promissory note (the “CC Note”). 155 Page The CC Note states that the CC Principal and any accrued interest is repayable within three business days of the earlier of (i) Admission and (ii) 19 September 2014. In addition, on repayment of the CC Principal, the Company must either, at its election: (i) issue to CC Ordinary Shares of a market value equivalent to 25 per cent. of the initial CC Principal or (ii) pay to CC an amount equal to 25 per cent. of the CC Principal. If the repayment of the CC Principal occurs on or after 20 June 2014 this additional payment shall be increased to 30 per cent. of the CC Principal. The rate of interest on all outstanding CC Principal is ten per cent. per annum with any amount not paid on the date it is due accruing default interest at 12 per cent. per annum. The Company may discharge its obligation to pay interest by adding such sums to the outstanding CC Principal. (iii) Robert Fahrbach Jr. Interim Facility and promissory note On 18 September 2013, the Company entered into an interim facility letter with Robert Fahrbach Jr. (“RF”) under the terms of which RF agreed to lend the Company the sum of US$1,000,000 (the “RF Principal”), with such loan being evidenced by a promissory note (the “RF Note”). The RF Note states that the RF Principal and any accrued interest is repayable within three business days of the earlier of (i) Admission and (ii) 19 September 2014. In addition, on repayment of the RF Principal, the Company must either, at its election: (i) issue to RF Ordinary Shares of a value equivalent to 25 per cent. of the initial RF Principal or (ii) pay an amount equal to 25 per cent. of the initial RF Principal. If the repayment of the RF Principal occurs on or after 20 June 2014 this additional payment shall be increased by five per cent. The rate of interest on all outstanding RF Principal is ten per cent. per annum with any amount not paid on the date it is due accruing default interest at 12 per cent. per annum. The Company may discharge its obligation to pay interest by adding such sums to the outstanding RF Principal. (iv) Simon Meadows Interim Facility and promissory note On 13 September 2013, the Company entered into an interim facility letter with Simon Meadows (“SM”) under the terms of which SM agreed to lend the Company US$1,000,000 (the “SM Principal”), with such loan being evidenced by a promissory note (the “SM Note”). The SM Note states that the SM Principal and any accrued interest is repayable within three business days of the earlier of (i) Admission and (ii) 17 September 2014. In addition, on repayment of the SM Principal, RM2 must either, at its election: (i) issue to SM Ordinary Shares of a value equivalent to 25 per cent. of the initial SM Principal or (ii) pay an amount equivalent to 25 per cent. of the initial SM Principal. If the repayment of the SM Principal occurs on or after 18 June 2014 this additional payment shall be increased by five per cent. The rate of interest on all outstanding SM Principal is ten per cent. per annum with any amount not paid on the date it is due accruing default interest at 12 per cent. per annum. The Company may discharge its obligation to pay interest by adding such sums to the outstanding SM Principal. (v) Jennifer Powers Interim Facility and promissory note On 18 September 2013, the Company entered into an interim facility letter with Jennifer Powers (“JP”) under the terms of which JP agreed to lend the Company the sum of US$400,000 (the “JP Principal”), with such loan being evidenced by a promissory note (the “JP Note”). The JP Note states that the JP Principal and any accrued interest is repayable within three business days of the earlier of (i) Admission and (ii) 19 September 2014. In addition, on repayment of the JP Principal, RM2 must either, at its election: (i) issue to JP Ordinary Shares of a value equivalent to 25 per cent. of the initial JP Principal or (ii) pay an amount equal to 25 per cent. of the initial JP Principal. If the repayment of the JP Principal occurs on or after 20 June 2014 this additional payment shall be increased by five per cent. 156 Page The rate of interest on all outstanding JP Principal is ten per cent. per annum with any amount not paid on the date it is due accruing default interest at 12 per cent. per annum. The Company may discharge its obligation to pay interest by adding such sums to the outstanding JP Principal. (vi) Moshe Tomkiewicz Interim Facility and promissory note On 18 September 2013, the Company entered into an interim facility letter with Moshe Tomkiewicz (“MT”) under the terms of which MT agreed to lend the Company the sum of US$300,000 (the “MT Principal”), with such loan being evidenced by a promissory note (the “MT Note”). The MT Note states that the MT Principal and any accrued interest is repayable within three business days of the earlier of (i) Admission and (ii) 19 September 2014. In addition, on repayment of the MT Principal, RM2 must either, at its election: (i) issue to MT the Ordinary Shares of a value equivalent to 25 per cent. of the initial MT Principal or (ii) pay an amount equal to 25 per cent. of the initial MT Principal. If the repayment of the MT Principal occurs on or after 20 June 2014 this additional payment shall be increased by five per cent. The rate of interest on all outstanding MT Principal is ten per cent. per annum with any amount not paid on the date it is due accruing default interest at 12 per cent. per annum. The Company may discharge its obligation to pay interest by adding such sums to the outstanding MT Principal. (vii) Donald Devine Interim Facility and promissory note On 18 September 2013, the Company entered into an interim facility letter with Donald Devine (“DD”) under the terms of which DD agreed to lend the Company the sum of US$1,000,000 (the “DD Principal”), with such loan being evidenced by a promissory note (the “DD Note”). The DD Note states that the DD Principal and any accrued interest is repayable within three business days of the earlier of (i) Admission and (ii) 19 September 2014. In addition, on repayment of the DD Principal, RM2 must either, at its election: (i) issue to DD Ordinary Shares of a value equivalent to 25 per cent. of the initial DD Principal or (ii) pay to DD an amount equal to 25 per cent. of the initial DD Principal. If the repayment of the DD Principal occurs on or after 30 June 2014 this additional payment shall be increased by five per cent. The rate of interest on all outstanding DD Principal is ten per cent. per annum with any amount not paid on the date it is due accruing default interest at 12 per cent. per annum. The Company may discharge its obligation to pay interest by adding such sums to the outstanding DD Principal. Commercial/Group organisation agreements (f) Settlement agreement with STM Technologies, Inc. On 27 September 2013 the Company and various Group companies (as detailed below) entered into a settlement agreement with STM Technologies, Inc., STM Pallet Company Inc., Inline Fiberglass Ltd and Stanley Rokicki (the “STM Settlement”) which provides for: (i) the termination of a contract between STM Pallet Company, Inc. and RM2 S.A. under which STM Pallet Company, Inc. agreed to manufacture and sell pallets to RM2 S.A.; (ii) the amendment of an intellectual property transfer agreement between STM Pallet Company, Inc. and RM2 S.A., namely the deletion of a provision under which RM2 S.A. was obliged to pay STM Pallet Company, Inc. royalties in relation to pultruded fabricated pallets produced and technology included in pultruded fabricated pallets; (iii) an agreement that the Company acquire the shares of RM2 Poland owned by Bazalt Kleszczow Ltd (“BKL”), a company controlled by Stanley Rokciki before 30 September 2013. The Company had loaned BKL the initial subscription fee for the shares in RM2 Poland when BKL originally subscribed for such shares. The consideration for the acquisition will be the cancellation of this loaned amount. This acquisition has now been completed; 157 Page (iv) the parties to enter into a commission sales agreement under which the Company agrees to pay STM Technologies, Inc. or Stanley Rokicki royalties on all pallets sold or rented by RM2 S.A. to customers introduced to RM2 S.A. by STM Technologies, Inc. or Stanley Rokicki; and (v) the parties to release one another from all known and unknown claims under all historic contracts or agreements between them. As consideration for the provisions detailed at (i) to (v) above RM2 S.A. agreed to pay US$2,000,000 to STM Technologies, Inc. The STM Settlement also references the terms of further ordinary course commercial undertakings agreed between the parties on or around the date of the STM Settlement. (g) Settlement agreement with Plastic Resources Corporation RM2 S.A. and RM2 USA entered into a Settlement and Release Agreement (the “PRC Settlement”) dated 15 November 2012 with Plastics Research Corporation (“PRC”), Gene Gregory, Michael Maedel, (together with PRC, the “PRC Parties”) John Walsh, Jane Walsh, Rick Needham and DBA Needham Consulting (together with RM2 S.A. and RM2 USA the “RM2 Parties”). Under the terms of the PRC Settlement, the PRC Parties and RM2 Parties release each other from all claims, known and unknown, which relate to an Exclusive Manufacturing and Supply Agreement entered into between RM2 S.A. and PRC (the “EMSA”), a non‐disclosure agreement between the parties and various related claims and arbitrations. Furthermore PRC agreed to pay RM2 S.A. a total of US$13,500,000 (the “PRC Settlement Amount”) plus interest in instalments over a seven year period as settlement of claims brought under the EMSA. The outstanding amount of this payment is subject to interest payable at a rate of seven per cent. per annum. This payment obligation is secured by a first priority lien in favour of RM2 S.A. on all pallet‐making machinery and equipment owned by PRC and an obligation on PRC to assign the lease of a facility in Redlands, California (the “Redlands Facility”) to RM2 S.A. (the “PRC Security”). RM2 S.A. and PRC entered into a promissory note restating these payment provisions, and a security agreement under which PRC grants the PRC Security to RM2 S.A. Should PRC begin commercial production of pallets using the design in production at the Redlands Facility at the date of the PRC Settlement, PRC would be obliged to pay royalties to RM2 S.A. Such royalties are payable on sales of such pallets made between 15 November 2013 and 14 November 2019, up to a maximum aggregate of royalty payments of US$11,000,000. The RM2 Parties all agree that for a period of two years from the date of this agreement none of them shall develop, manufacture or sell pallets incorporating ‘Low Pressure Molding Compound’ or ‘thermoset Sheet Molding Compound’ technology. On 13 December 2013, the Company received a letter from PRC stating that PRC would be defaulting on its payment obligations in respect of the PRC Settlement Amount. RM2 had previously considered that there were significant uncertainties in relation to the payment of the PRC Settlement Amount and had therefore decided to record full impairment of the PRC Settlement Amount as detailed in notes 4 and 9 of the historical consolidated financial information set out in Section B of Part V. RM2 will now take steps to enforce the PRC Security. (h) Sale and Purchase Agreement relating to Equipment Tracking On 27 September 2013, the Company entered into an agreement (“ET SPA”) with Ewa Groszek, Yvette Walsh, James Ryan, and Philip Rowland (“Sellers”) to acquire from the Sellers the entire issued share capital of Equipment Tracking which the Company did not already hold (“Sale Shares”). Completion of the ET SPA (“ET SPA Completion”) occurred on 10 December 2013. The Company paid £2,000,000 total consideration for the Sale Shares, paid to each of the Sellers pro rata to their ownership. Of this sum, £125,000 had already been paid to the Sellers as a non‐refundable deposit. The Sellers provide customary representations and warranties on, amongst other things, the organisation and standing of Equipment Tracking, and title to shares. In addition, the representations and warranties provide detail on the nature, scope, ownership and validity of the intellectual property and software owned by 158 Page Equipment Tracking. The Sellers have also entered into non‐compete covenants and non‐solicitation covenants for a two year period following ET SPA Completion. Agreements relating to the Admission (i) Placing Agreement The Company, the Directors and Cenkos entered into the Placing Agreement on 17 December 2013. Pursuant to the Placing Agreement, the Company appointed Cenkos as its agent for the purpose of carrying out the Placing and Cenkos agreed to use its reasonable endeavours to procure subscribers for the Placing Shares at the Placing Price. The obligations of Cenkos and completion of the Placing are subject to the Placing Agreement becoming unconditional and not being terminated in accordance with its terms. Such conditions include, inter alia, Admission occurring by not later than 8.00 a.m. on 6 January 2014 or such later date as Cenkos may agree with the Company (being not later than 3.00 p.m. on 20 January 2014). The fees payable to Cenkos for acting as broker and nominated adviser are provided for in the Nomad Engagement Letter and IPO Engagement Letter (each of which are described below). In addition to the fees and commissions referred to above, the Company has agreed to pay or bear all costs, charges and expenses properly and reasonably incurred and arising out of, or incidental to, the Placing, Admission and the arrangements referred to or contemplated in the Placing Agreement, including the costs and expenses of the Registrar. The Placing Agreement contains (1) certain customary warranties and undertakings given by the Company and the Directors to Cenkos as to the accuracy of the information contained in this document and other matters relating to the Group and its business; (2) certain customary indemnities from the Company in favour of Cenkos; and (3) certain undertakings from the Company to, inter-alia, consult with, or obtain the consent of, Cenkos. Cenkos may terminate the Placing Agreement in certain circumstances prior to Admission. These include, inter alia, if any statement contained in this document was untrue, incorrect or misleading in any material respect or if any of the warranties given in the Placing Agreement was not true and accurate, or if there is a material adverse change in the condition of the Group as a whole or a material adverse change in the financial markets. (j) Nominated Adviser engagement letter (“Nomad Engagement Letter”) The Company and Cenkos entered into an agreement on 11 November 2013 whereby, conditional on Admission, the Company appointed Cenkos to act as its nominated adviser and broker following Admission for an annual retainer fee of £75,000 per annum plus VAT. The appointment may be terminated by either party on at least three months’ written notice after the first anniversary of the Nomad Engagement Letter. Either party may terminate the Nomad Engagement Letter forthwith in the event of a material breach by the other party or the other party suffering an insolvency event. Cenkos may also terminate the Nomad Engagement Letter forthwith at any time in certain circumstances including where Cenkos would suffer reputational damage or default of regulatory obligations by continuing to act or where the Company fails to accept Cenkos’ advice on a material matter during the appointment. The Nomad Engagement Letter contains certain customary indemnities from the Company. In addition, the Company has granted Cenkos a right of first refusal to act as the Company’s adviser on certain other equity transactions within the first 12 months of the appointment. (k) IPO engagement letter (“IPO Engagement Letter”) The Company and Cenkos entered into an agreement on 11 November 2013 whereby the Company appointed Cenkos to act as its broker and financial adviser in relation to the Admission and the Placing. Cenkos is entitled to a success fee comprising 3.5 per cent. of all gross monies raised on Admission. The IPO Engagement Letter terminates automatically upon Admission. Either party may terminate the IPO Engagement Letter on one month’s written notice or forthwith if one party commits a material breach of its obligations. Cenkos may terminate the IPO Engagement Letter forthwith in certain circumstances including if the Company commits a material breach of the AIM Rules or if Cenkos would suffer reputational damage or default of regulatory 159 Page obligations by continuing to act. The IPO Engagement Letter contains certain customary indemnities from the Company. (l) Lock‐In Arrangements The Company, Cenkos and the Locked In Shareholders entered into the Lock‐In Arrangements on 17 December 2013 whereby the latter have agreed not to dispose of any part of their interests in Ordinary Shares held by them or their associates at Admission for a period of 12 months from Admission (the “Restricted Period”). The Locked‐ In Shareholders have further agreed they will, during the period of 12 months from the expiry of the Restricted Period, only dispose of any part of their interests in Ordinary Shares held by them or their associates at Admission through Cenkos (or through a replacement broker for the time being of the Company) in such manner so as to ensure an orderly market in the Ordinary Shares. The restrictions in the Lock‐In Arrangements are subject to certain customary limited exceptions. (m) Registrar’s Agreement A registrar’s agreement dated 26 November 2013 (the “Registrar’s Agreement”) was entered into between the Company and the Registrar, pursuant to which the Company appointed the Registrar to act as its registrar and provide the services set out in the Registrar’s Agreement. In consideration of the services to be provided, the Company has agreed to pay the Registrar a set up fee of £1,500 and a minimum annual fee of £5,500. Any additional services that the Company may require during the Registrar’s engagement are set out in the schedule of fees to the Registrar’s Agreement. Certain additional services are included in the minimum annual fee. Subject to earlier termination, the Registrar’s Agreement is for a fixed term of one year and thereafter until terminated by either party on not less than three months’ notice. Either party may terminate the Registrar’s Agreement at any time in certain other circumstances, such as one party being in persistent material breach of its obligations under the Registrar’s Agreement. The Registrar’s maximum liability under the Registrar’s Agreement in respect of any 12 month period is capped at an amount equal to two times the fees payable by the Company to the Registrar in that 12 month period. The parties are required under the Registrar’s Agreement to indemnify each other in certain circumstances. (n) Deed poll creating depositary arrangements To enable Shareholders to settle their securities in the Company through the CREST system, the Company has put in place a Depositary Interests facility operated by the Depositary. The Depositary Interests facility is created pursuant to a deed poll dated 29 November 2013 (the “Deed Poll”), under which the Depositary (or its nominee) will hold Ordinary Shares in book‐entry form on trust for Shareholders and it will issue uncertificated Depositary Interests (on a one‐for one basis) representing those underlying Ordinary Shares and provide the necessary custodian services. The relevant Shareholders will retain the beneficial interest in the Ordinary Shares held through the Depositary Interests facility and voting rights, dividends or any other rights relating to those Ordinary Shares will be passed on by the Depositary (or its nominee) in accordance with the terms of the Deed Poll. The Depositary Interests can then be traded, and settlement can be effected, within the CREST system in the same way as any other CREST security. Shareholders wishing to withdraw from the Depositary Interests facility and hold their Ordinary Shares in book‐ entry form may do so at any time using standard CREST messages. Transfers of Depositary Interests are subject to stamp duty or stamp duty reserve tax, as appropriate, in the normal way. The Deed Poll is in a standard form approved by Euroclear. There is no separate fee payable to the Depositary under the Deed Poll; however, the Company shall pay the Depositary the fees specified in the Depositary Agreement (as defined and summarised in paragraph (o) below). The Depositary is also entitled to charge the holders of Depositary Interests its reasonable and properly incurred fees and expenses as notified to them from time to time. 160 Page The Depositary may resign as depositary by giving not less than 90 days’ prior written notice to the holders but this may not take effect until the appointment of a successor Depositary takes effect. The Deed Poll may be terminated by the Depositary giving 30 days’ prior written notice. Each holder of Depositary Interests is required to indemnify the Depositary in certain circumstances (excluding default, fraud and negligence on the part of the Depositary). In order to discharge any liability of the holders of Depositary Interests to the Depositary arising under such indemnity, the Depositary may sell the Ordinary Shares it holds on trust for such holder or make deductions from any income or capital arising from such Ordinary Shares. The Depositary’s maximum liability under the Deed Poll is the value of the Ordinary Shares to which such liability relates or, if less, £5,000,000. (o) Depositary Agreement An agreement for the provision of depositary and custody services dated 29 November 2013 (the “Depositary Agreement”), was entered into between the Company and the Depositary, pursuant to which the Company appointed the Depositary to act as depositary and custodian in respect of the Depositary Interests and to provide the services set out in the Depositary Agreement. In consideration of the services to be provided, the Company has agreed to pay the Depositary an annual fee of £10,000. The Company has also agreed to pay the Depositary £9,000 in respect of the compilation of the initial Depositary Interests register and the provision of the draft documentation in respect of the Deed Poll and the Depositary Agreement. There is a fee schedule in the Depositary Agreement which stipulates the costs of any additional services that the Company may require during the Depositary’s engagement including £3.50 per deposit or cancellation, and £0.60 per transfer, of any Depositary Interests. Subject to earlier termination, the appointment of the Depositary is for a fixed term of one year and thereafter until terminated by either party giving to the other not less than three months’ notice. Either party may also terminate the Depositary Agreement at any time in certain other circumstances. The Depositary’s maximum liability under the Depositary Agreement in respect of any 12 month period is capped at an amount equal to two times the fees payable by the Company to the Depositary in that 12 month period. The parties are required under the Depositary Agreement to indemnify each other in certain circumstances. 13. Working capital The Directors are of the opinion that, having made due and careful enquiry, the working capital available to the Company and the Group, taking into account the net proceeds of the Placing, will be sufficient for its present requirements, that is for the period of at least 12 months from Admission. 14. Litigation Save as disclosed in this document, the Group is not involved nor has it been involved in any governmental, legal or arbitration proceedings in the previous 12 months which have, or may have had in the recent past, a significant effect on the Group’s financial position or profitability nor, so far as the Directors are aware, are any such proceedings pending or threatened against the Company or any member of the Group. 15. Principal investments The Company does not intend to make any investments and no further investments are planned for the foreseeable future other than in accordance with the Company’s strategy as set out in Part I of this document. 16. Disclosure and Transparency Rules To enable the Company to comply with its disclosure obligations under Rule 17 of the AIM Rules for Companies, a requirement for Shareholders to disclose their total proportion of voting rights (as defined in DTR5) are incorporated into the Articles. The Company is required by Rule 17 of the AIM Rules to announce without delay the information contained in any such notification received from its Shareholders notwithstanding any statutory requirements of disclosure. A summary of the provisions contained in the Articles is set out in paragraph 11 of this Part VII. 161 Page 17. Third party information Where information has been sourced from a third party, the information has been accurately reproduced and, as far as the Company and the Directors are aware and are able to ascertain from information published by that third party, no facts have been omitted which would render the reproduced information inaccurate or misleading. 18. Other Information 18.1 The fees and expenses of, and incidental to, Admission are estimated at £6.4 million inclusive of VAT. These include (but are not limited to) accountancy fees, solicitors’ fees and the fees of the Company’s nominated adviser and broker. 18.2 Except for the material contracts referred to in paragraph 12 of this Part VII, there are no contracts or agreements which are of fundamental importance to the Company’s business. 18.3 Save as disclosed in this document and as set out below, the Group is not dependent on any patents, licences, industrial or commercial or financial contracts or manufacturing processes which have a material effect on the Group’s business or profitability. The Group is, to an extent, dependent on the pultrusion process. Equipment Tracking derives a significant proportion of its income from licencing its software to third parties. 18.4 Except as stated in this document, none of the Directors performs any principal activities outside the Company that are significant with respect to the Company. 18.5 Except as stated in this document, there have been no principal investments made by the Company during the last three financial years and there are no principal future investments on which firm commitments have been made. 18.6 Except as otherwise stated in this document, no person has received, directly or indirectly, from the Company within the 12 months preceding the Company’s application to AIM, or has entered into any contractual arrangements with the Company to receive, directly or indirectly, from the Company on or after Admission fees totalling £10,000 or more, securities which have a value of £10,000 or more or any other benefit with a value of £10,000 or more at the date of Admission. 18.7 Grant Thornton, as Reporting Accountants, have given and not withdrawn their written consent to the issue of this document with the inclusion in it of their report at Parts V & VI and references to their name in the form and context in which they respectively appear. 18.8 Grant Thornton is registered with the Institute of Chartered Accountants in England and Wales to carry out audit work. 18.9 Cenkos, as Nominated Adviser and Broker, has given and not withdrawn its written consent to the issue of this document with the inclusion in it of references to its name in the form and context in which it appears. 18.10 Cenkos is regulated by the FCA. 18.11 Except as disclosed in this document, there has been no significant change in the financial or trading position of the Group since the period ending 31 December 2012, the date to when the financial information in Part V has been drawn up. 18.12 Save as disclosed in this document, the Company has not entered into any related party transactions. 18.13 Save as disclosed in this document, there are no environmental issues that the Directors have determined may affect the Company’s utilisation of tangible fixed assets and the Directors have not identified any events which have occurred since the end of the last financial year and which are considered to be likely to have a material effect on the Company’s prospects for the current financial year. 18.14 The financial information relating to the Company contained in this document does not comprise statutory accounts within the meaning of section 434 of the Act. 18.15 It is expected that CREST accounts will be credited in respect of entitlements to Depositary Interests representing beneficial interests in Ordinary Shares on Admission. 162 Page 18.16 The Ordinary Shares have been allocated the ISIN Number of LU0994178464 and the SEDOL number of BGFB1F1, each of which will be enabled on Admission. 18.17 Save as disclosed in this document, there are no arrangements of which the Company is aware which may result in a change of control of the Company. 18.18 There have been no takeover bids by third parties in respect of the Ordinary Shares received by the Company in the last financial year. 19. Copies of this document Copies of this document and the Articles are available to the public, free of charge, at the offices of Dentons UKMEA LLP, One Fleet Place, London EC4M 7WS, United Kingdom during normal business hours on any weekday (other than Saturdays, Sundays and public holidays), for a period of at least one month from the date of Admission. This document will also be available for download from the Company’s website at www.rm2.com. 17 December 2013 163 Page PART VIII DEFINITIONS “2013 OPTIONS” has the meaning given in paragraph 6 of Part VII “2013 OPTIONHOLDERS” has the meaning given in paragraph 6 of Part VII “2013 PLAN” has the meaning given in paragraph 6 of Part VII “ACT” the UK Companies Act 2006 “ADMISSION” admission of the entire issued and to be issued share capital of the Company to trading on AIM and such admission becoming effective in accordance with the AIM Rules for Companies “AIM” AIM, a market operated by the London Stock Exchange “AIM ADMISSION DOCUMENT” this document dated 17 December 2013 “AIM RULES” the AIM Rules for Companies and the AIM Rules for Nomads “AIM RULES FOR COMPANIES” the rules for AIM companies, as issued by the London Stock Exchange, as amended from time to time “AIM RULES FOR NOMADS” the rules for nominated advisers to AIM companies, as issued by the London Stock Exchange, as amended from time to time “ARTICLES” the Company’s articles of association “ASTM” ASTM International, formerly known as the American Society for Testing and Materials “ASTM D1185” has the meaning given in paragraph 8 of Part II “AUDIT COMMITTEE” the audit committee of the Board “BOARD” OR “DIRECTORS” the directors of the Company, or a duly authorised committee thereof, whose names are set out on page 4 of this document “CENKOS” Cenkos Securities PLC, a company registered in England and Wales with registered number 5210733 “CHEP” a pooling solutions business owned by Brambles Limited “CREST” the computerised settlement system (as defined in the CREST Regulations) operated by Euroclear “CREST REGULATIONS” the Uncertificated Securities Regulations 2001 (SI 2001/3755) as amended “DECABDE” decabromodiphenyl ether “DEPOSITARY” Computershare Investor Services plc with company number 3498808 and registered office at The Pavilions, Bridgwater Road, Bristol BS13 8AE 164 Page “DEPOSITARY INTERESTS” the uncertificated depositary interests issued by the Registrar and representing Ordinary Shares in the Company pursuant to a deed poll described in paragraph 12(n) of Part VII of this document “DISCLOSURE AND TRANSPARENCY RULES” the disclosure and transparency rules issued by the FCA acting in its capacity as the competent authority for the purposes of Part V of FSMA “DPE” has the meaning given in paragraph 12(b) of Part VII “DPE SHARES” the 4,157,428 new Ordinary Shares to be issued by the Company to DPE on Admission as part consideration for retiring the DPE Warrants “DPE WARRANTS” has the meaning given in paragraph 12(b) of Part VII “DTR5” has the meaning given in paragraph 11.10 of Part VII “EEA” the European Economic Area “ENLARGED ISSUED SHARE CAPITAL” the entire issued ordinary share capital of the Company immediately following Admission, comprising the Existing Ordinary Shares and the New Ordinary Shares “EQUIPMENT TRACKING” Equipment Tracking Limited, a company incorporated in England and Wales with registered number 05274087 “EUROCLEAR” Euroclear UK & Ireland Limited, a company incorporated in England with registered number 2878738, being the operator (as defined in the CREST Regulations) of the system known as CREST “EXISTING ORDINARY SHARES” the 156,182,775 Ordinary Shares (including 12,308,775 Restricted Shares) in issue immediately prior to the Placing and Admission “FCA” the UK Financial Conduct Authority “FDA” the US Food and Drug Administration “FSMA” the Financial Services and Markets Act 2000, as amended “GMA” the US Grocery Manufacturers Association “GRANT THORNTON” Grant Thornton UK LLP, Reporting Accountants and tax advisers to the Company “GRAS” generally recognised as safe by FDA “GROUP” the Company and the Subsidiaries “GROUP COMPANY” any member of the Group “HDPE” high‐density polyethylene “IFRS” International Financial Reporting Standards, as adopted for use in the European Union “IGPS” has the meaning given to it in paragraph 4.A. of Part I of this document “IP CO” RM2 IP S.A., a company registered in Luxembourg with registered number B 163 514 “ISIN” the International Securities Identification Number “ISO” the International Organisation for Standardisation 165 Page “ISO 8611” has the meaning given in paragraph 8 of Part II “JKD” has the meaning given in paragraph 12(a) of Part VII “LOCK‐IN ARRANGEMENTS” the agreement by which the Locked‐In Shareholders have agreed, with Cenkos and the Company, certain undertakings with respect to their holdings of Ordinary Shares following Admission, as more particularly described in paragraph 12(l) of Part VII of this document “LoCKED‐IN SHAREHOLDERS” each Director, Elizabeth Pauchet, Brian Dougan, Andrew Dowse, Christopher Gibbs, Matthew Gilfillan, Michael Greenspan, Tom Lane, Ruari McGirr, Rick Needham, Anthony Parry, Philip Seligmann, Peter Andrianopoulos and Jeffrey Thompson “LONDON STOCK EXCHANGE” London Stock Exchange plc “LUXEMBOURG COMPANIES LAW” Loi du 10 août 1915 concernant les sociétés commerciales (telle que modifiée) – Law dated August 10, 1915 concerning commercial companies (as amended) “NEW ORDINARY SHARES” the Placing Shares and the DPE Shares “NFPA13” National Fire Protection Association Standard for the installation of sprinkler systems “NOMAD” the Nominated Adviser to the Company, as defined in the AIM Rules “NON‐EXECUTIVE DIRECTOR” a non‐executive director of the Company “OFFICIAL LIST” the Official List of the UKLA “ORDINARY SHARES” Ordinary Shares of US$0.01 each in the capital of the Company “PLACEES” subscribers for the Placing Shares, as procured by Cenkos on behalf of the Company pursuant to the Placing Agreement “PLACING” the conditional placing by Cenkos of the Placing Shares on behalf of the Company at the Placing Price pursuant to and on the terms of the Placing Agreement “PLACING AGREEMENT” the conditional agreement dated 17 December 2013 between (i) Cenkos; (ii) the Company; and (iii) the Directors relating to the Placing and Admission, further details of which are set out in paragraph 12(i) of Part VII of this document “PLACING PRICE” 88 pence per Placing Share “PLACING SHARES” the 155,903,548 new Ordinary Shares to be issued by the Company and placed with Placees pursuant to the Placing “PRC” has the meaning given in paragraph 12(g) of Part VII “PROSPECTIVE DIRECTIVE” the Prospectus Directive (2003/71/EC) “PROSPECTUS RULES” the prospectus rules of the UK Listing Authority made in accordance with Section 73A of FSMA as amended from time to time brought into effect on 1 July 2005 pursuant to Commission Regulation (EC) No. 809/2004 and the Prospectus Regulations 2005 (SI 2005/1433) “QCA CODE” the Corporate Governance Code for small and mid‐sized quoted companies 2013 published by the Quoted Companies Alliance (as amended from time to time) “R&D” research and development 166 Page “RECEIVER” has the meaning given to it in paragraph 3.B.i. of Part I of this document “REGISTRAR” Computershare Investor Services (Jersey) Limited of Queensway House, Hilgrove Street, Jersey JE1 1ES “REGULATION S” Regulation S promulgated under the Securities Act “REMUNERATION COMMITTEE” the remuneration committee of the Board “RESTRICTED SHARES” 12,308,775 restricted Ordinary Shares granted to certain Directors as set out in paragraph 7.2 of Part VII of this document and having the performance conditions and restrictions as set out in paragraph 6.2 of Part VII of this document “RESTRICTED TERRITORIES” the United States of America, Australia, Canada, Japan, the Republic of Ireland and the Republic of South Africa “RFID” radio‐frequency identification “RM2” OR THE “COMPANY” RM2 International S.A., a company incorporated in Luxembourg with registered number B 132 740, and “RM2” shall be deemed to include such of the Subsidiaries as the context may require “RM2 CANADA” RM2 Canada Inc, a company incorporated in Canada with registered number 7636156 “RM2 FRANCE” RM2 France sarl, a company incorporated in France with registered number 751 487 067 “RM2 HOLLAND” RM2 Holland B.V., a company incorporated in the Netherlands with registered number 24423716 “RM2 POLAND” RM2 Europe Sp. Z.o.o., a company incorporated in Poland with registered number KRS0000404937 “RM2 S.A.” RM2 S.A., a company incorporated in Luxembourg with registered number B143964 “RM2 SWISS BRANCH” RM2 S.A., (Swiss Branch), a branch of RM2 S.A., registered in Switzerland with registered number CH‐217.3.542.870‐6 “RM2 USA” RM2 USA Inc, a company registered in Delaware with registered number 4828283 “SECURITIES ACT” the US Securities Act of 1933, as amended “SEDOL” the Stock Exchange Daily Official List Identification Number “SENIOR MANAGERS” the senior managers of the Group whose names are listed in paragraph 6.B. of Part I of this document “SHAREHOLDER” a holder of Ordinary Shares “SPECIAL MAJORITY” a Shareholders’ resolution required to be passed by at least two thirds of the votes cast “STERLING” OR “£” Pound sterling, the lawful currency of the United Kingdom “SUBSIDIARIES” any subsidiary or subsidiary undertaking of the Company, as defined in the Act “SUPPLIER” has the meaning given to it in paragraph 3.B.i. of Part I of this document “TACS” Track Asset, Control Spend, the pallet tracking and management software previously licensed by RM2 from Equipment Tracking, which was acquired by RM2 on 10 December 2013 167 Page “TAKEOVER CODE” the City Code on Takeovers and Mergers “TAKEOVER PANEL” the Panel on Takeovers and Mergers “TOTAL SOLUTIONS INC ” RM2 Total Solutions Inc, a company incorporated in Delaware with registered number 4747908 “TOTAL SOLUTIONS NETHERLANDS” RM2 Total Solutions International B.V., a company incorporated in the Netherlands with registered number 24423714 “UK” OR “UNITED KINGDOM” the United Kingdom of Great Britain and Northern Ireland “UK CORPORATE GOVERNANCE CODE” the UK Corporate Governance Code published by the Financial Reporting Council “UK LISTING AUTHORITY” OR “UKLA” the FCA acting in its capacity as the competent authority for the purposes of Part VI of FSMA “USA” OR “US” OR “UNITED STATES” United States of America, each state thereof (including the District of Columbia), its territories, possessions and all areas subject to its jurisdiction “US$” OR “USD” the United States dollar “UNCERTIFICATED” OR “IN UNCERTIFICATED securities recorded on a register of securities maintained by Euroclear in accordance with the FORM” CREST Regulations as being in uncertificated form in CREST and title to which, by virtue of the CREST Regulations, may be transferred by means of CREST “VRL” Victoria Rises Limited, a company incorporated in England and Wales with registered number 06894905 168 sterling 162549 Page RM2 International S.A. AIM Admission Document Nominated Adviser & Broker Cenkos Securities plc 6.7.8 Tokenhouse Yard London EC2R 7AS RM2 International S.A. 5, rue de la Chapelle L-1325 Luxembourg Grand Duchy of Luxembourg